Form 20-F

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

FORM 20-F

 

(Mark One)

¨ REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

OR

 

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended 30 June 2004

 

OR

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the transition period from                      to                     

 

Commission file number 0-15850

 

Ansell Limited

(Australian Company Number 004 085 330)

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Ansell Limited

(Translation of Registrant’s name into English)

 

Victoria, Australia

(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organisation)

 

Level 3, 678 Victoria Street, Richmond, Victoria, 3121, Australia

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act.

 

Title of each class


 

Name of each exchange on which registered


None   None

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.

 

Ordinary Shares

American Depositary Shares*

 

* Evidenced by American Depositary Receipts, each American Depositary Share representing four (4) Ordinary Shares

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.

 

None

 

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report.

 

Ordinary Shares – 176,310,916 (at 30 June 2004)**

 


 

** This figure includes 1,140,936 shares represented by the 285,234 American Depositary Shares outstanding on 30 June 2004.

 


 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

 

       

  x Yes          ¨ No

Indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow

 

       

  ¨ Item 17    x Item 18

 


 


Contents - Business Description and Financial Statements

 

SEC ITEM


       PAGE NO

PART I

        

Item 1:

  Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisors    1

Item 2:

  Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable    2

Item 3:

  Key Information    3
    3A   Selected Financial Data    3
    3B   Capitalisation and Indebtedness    5
    3C   Reasons for the Offer and use of Proceeds    5
    3D   Risk Factors    5

Item 4:

  Information on the Company    8
    4A   History and Development of the Company    8
    4B   Business Overview    11
    4C   Organisational Structure    16
    4D   Property, Plants and Equipment    16

Item 5:

  Operating and Financial Review and Prospects    18
    5A   Operating Results    18
    5B   Liquidity and Capital Resources    23
    5C   Research And Development    25
    5D   Trend Information    25
    5E   Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements    25
    5F   Contractual Obligations    26
    5G   Safe Harbour    26
    5H   Critical Accounting Policies    26

Item 6:

  Directors, Senior Management and Employees    28
    6A   Directors and Senior Management    28
    6B   Compensation    31
    6C   Board Practices    35
    6D   Employees    41
    6E   Share Ownership    42

Item 7:

  Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions    44
    7A   Major Shareholders    44
    7B   Related Party Transactions    44
    7C   Interests of Experts and Counsel    44

Item 8:

  Financial Information    45
    8A   Consolidated Statements and other Financial Information    45
    8B   Significant Changes    45

Item 9:

  The Offer and Listing    46
    9A   Offer and Listing Details    46
    9B   Plan of Distribution    46
    9C   Markets    47
    9D   Selling Shareholders    47
    9E   Dilution    47
    9F   Expenses of the Issue    47

Item 10:

  Additional Information    48
    10A   Share Capital    48
    10B   Constitution    48
    10C   Material Contracts    50
    10D   Exchange Controls    51
    10E   Australian Taxation    60
    10F   Dividends and Paying Agents    63

 


    10G   Statement by Experts    63
    10H   Documents on Display    63
    10I   Subsidiary Information    63

Item 11:

  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk    64
    Derivative Financial Instruments    64

Item 12:

  Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities    70

Item 13:

  Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies    71

Item 14:

  Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders    72

Item 15:

  Controls and Procedures    73

Item 16:

       74
    16A   Audit Committee Financial Expert    74
    16B   Code Of Ethics    74
    16C   Principal Accountant Fees and Services    74
    16D   Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees    75
    16E   Purchases Of Equity Securities By The Issuer    75

Item 17:

  Financial Statements    76

Item 18:

  Consolidated Financial Statements    77
    Statements of Financial Performance    77
    Statements of Financial Position    78
    Statements of Cash Flows    79
    Industry Segments    80
    1.   Summary of Significant Accounting Policies    81
    2.   Impact of Adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards    88
    3.   Total Revenue    88
    4.   Profit/(Loss) from Ordinary Activities Before Income Tax    89
    5.   Contributed Equity    90
    6.   Accumulated Losses and Reserves    91
    7.   Total Equity Reconciliation    92
    8.   Income tax    92
    9.   Dividends Paid or Declared    93
    10.   Outside Equity Interests    93
    11.   Cash Assets    93
    12.   Receivables    94
    13.   Inventories    94
    14.   Other Financial Assets (Investments)    95
    15.   Property, Plant and Equipment    95
    16.   Intangible Assets    97
    17.   Deferred Tax Assets    97
    18.   Payables    98
    19.   Interest Bearing Liabilities    98
    20.   Provisions    100
    21.   Other Liabilities    101
    22.   Dissection of Liabilities    101
    23.   Expenditure Commitments    101
    24.   Superannuation    102
    25.   Ownership-Based Remuneration Schemes    103
    26.   Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets    105
    27.   Financial Instruments    107
    28.   Director and Executive Disclosures    110
    29.   Service Agreements    115
    30.   Notes to the Industry Segments Report    116
    31.   Notes to the Statements of Cash Flows    118
    32.   Acquisition of Controlled Entities and Material Businesses    119

 


    33.   Disposal of Controlled Entities and Material Businesses    119
    34.   Non-Director Related Party Disclosures    119
    35.   Earnings per Share    121
    36.   Environmental Matters    121
    37.   Particulars Relating to Controlled Entities    122
    38.   Investments in Associates    125
    39.   Major differences between Australian GAAP and US GAAP—Restated    127
    40.   Reconciliation to United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (US GAAP)    134
    Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm    142

Item 19:

  Exhibits    143

Signature

       144

South Pacific Tyres

   145
    Statement Of Financial Performance    145
    Statement Of Financial Position    146
    Statement Of Partners’ Equity    147
    Statements Of Cash Flows    148
    Notes To The Financial Statements    149

Exhibit Index

   187
    Exhibit 1.1    187
    Exhibit 7.1    188
    Exhibit 8.1    189
    Exhibit 12.1    191
    Exhibit 12.2    192
    Exhibit 13.1    193
    Exhibit 13.2    194

 


PART I

 

Item 1 : Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisors

 

Not Applicable

 

1


PART I

 

Item 2 : Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable

 

Not Applicable

 

2


PART I

 

Item 3 : Key Information

 

3A SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

 

The following selected financial data for the five year period ended 30 June 2004 has been derived from Ansell Limited’s audited consolidated financial statements (the “Financial Statements”) and should be read in conjunction with and are qualified in their entirety by reference to those statements and accompanying notes thereto. Such Financial Statements have been audited by KPMG, Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

 

Except as set forth below, Ansell Limited’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with Australian GAAP, which varies in certain material respects from U.S. GAAP. For discussion of the major differences and a reconciliation of the material differences between Australian GAAP and US GAAP as they relate to Ansell Limited, see Notes 39 and 40 to the Consolidated Financial Statements. Refer Note 39(r) for details regarding the restatement of certain amounts in the US GAAP results for the years ended 30 June 2003, 2002, 2001 and 2000.

 

In millions of A$, except per share
& per ADS amounts


   For Years Ended 30 June

 
     2004

   2003

   2002

    2001

    2000

 

STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE DATA

                            

Amounts prepared in accordance with Australian GAAP :

                            

Sales revenue (excluding South Pacific Tyres)

   1,113    1,294    2,223     4,157     5,726  

Profit/(loss) before income tax

   94    80    (57 )   54     (53 )

Income tax expense

   21    27    56     190     30  

Outside equity interest after tax

   2    3    (3 )   (3 )   (4 )

Net profit/(loss) after income tax

   71    50    (116 )   (139 )   (87 )

Amounts prepared in accordance with US GAAP (Restated) :

                            

Sales revenue from continuing operations

   1,113    1,294    1,414     1,412     1,173  

Income/(loss) from continuing operations

   83    69    (126 )   (281 )   (33 )

Net income/(loss)

   90    51    (172 )   (207 )   (42 )

SHARE INFORMATION (1)

                            

Amounts prepared in accordance with Australian GAAP :

                            

Number of shares on issue (millions)

   177    187    188     188     209  

Basic Earnings per share ($’s)

   0.39    0.27    (0.62 )   (0.72 )   (0.42 )

Basic Earnings per ADS ($’s)

   1.56    1.08    (2.48 )   (2.88 )   (1.68 )

Dividends provided for or paid

   31    —      —       47     103  

Dividends per ordinary share ($’s)

   0.17    —      —       0.05     0.10  

Dividends per ADS ($’s)

   0.68    —      —       0.20     0.40  

Dividends per ADS – US$ (2)

   0.48    —      —       0.10     0.23  

Amounts prepared in accordance with US GAAP (Restated) : (3)

                            

Basic Earnings per share – continuing operations (4) ($’s)

   0.46    0.37    (0.67 )   (1.45 )   (0.16 )

Basic Earnings per ADS – continuing operations ($’s)

   1.84    1.48    (2.68 )   (5.80 )   (0.64 )

Basic Earnings per share – net income/(loss) ($’s)

   0.50    0.27    (0.92 )   (1.07 )   (0.20 )

Basic Earnings per ADS – net income/(loss) ($’s)

   2.00    1.12    (3.68 )   (4.28 )   (0.80 )

STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION DATA (AT YEAR END)

                            

Amounts prepared in accordance with Australian GAAP :

                            

Current assets

   749    761    822     1,803     3,344  

Total assets

   1,499    1,579    1,833     3,476     5,086  

Current liabilities

   404    368    389     1,450     2,863  

Non-current liabilities

   283    366    568     960     723  

Shareholders’ equity

   812    845    876     1,066     1,500  

Amounts prepared in accordance with US GAAP (Restated)(3) :

                            

Current assets

   749    761    821     1,802     3,342  

Total assets

   1,591    1,615    1,844     3,546     5,190  

Current liabilities

   405    367    389     1,427     2,797  

Long term debt (including leases)

   236    320    517     862     628  

Shareholders’ equity

   880    864    874     1,139     1,653  

 

3


PART I

 

Item 3 : Key Information

 

3A SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA (continued)

 

 

(1) Effective 12 April 2002, Ansell Limited reduced the number of ordinary shares and exercisable options on issue by means of a 1 for 5 share consolidation, which received shareholder approval at an Extraordinary General Meeting held on 12 April 2002. Where appropriate prior year comparatives have been adjusted to take into account this share consolidation.

 

(2) US$ amount of A$ dividends translated at the Noon Buying Rate on the respective A$ dividend payment dates, which represents approximately the actual US$ dividend paid to holders of American Depositary Shares (ADSs) by the Depositary.

 

(3) The principle differences between Australian GAAP and US GAAP are explained in Notes 39 and 40 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

(4) Diluted earnings per share are the same as basic earnings per share.

 

EXCHANGE RATES

 

Ansell Limited publishes its consolidated financial statements in Australian dollars (A$ or $). Unless specified or the context otherwise requires, references to US$ or US dollars are to United States dollars and references to $ or A$ are to Australian dollars. For the convenience of the reader, this Annual Report contains translations of certain Australian dollar amounts into US dollars at specified exchange rates. These translations should not be construed as representations that the Australian dollar amounts actually represent such US dollar amounts or could be converted into US dollars at the rate indicated. Unless otherwise stated, the translations of Australian dollars into US dollars have been made at the noon buying rate in New York City for cable transfers in Australian dollars as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (the “noon buying rate”) on specified dates.

 

The rate of exchange of A$1.00 to US$ based on the noon buying rate 28 February 2005 was 0.7880.

 

The following table sets forth, for the periods and dates indicated, information concerning the rates of exchange of A$1.00 to US$ based on the noon buying rate.

 

For the last six months

 

US$ per A$1.00


   High

   Low

February 2005

   0.7922    0.7650

January 2005

   0.7765    0.7553

December 2004

   0.7819    0.7515

November 2004

   0.7905    0.7464

October 2004

   0.7484    0.7203

September 2004

   0.7256    0.6880

 

For the last five fiscal years

 

US$ per A$1.00


   2004

   2003

   2002

   2001

   2000

Average Rate (1)

   0.7016    0.5865    0.5221    0.5377    0.6280

 

(1) The average of the noon buying rate on the last business day of each calendar month during the period.

 

Fluctuations in the A$/US$ exchange rate will affect the US$ equivalent of the A$ price of the ordinary shares on the Australian Stock Exchange Limited, and as a result, are likely to affect the market price of Ansell Limited’s ADSs in the United States. Such fluctuations would also affect the US$ amounts received by holders of ADSs on conversion by the Depositary of cash dividends paid in A$ on the ordinary shares underlying the ADSs.

 

4


PART I

 

Item 3 : Key Information

 

3A SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA (continued)

 

Ansell Limited purchases forward exchange contracts to cover exchange rate risks on import/export transactions. The Company believes it has reduced substantially its exposure to movements in exchange rates with respect to these transactions. The Company remains exposed, however, to fluctuations in exchange rates to the extent that the results of operations of its foreign subsidiaries are denominated in currencies other than Australian dollars and are translated for each relevant financial period into Australian dollars at the average exchange rate for the period.

 

3B CAPITALISATION AND INDEBTEDNESS

 

Not Required

 

3C REASONS FOR THE OFFER AND USE OF PROCEEDS

 

Not Required

 

3D RISK FACTORS

 

The following list of risks and uncertainties may not be exhaustive. Additional risks and uncertainties that we do not currently know about or that we currently believe are immaterial may also harm Ansell’s business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Since a substantial portion of Ansell’s costs and net sales are incurred and realised in currencies other than Australian dollars, fluctuations in currency exchange rates could have a material effect on the results of operations.

 

Due to the worldwide locations of Ansell’s manufacturing facilities, a substantial portion of costs are incurred in currencies other than Australian dollars, primarily the U.S. dollar and currencies of various Southeast Asian countries. In fiscal years 2002, 2003 and 2004 all Ansell’s manufacturing costs in respect of its continuing operations were denominated in currencies other than Australian dollars.

 

Similarly, due to the worldwide presence of Ansell’s customer base, a substantial portion of net sales is realised in various currencies other than Australian dollars, primarily U.S. dollars, Euros and to a lesser extent British pounds, Canadian dollars and several other currencies. For each of fiscal years 2002 and 2003, approximately 95% and in 2004 approximately 94% of net sales were denominated in currencies other than Australian dollars. Net sales and costs are not aligned in certain regions, which limits natural currency hedges.

 

We expect that a large part of Ansell’s costs and sales will continue to be in non-Australian currencies. As a result, fluctuations in currency exchange rates, particularly of the U.S. dollar, various Southeast Asian currencies and the Euro relative to the Australian dollar could have a material positive or negative effect on the results of operations.

 

Ansell’s board of directors reviews and approves the currency and hedging strategies. These strategies should reduce but not eliminate the risks of currency exchange rate fluctuations and will result in transaction costs associated with hedging transactions.

 

5


PART I

 

Item 3 : Key Information

 

3D RISK FACTORS (continued)

 

The public market for Ansell Limited’s shares may fluctuate.

 

The market price of Ansell Limited’s shares could fluctuate significantly in response to various factors, including:

 

    actual or anticipated variations in semi-annual operating results, including currency translation,

 

    announcements of technological innovations or new services or products by Ansell or Ansell’s competitors,

 

    the operating and stock price performance of other comparable companies,

 

    changes in financial estimates by securities analysts,

 

    changes in Ansell’s expected capital needs, and

 

    announcements relating to strategic relationships, mergers or consolidations by Ansell’s competitors or us.

 

The stock markets have experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations that have affected the market prices of equity securities. These fluctuations have often been unrelated or disproportionate to operating performance. These broad market factors may materially affect the trading price of Ansell Limited’s common stock. General economic, political and market conditions, like recessions and interest rate fluctuations, may also have an adverse effect on the market price of Ansell Limited’s shares.

 

Ansell’s manufacturing operations are based, and revenues originate, in many different countries and are, therefore, subject to instability and fluctuation in political, diplomatic and economic conditions, including changes in policies regarding taxation.

 

In fiscal year 2004, approximately 89% of the Ansell’s manufacturing operations, measured in terms of cost of production, and approximately 61% of Ansell’s net sales were outside the United States. As a company with worldwide presence, we are subject to economic, political and diplomatic factors in countries where we have operations that could adversely affect the financial results, restrict Ansell’s ability to expand or limit the current operations.

 

Ansell’s plants outside the United States are located in Malaysia, Thailand, Sri Lanka, India, Mexico, and the U.K. as are those of many of Ansell’s competitors. As a result, we are directly affected by the political and economic conditions, to the extent that they affect on the export of product from manufacturing plants that exist in those parts of the world. Any political or economic instability, a significant increase in the rate of corporate taxation, a discontinuance or reduction in export tax rebates or any other change in a country’s policies regarding foreign ownership of manufacturing facilities could adversely affect the results of operations. We expect that non-U.S. production costs will continue to represent the major portion of such costs.

 

We also expect that we will be subject to the risks of conducting business internationally, including foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations, unexpected changes in regulatory requirements, tariffs and other barriers. The results of operations may be adversely affected by these factors.

 

Several of Ansell Limited’s subsidiaries, and the Company in some instances, are defendants in product liability lawsuits related to products manufactured and sold by subsidiaries. Although we cannot quantify Ansell’s exposure in these cases, we are incurring and expect to incur additional expenses in defending these. Some of those expenses, as well as judgements that could be entered against us, are not covered by insurance.

 

Ansell, and other companies in its industry, are currently defendants in numerous product liability lawsuits alleging fault for allergic reactions to natural rubber latex gloves experienced by some users. As of 30 June 2004, Ansell was a defendant along with other manufacturers and distributors of latex gloves in 46 lawsuits filed in the United States on behalf of individuals alleging wrongful death, personal injuries and lost wages as a result of their exposure to natural rubber latex gloves.

 

6


PART I

 

Item 3 : Key Information

 

3D RISK FACTORS (continued)

 

The lawsuits allege, among other things, that the defendants were negligent in the design and manufacture of the gloves and failed to adequately warn users of the possibility of allergic reactions to latex products. As of 30 June 2004, the 46 lawsuits pending against us in the United States represented approximately 50% of outstanding latex related cases filed against all defendants in the United States.

 

In the United States, we had 367 and 313 latex allergy lawsuits pending against us at 30 June 2002 and 30 June 2003, respectively. We are unable to anticipate how many additional plaintiffs may file similar lawsuits or how many lawsuits may be filed in other countries.

 

Ansell is subject to regulation by governments around the world, and if these regulations are not complied with, existing and future operations may be curtailed, and could be subject to liability.

 

The design, development, manufacturing, marketing and labelling of Ansell’s products are subject to regulation by governmental authorities in the United States, Europe and other countries, including the Food and Drug Administration and the European Committee for Standardisation, known as the FDA and CEN, respectively. The regulatory process can result in required modification or withdrawal of existing products and a substantial delay in the introduction of new products. Also, it is possible that regulatory approval may not be obtained for a new product.

 

Failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements can result in actions that could adversely affect Ansell’s business and financial performance.

 

Ansell is heavily dependent upon the rubber crop and the availability of latex concentrate, and a material disruption in the regular supply of rubber for latex concentrate or increases in the price of latex concentrate could negatively affect the results of operations.

 

Ansell accounted for approximately 4% of worldwide liquid natural latex consumption in fiscal 2004.

 

Ansell’s ability to produce natural latex products is heavily dependent upon the regular availability of raw rubber harvested by independent growers in Southeast Asia and processed into latex concentrate. A material disruption in the regular supply of rubber for latex concentrate due to weather or other natural phenomena, labour or transportation stoppages or shortages, political unrest or otherwise, would cause adverse effects to Ansell’s business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, rubber is a commodity traded on world commodities exchanges and is subject to price fluctuations driven by changing market conditions.

 

7


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

OVERVIEW

 

The fiscal year of Ansell Limited (“Ansell Limited” or the “Company,” which, unless the context otherwise requires, includes Ansell Limited and its consolidated subsidiaries) ends on 30 June. The fiscal year ended 30 June 2004 is referred to herein as “2003-2004” or “fiscal year 2004” and other fiscal years are referred to in a similar manner.

 

This Annual Report contains forward looking statements (within the meaning of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) and information that is based on management’s beliefs as well as assumptions made by and information currently available to management. When used in this Annual Report the words “anticipate,” “estimate,” “believe,” “expect,” “potential,” “should” and similar expressions are intended to identify forward looking statements. These forward looking statements necessarily make numerous assumptions with respect to the Company’s operations, potential exposure, industry performance, general business, economic and regulatory conditions, access to markets and materials and other matters, all of which are inherently subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies and many of which are beyond the Company’s control. Should one or more of these risks or uncertainties materialise or should underlying assumptions prove incorrect, actual results may vary materially from those anticipated, planned for, estimated, expected or projected. The Company believes that a number of important factors could cause the Company’s actual results to differ from those that may have been or may be projected in forward looking statements made by or on behalf of the Company from time to time. These factors include the economic situation in those areas of the world where the Company has substantial operations, customers or consumers, foreign currency exchange rates, the success of the Company’s business strategies including cost cutting and consolidations, the ability of the Company to take advantage of growth opportunities through acquisitions, the positioning of business segments, future production output capacity, litigation, environmental risks, and risks of derivative instruments. See also “Risk Factors” in Item 3 of this Annual Report. The forward looking statements in this Annual Report are contained principally under Item 5 – “Operating and Financial Review and Prospects.”

 

4A HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT OF THE COMPANY

 

Ansell Limited’s business originated in 1893 as a branch of Dunlop of the United Kingdom (“Dunlop UK”) conducting an Australian bicycle tire business. The Company was incorporated under the Corporations Act of Australia (the “Corporations Act”) on 16 August 1920 in Victoria, Australia under the name of Dunlop Rubber Company of Australia Limited, at which time it acquired the rights in Australia to the trademark and tradename Dunlop and the right to use certain technology of Dunlop UK.

 

Until the 1960s the Company was engaged primarily in the manufacture of rubber based products. During the 1960s and the 1970s, the Company undertook a geographic and product diversification program, including the addition of clothing and footwear businesses (which were the foundation for the Pacific Brands Group) and the establishment of manufacturing facilities in Malaysia, New Zealand and the Philippines.

 

In 1980, the Company merged with another Australian industrial company, Olympic Consolidated Industries Limited (“Olympic”), which was engaged in the tire, polyurethane foam, cable and polystyrene businesses. Both the Company and Olympic had substantial tire manufacturing operations in an industry with over capacity, and the merger led to significant consolidation. After the merger, the Company operated under the name Dunlop Olympic Limited until 1986, when it changed its name to Pacific Dunlop Limited.

 

In 1984, the Company acquired the New Zealand businesses of Canzac Cables Ltd and Dunlop New Zealand Ltd., with their cables, tire manufacturing and retailing, industrial products and sporting goods operations fitting in well with the Company’s operations in Australia.

 

During the course of the 1980s, the Company further expanded its operations in Australia and internationally through acquisitions, increased international marketing activity and the construction of new manufacturing facilities, particularly in Asia and North America. The Company also completed a series of joint ventures which complemented and strengthened its prior activities, the most significant of which was the combination of its Australian and New Zealand tire manufacturing and retailing activities with those of The Goodyear Tire and Rubber Company in March 1987.

 

8


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

4A HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT OF THE COMPANY (continued)

 

In addition, during the 1980s, the Company significantly expanded its battery operations through the acquisition of the battery operations of Chloride Group Plc in the United States, Australia and New Zealand and the acquisition of GNB Technologies Inc., a United States battery manufacturer.

 

During 1988–1989, the Company acquired certain health and medical businesses, which led to the creation of the Medical Group. The Company also acquired during 1988–1989 the automotive parts distribution businesses of Repco Limited in Australia. Shortly thereafter, the Company acquired the Edmont industrial glove business (“Edmont”) and in 1995 acquired the Perry medical gloves business.

 

These two acquisitions significantly increased the size of the Ansell Healthcare business. Sales during 1995-1996 included adidas, a number of businesses in the Industrial Foam and Fibre Group and the public float of Cochlear Ltd. In 1996–1997 Loscam Ltd and the Telectronics business of the Medical Group were sold and Ansell Healthcare acquired the Golden Needles Knitting business.

 

On 29 November 1996, the Telectronics implantable medical device business was sold for US$135 million ($166 million net proceeds) to St Jude Medical, Inc. of the United States. Responsibility for products manufactured prior to the sale of the business (including the Accufix Pacing Leads Litigation) was not assumed by the purchaser.

 

During the 1998 fiscal year the Olex Communications division of the Cables and Engineered Products Group was sold for $23 million. GNB Environmental Services Inc. (ESI), a subsidiary of GNB was also sold in that year.

 

The Australian, New Zealand and Sri Lankan cable businesses were sold on 2 June 1999. Proceeds from the sale, including certain property sales of the Cables Group, amounted to $300 million. The sale generated a breakeven result after providing for appropriate write-downs for the Chinese and Indonesian facilities, which were sold during the 2000 fiscal year. During that year the Company also purchased the Medical Glove business of Johnson & Johnson for US$86 million and announced the intention to sell its Electrical Distribution business and GNB Technologies Group.

 

The sales of the Electrical Distribution business and GNB Technologies Group were finalised during the 2001 fiscal year for $343 million and US$333 million respectively. Other key events that occurred during the 2001 fiscal year were:

 

    resolution of the outstanding Accufix Pacing Leads class action litigation in the United States within the previously provided provisions,

 

    the strengthening of Ansell Healthcare’s global leadership and competitiveness in barrier protection products by continuing the integration of the Johnson & Johnson medical gloves business, fully commissioning the new Thailand condom plant and commencing a major manufacturing and marketing restructure,

 

    the acquisition and integration by Pacific Brands of Clarks Shoes and the Sara Lee Apparel business in Australasia and Fiji,

 

    the closure of South Pacific Tyres heavy truck tire plant and the realignment of the marketing function along consumer and commercial lines,

 

    effective 1 August 2000, the Novare joint venture between the Company and Andersen Consulting (now Accenture) for the provision of business support services and information technology solutions to companies across the manufacturing, distribution and retail industries in Australia and New Zealand formally commenced operation.

 

 

In addition to the above, the Company also released announcements concerning a restructuring of its activities including the sale of the Pacific Automotive and Pacific Brands businesses, the acquisition of Accenture’s 50% interest in the Novare joint venture and an agreement with the Goodyear Tire and Rubber Company of the United States governing the restructure of the South Pacific Tyres Joint Venture.

 

During the 2002 fiscal year the sales of the Pacific Automotive and Pacific Brands businesses were finalised for $251.5 million and $730 million respectively. The agreement with the Goodyear Tire and Rubber Company of the United States was also completed. This agreement included reducing manufacturing facilities from five to two and franchising a number of company owned stores.

 

9


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

4A HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT OF THE COMPANY (continued)

 

As part of the agreement, an option in favour of the Company was executed (exercisable between August 2005 and August 2006) which enables the Company to put the business to Goodyear. If the option is not exercised, Goodyear has a call option exercisable in the following six months. Under these agreements the Company is not required to contribute any further cash, its contribution being limited to its equity invested of $140 million and its current loans of $56.3 million.

 

As a result of this agreement, the Company effective 1 July 2001, discontinued its past practice of including 50% of the result of South Pacific Tyres (after elimination of intercompany items) in its statements of income prepared under Australian GAAP. The Company’s interest in the South Pacific Tyres Partnership is carried as an investment.

 

Also effective 31 August 2001 the Company took full ownership of the Novare joint venture by acquiring Accenture’s 50% interest for $19.3 million.

 

In April 2002 the Company changed its name from Pacific Dunlop Limited to Ansell Limited and reduced the number of ordinary shares and exercisable options on issue by means of a 1 for 5 share consolidation.

 

During the 2003 fiscal year, the Company completed most of the remaining corporate and restructuring activities associated with its former structure.

 

Also during fiscal 2003 the Company launched the first phase of Operation Full Potential, a three year program designed to significantly enhance Ansell’s operating performance. The first phase concentrated on business growth and development initiatives and provided capabilities and resources to address business challenges that emerged during the year.

 

The Company also progressed its Occupational Value Proposition (OVP), an exciting and radically different approach begun at Ford Motor Company in 2001, to move Ansell “from products to solutions” by developing our expertise in guiding customers in hand injury reduction techniques using our products and know-how. During fiscal 2003 the Company progressed OVP from concept through to trials completed successfully in potential customers’ production facilities.

 

During the 2004 fiscal year, the Company moved into the second phase of Operation Full Potential resulting in the activities, capabilities and program structure being integrated into the respective business segments.

 

Also during fiscal 2004 Ansell continued its successful push to help customers change the way they manage their hand protection costs to focus on the total value of hand protection rather than the more traditional concentration on glove procurement cost. This approach has lead to a number of significant glove contracts during the year.

 

The Company also adopted the globally recognised Six Sigma operational excellence methodology during the 2004 fiscal year. This methodology has a focus on improving customer satisfaction and delivering on customer expectations by reducing variations in products and processes.

 

The Company’s registered head office is located at 678 Victoria Street Richmond, Victoria, Australia. Its telephone number is (61 3) 9270 –7270 and fax number is (61 3) 9270-7300. Further information can be found by viewing the Company’s website www.ansell.com. However, such information is not part of this Annual Report.

 

Refer to Item 5.B for information on the Company’s principal capital expenditures and divestitures since the beginning of the last three financial years. There are no material capital expenditures or divestitures currently in progress.

 

10


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

4B Business Overview

 

ORGANIZATION

 

Although the Company continues to be listed on the Australian Stock Exchange and maintains its registered head office in Australia, its operational head office is located in Red Bank, New Jersey, USA. The Company’s Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and most of the senior management team are based in New Jersey.

 

ANSELL HEALTHCARE

 

Ansell Healthcare provides essential healthcare barrier protection against injury, infection and contamination for millions of people at work, in medical situations, in the home and in special environments, such as food preparations and microelectronics.

 

The following table sets forth certain information with respect to Ansell Healthcare for the periods and dates indicated.

 

     For Years Ended 30 June

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Sales

   1,113    1,294    1,414

Operating Profit

   146    160    162

Gross Assets (1)

   663    707    865

Employees

   11,509    11,991    12,118

 

(1) Gross assets exclude cash, goodwill and brand names.

 

Ansell operates in three broad market segments: Professional Healthcare (surgeons’ and examination gloves); Occupational Healthcare (industrial hand protection); and Consumer Healthcare (condoms and household gloves). The Company is organized across three geographic regions – the Americas, Europe and Asia Pacific – supported by a shared operations/supply chain, a Science and Technology group and global marketing teams. More than 48 percent of Ansell’s sales in fiscal year 2004 were in the Americas, with a further 36 percent in the European region and the balance in Asia Pacific. Refer to Item 5.A. for additional information on the breakdown of total revenues by category of activity and geographic market.

 

Medical gloves are marketed principally under the umbrella brands of Ansell and Ansell Perry and specific product brands include Gammex, Conform, Encore, Nutex, MicrOptic, X-AM, Synsation, Dermaclean, Nitratouch, Allergard, Surgikos, Maxxus, Neutralon, Ultralon, Dispos-a-Glove, Micro Touch Ultra and Micro Touch Plus.

 

Ansell Healthcare believes it is one of the world’s largest manufacturers and marketers of synthetic dipped and sewn industrial gloves, which are principally branded Ansell Edmont. Specific product brands include Ansell, Nitrilite, Solvex, Hycron, Golden Needles and HyFlex.

 

Condom brands include Lifestyles, Mates, Mannix, Contempo, Primex, Chekmate and Kama Sutra.

 

Refer to Item 5.C for additional information on new product development.

 

With the exception of most types of industrial gloves and some medical gloves, Ansell Healthcare’s products are predominantly made of natural and synthetic latex and, accordingly, share common manufacturing processes and polymer dipping technology. Ansell Healthcare believes that the expertise it has developed in proprietary latex process and engineering technology enables it to produce high quality natural and synthetic latex gloves and condoms at low cost and that it has a flexible supply and logistics infrastructure that allows it to switch production between various products to take advantage of changes in market demand.

 

The Operations and Supply Chain group support product flows to the markets through 15 global production facilities located in Asia, North America and the UK. Almost 80% of the product sourced is manufactured at these facilities with the balance outsourced under strict quality and performance specifications.

 

11


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

4B BUSINESS OVERVIEW (continued)

 

ANSELL HEALTHCARE (continued)

 

Each on Ansell’s products faces competition from a variety of sources, including international and local producers. Major international competitors include SSL International PLC, the world leader in condoms; Regent, which produces medical surgical gloves; Allegiance (a Division of Cardinal Healthcare), which manufacturers and distributes medical examination and surgical gloves; MAPA, (a subsidiary of the French TOTAL group) which produces household and light industrial gloves and condoms; Kimberley Clark Corporation, a U.S. company that manufacturers and markets disposable latex and synthetic glove products; Sempermed (a Division of Austria’s Semperit), which produces disposable medical gloves; and Church & Dwight, which is a major producer of condoms in the United States.

 

Ansell Healthcare’s operations are not impacted by seasonal factors.

 

Discontinued Operations

 

Since the mid 1990’s the Company has pursued a policy of divesting major businesses to enable greater focus on the Ansell Healthcare operations. The divestments were largely completed by the end of fiscal 2002 with principally only the investment in the South Pacific Tyres (SPT) business remaining within discontinued operations (refer Item 4A). SPT is not treated as discontinued for US GAAP reporting.

 

The following table sets forth certain information with respect to these discontinued operations for the periods and dates indicated.

 

     For Years Ended 30 June

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Sales

   —      —      809

Operating Profit

   —      —      61

Gross Assets (1)

   210    223    253

Employees

   —      —      —  

 

(1) Gross assets exclude cash, goodwill and brand names.

 

The major business groups divested during the last three years are as follows:

 

Pacific Brands

 

The Pacific Brands business was sold in November 2001 for $730 million to an investor consortium led by CVC Asia Pacific and co-led by Catalyst Investment Managers Pty Ltd.

 

Pacific Brands was a large Australian consumer goods business marketing many brands that are household names and was organised into four key operating groups: Clothing, Household Products, Footwear and Sport, Leisure and Workwear.

 

Pacific Automotive

 

The Company sold its Australian and New Zealand automotive parts business effective 31 August 2001 for $251.5 million to a company owned and funded by GS Private Equity, Gresham Private Equity and Macquarie Direct Investment.

 

Pacific Automotive traded under the trade names of Repco Auto Parts, CarParts, Autopro, Motospecs, Ashdown and Appco and was a supplier of general autoparts selling to the trade, service stations and reseller markets.

 

12


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

4B BUSINESS OVERVIEW (continued)

 

RAW MATERIALS

 

Raw materials are a significant manufacturing cost for many of Ansell Healthcare’s products, the most significant being latex. Latex prices can be volatile and are dependent upon world supply and demand and currency movements.

 

Ansell Limited attempts to obtain raw materials from the most economical and reliable sources wherever situated, with regard to world supply, prices and commodity markets. The Company has multiple suppliers for its major raw materials to minimise the risks associated with sole suppliers. No material shortages are anticipated in any of Ansell Healthcare’s operations. The Company attempts to pass on to its customers raw material price fluctuations. Careful monitoring and management of raw material costs is carried on throughout Ansell Healthcare’s business segments.

 

REGULATION AND ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS

 

Government Regulation

 

The products Ansell manufactures are subject to regulations of varying degrees in each of the countries in which the Company markets its products. These regulations have been particularly advanced in the United States by the Safe Medical Devices Act of 1990 and in Europe, with the completion of the work required by the Single European Act of 1986 and its on-going implementation. In addition, harmonisation of regulatory requirements and reciprocity of testing procedures and data, on an international basis, has led to the adoption of an international quality management system standard, which is being implemented progressively by various regulatory authorities including the FDA and the Commission of the European Union.

 

Changes in existing requirements or adoption of new requirements could adversely affect Ansell Healthcare’s ability to comply with regulatory requirements. Failure to comply with regulatory requirements could have a material adverse effect on the business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

United States

 

In the United States, products offered through Ansell’s Professional Healthcare and Personal Healthcare segments are regulated as medical devices under the Federal Food, Drug and Cosmetic Act (the FDC Act) by the FDA. We believe that all of the Company’s products regulated by the FDC Act are in compliance in all material respects with the relevant sections of the FDC Act and the advice and guidance provided by the FDA. Medical device manufacturers are subject to periodic inspections and audits by the FDA for compliance with the FDA’s current Quality System Regulation, which specifies good manufacturing practices (known as QSR/GMP requirements) for medical devices. The FDA has a number of compliance and enforcement procedures when deviations from QSR/GMP requirements are observed during such inspections. Which procedures are used depends upon the seriousness of the observations as well as the compliance history of the facility inspected and the company owning it.

 

13


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

4B BUSINESS OVERVIEW (continued)

 

REGULATION AND ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS (continued)

 

As a general matter, the FDA often seeks to resolve observed QSR/GMP deficiencies on a voluntary basis without resorting to formal administrative enforcement action. In many cases, the FDA and the affected company enter into an agreement whereby the company retains one or more recognised, expert consultants to assist the company in achieving substantial compliance with the relevant QSR/GMP requirements and to certify that such efforts have been successful. When observed QSR/GMP deficiencies cannot be resolved through voluntary action and in a timely manner, the FDA has the option of initiating further enforcement action, including warning letters, import alerts, product bans, field corrections, seizures, recalls, injunctions, civil penalties, fines based on the equitable remedy of disgorgement, adverse publicity issued by the FDA and criminal prosecutions.

 

Each manufacturing operation of Ansell Healthcare has a Quality Assurance/Quality Control (QA/QC) department with its own budget. Also, we operate in a total quality environment where all participants in the manufacturing process are responsible for quality. It is the responsibility of the QA/QC department along with manufacturing to maintain the quality systems and records.

 

The FDA has periodically inspected most of Ansell Healthcare’s condom and medical glove manufacturing facilities, including Ansell Healthcare’s overseas manufacturing facilities and has made observations on how manufacturing operations could be improved. In upgrading manufacturing facilities to address the FDA’s observations and evolving technology and to otherwise comply with QSR/GMP requirements, we have and will continue to expend time, monies and efforts in the areas of product and quality control.

 

The FDA currently requires manufacturers intending to market a new medical examination glove, surgical glove or condom or to modify significantly a previously cleared medical examination glove, surgical glove or condom or the labelling of one of these products to obtain prior clearance. Although we typically have not experienced delays in obtaining clearance for new medical examination glove, surgical glove or condom products, there can be no assurance that we will not experience such delays for future products. An adverse determination by the FDA or a request for additional data or information could have the effect of delaying or precluding clearance and, at the same time, could materially delay or block the commencement of marketing new medical examination glove, surgical glove or condom products.

 

The FDA examines medical examination gloves, surgical gloves and condoms that are imported into the United States by randomly testing some but not all shipments for defects. If a shipment of any of these products is found to be defective, the manufacturing facility that produced the defective product will be subject to a Level 1 import alert. Under Level 1, no further shipments will be cleared for import unless tested and shown not to be defective.

 

A facility will be removed from Level 1 if five consecutive shipments are tested and shown not to be defective. The facility can then import shipments without prior testing but subject to possible FDA testing on a random basis. If a second shipment is found to be defective during testing while on Level 1 or in random FDA testing during the 24 months after removal from Level 1, the manufacturing facility will be placed on Level 2 import alert. On Level 2, no further shipments will be cleared for import unless tested and shown not to be defective.

 

A facility will be removed from Level 2 if ten consecutive shipments are tested and shown not to be defective. The facility can then import shipments without prior testing but subject to possible FDA testing on a random basis. If a second shipment is found to be defective during testing while on Level 2 or in random FDA testing during the 24 months after removal from Level 2, the manufacturing facility may be placed on Level 3 import alert. A facility on Level 3 cannot import further shipments even if they have been tested and shown not to be defective.

 

14


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

4B BUSINESS OVERVIEW (continued)

 

REGULATION AND ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS (continued)

 

United States (continued)

 

A facility can be removed from Level 3 only by showing the FDA that the facility complies with QSR/GMP requirements based on an acceptable FDA inspection or a certification by the facility based on an independent audit by a qualified third party. After this, the facility will be placed on Level 1 detention and must seek removal from that status as described above.

 

Ansell’s condom manufacturing facilities in Bangalore, India and Surat Thani, Thailand were placed on Level 2 detention in March 2003. The import alerts remained in effect for approximately 1 month and were lifted in April 2003. Ansell’s glove manufacturing facility in Shah Alam, Malaysia was placed on Level 1 detention in October 2002. The import alert remained in effect for 3 months and was lifted on January 6, 2003. See also Item 5A “Operating Results”.

 

Labelling and promotional material for medical examination gloves, surgical gloves, and condoms are regulated by the FDA under the FDC Act and violations are subject to enforcement action as described above. Advertising for medical examination gloves, surgical gloves, and condoms is regulated by the Federal Trade Commission (FTC) under the Federal Trade Commission Act and violations are subject to enforcement action by the FTC including orders prohibiting objectionable claims, civil monetary penalties, monetary consumer redress, and orders requiring corrective advertising. We believe that the labelling and advertising of all Ansell products complies in all material respects with FDA and FTC requirements.

 

Europe

 

Condoms and medical gloves are regulated by Directive 93/42/EEC of the European Commission on medical devices that came into effect on 1 January 1995 and became a mandatory requirement for sales in Europe in June 1998. This directive regulates the sale of all medical devices throughout the European Union and the European Economic Area (which comprises the fifteen states of the European Union plus Iceland, Norway and Liechtenstein). Ansell Healthcare’s condoms and medical gloves are in compliance with the requirements of this directive and all relevant standards (including rules for the affixing and use of CE conformity marking set forth by Directive 93/465/EEC of the European Commission) allowing these products to carry the CE mark and to be sold in all European countries except, with respect to condoms, France, without further approval. Pursuant to Article 8 of Directive 93/42/EEC, France requires testing of condoms in addition to the requirement necessary to obtain a CE mark.

 

Occupational gloves are governed under the directive for personal protective equipment, Directive 89/686/EEC. Ansell Healthcare’s occupational gloves are in compliance with the requirements of this directive and all relevant standards (including rules for the affixing and use of CE conformity marking set forth by Directive 93/465/EEC of the European Commission) allowing these products to carry the CE mark and to be sold in all European countries without further approval.

 

Ansell Healthcare is also required to comply with regulations governing packaging waste, including Directive 94/62/EEC, which requires that certain percentages of waste material must be reused or recycled in every European Union country. The required percentage will increase over the next few years. Ansell Healthcare must also show compliance with Directive 46/95/EEC, which regulates the privacy of personal data on customers and individuals submitting complaints.

 

15


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

4B Business Overview (continued)

 

REGULATION AND ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS (continued)

 

Other Government Regulation

 

Whether or not FDA clearance is obtained for a new product, approval or clearance of a product by regulatory authorities in foreign countries may be required prior to the commencement of sales of the product in such countries. The requirements governing product approvals or clearances vary widely from country to country, and the time required for approval may be longer or shorter than that required for FDA approval. There are also several local country quality marks that, although not required, are essential to sales in various countries.

 

Additionally, Ansell Healthcare operates plants in the United Kingdom, Malaysia, Sri Lanka, Thailand, Mexico and India. The occupational, health and safety laws and regulations vary dramatically within these countries. Ansell Healthcare’s policy is to operate a more stringent Ansell-wide approach to occupational health and safety regardless of these prescribed regulations and to ensure that an internationally acceptable work environment is provided for employees. We coordinate an international occupational health and safety program through Ansell Healthcare’s Global Safety, Health and Environment Director. All plants are required to report on all occupational health and safety issues on a monthly basis to senior management.

 

Details of other regulatory and environmental matters are referred to in Note 36 to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained within Item 18.

 

4C ORGANISATIONAL STRUCTURE

 

Note 37 to the Financial Statements included in Item 18 contains a listing of the Company’s subsidiaries, their countries of incorporation and the Company’s proportion of ownership interest in each.

 

4D PROPERTY, PLANTS AND EQUIPMENT

 

Set out below is a breakdown by geographic location of the Company’s manufacturing facilities (with distribution facilities attached to manufacturing facilities not counted separately), as at 30 June 2004.

 

Geographic Region


  

Products Produced


   No. of Manufacturing
Facilities


United States

   Industrial gloves    3

Malaysia

   Household, surgical and examination gloves    3

United Kingdom

   Industrial gloves    1

Thailand

   Household, surgical and examination gloves and condoms    2

Mexico

   Industrial gloves    2

Sri Lanka

   Industrial and surgical gloves    1

India

   Surgical gloves and condoms    3
         

Total

        15
         

 

The Company’s material leased properties are as set forth below:

 

Country


  

City


   Floor Space (Sq ft)

  

Use


Premises/Property:

              

Australia

   Richmond    29,750    Corporate

England

   Tamworth    26,000    Manufacturing, Warehousing

England

   Surbiton    9,000    Marketing

England

   Newark    12,000    Marketing

Germany

   Munich    7,000    Marketing

France

   Paris    27,000    Marketing

Belgium

   Brussels    22,000    Marketing

Belgium

   Aalst    56,000    Warehousing

USA

   Red Bank    45,877    Marketing, Corporate

USA

   Dothan    82,000    Manufacturing, Warehousing

Mexico

   Juarez    219,000    Manufacturing

Property Only:

              

Sri Lanka

   Colombo    1,080,000    Manufacturing

 

16


PART I

 

Item 4 : Information on the Company

 

4D PROPERTY, PLANTS AND EQUIPMENT (continued)

 

 

The Company believes that its facilities are suitable and adequate for its present needs and are in good operating condition. Ansell Limited has in place insurance covering casualty and certain other risks to which its worldwide facilities and operations may be subject. Generally, the current insurance policies do not cover political risks.

 

Pursuant to Company policy, the Company’s principal capital intensive and strategic manufacturing and distribution facilities are owned. Those facilities that are not owned are generally leased by the Company for periods varying from 1 to 10 years, and comprise certain warehouse/distribution centres and sales and administration office accommodation. The Company does not believe its business is dependent on any single facility.

 

No major encumbrances on material tangible fixed assets or environmental issues exist that may affect the Company’s utilisation of the assets.

 

17


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5A OPERATING RESULTS

 

The following discussion and analysis is based upon or derived from the Consolidated Financial Statements included in this Annual Report, which are prepared in accordance with Australian GAAP.

 

Notes 39 and 40 to the Consolidated Financial Statements contain a discussion of the major differences between Australian GAAP and U.S. GAAP and reconciliation to U.S. GAAP.

 

The following tables set forth the contributions of each business group to sales revenue and operating profit of the Company for the fiscal years ended 30 June 2002, 2003 and 2004:

 

OPERATING REVENUE BY BUSINESS GROUP (1)

(EXCLUDING UNALLOCATED & NON RECURRING ITEMS (2))

 

     For Years Ended 30 June

$ In millions


   2004

   % change

    2003

   % change

    2002

Occupational Healthcare

   545    (12.8 %)   625    (2.3 %)   640

Professional Healthcare

   382    (15.7 %)   453    (17.2 %)   547

Consumer Healthcare

   186    (13.9 %)   216    (4.8 %)   227
    
  

 
  

 

Total Healthcare

   1,113    (14.0 %)   1,294    (8.5 %)   1,414

Discontinued Businesses

   —      —       —      —       809
    
  

 
  

 

Total Operating Revenue

   1,113    (14.0 %)   1,294    (41.8 %)   2,223
    
  

 
  

 

 

(1) The sales figures in this table exclude intergroup sales. There were no significant intergroup sales during any of these three fiscal years.

 

(2) Refer to Industry Segments in Item 18 Financial Statements for details of Non Recurring Items.

 

OPERATING PROFIT BEFORE TAX (1)

 

     For Years Ended 30 June

 

$ in millions


   2004

    % change

    2003

    % change

    2002

 

Occupational Healthcare

   74     17.5 %   63     70.3 %   37  

Professional Healthcare

   41     (24.1 %)   54     (41.9 %)   93  

Consumer Healthcare

   32     (25.6 %)   43     30.3 %   33  

Unallocated Items and Eliminations

   (35 )         (48 )         (57 )

Non Recurring/Discontinued Businesses

   (2 )         (6 )         (108 )

Net Interest, including borrowing costs

   (17 )         (27 )         (55 )
    

 

 

       

Total Operating Profit Before Tax

   93     17.7 %   79           (57 )
    

 

 

       

 

(1) The operating profit figures in this table exclude unrealised operating profit on inventory which has been purchased by one business group from another.

 

SALES REVENUE BY GEOGRAPHIC MARKET

 

The following table sets forth the Company’s sales revenue from continuing businesses by geographic market for the fiscal years ended 30 June 2002, 2003 and 2004. The revenue has been classified by location of the customer and excludes intergroup sales.

 

     For Years Ended 30 June

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Australia, New Zealand and Southeast Asia

   168    174    170

North, Central and South America

   545    656    800

Europe

   400    464    444
    
  
  

Total

   1,113    1,294    1,414
    
  
  

 

18


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5A OPERATING RESULTS (continued)

 

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

Consolidated

 

Ansell Limited recorded a profit after tax to shareholders of $70.7 million for the year ended 30 June 2004, which was 42% higher than the profit of $49.9 million in the previous year due to improved margins and lower expenses, net interest and taxation.

 

Operating Revenue

 

Total revenue in 2003/2004 of $1,131.1 million included other revenue of $5.3 million, which related to proceeds from the sale of non-current assets. Total revenue in 2002/2003 was $1,320.1 million compared with $3,190.4 million in 2001/2002 which included $939.7 million of proceeds from the sale of businesses.

 

Sales revenue in 2003/2004 from Healthcare businesses (Occupational, Professional and Consumer) was $1,113.3 million, compared with $1,293.6 million in 2002/2003 and $1,414.2 million in 2001/2002. The decrease in sales revenue over the last two years was largely due to the strengthening of the Australian dollar against the US dollar.

 

Operating Profit from Ordinary Activities before Income Tax Expense

 

Ansell Limited recorded an Operating Profit of $93.3 million for 2003/2004, compared to a profit of $79.3 million for 2002/2003 and a loss of $57.2 million in 2001/2002.

 

A review of the carrying value of all assets in 2002/2003 resulted in the write-down in the value of the Company’s non-core investment in Ambri Limited. A non-recurring, non-cash write-off of $6.1 million was incurred to bring the book value of Ansell Limited’s investment into line with the market price of the shares.

 

The 2001/2002 result was impacted by a $99.9 million write-down of all amounts owing by and shares held in Exide Technologies of the USA, as a result of this company filing for bankruptcy protection under Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. In addition, the manufacturing facility at Troy, Alabama in the USA was written-down by $63.1 million, following its announced closure. The 2001/2002 result also included a net gain of $25.7 million on the divestiture of businesses.

 

Income Tax Expense

 

Income tax expense for the year was $20.7 million, compared to the previous year’s $26.8 million and $55.8 million for 2001/2002. In the 2004 fiscal year the Company continued to benefit from the utilisation of unbooked US tax losses.

 

The 2001/2002 tax expense included the write off of tax balances attributable to the Australian operations of $15.2 million.

 

19


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5A OPERATING RESULTS (continued)

 

ANSELL HEALTHCARE

 

YEAR ENDED JUNE 2004 V JUNE 2003

 

Ansell Healthcare’s sales of $1,113.3 million were 13.9% lower than the previous year, while operating profit of $146.3 million was 8.3% lower. Sales and operating profit were both materially impacted by currency movements, compared to the prior period.

 

Occupational Healthcare

 

Sales of $545.2 million were lower than the previous year by 12.9% while operating profit of $74.2 million was higher by 18.0%. Operating profit margin increased from 10.1% to 13.6%.

 

This segment accounted for approximately 49% of Ansell Healthcare’s total revenues and 51% of operating profit.

 

The expanding Hyflex® family of products continued to drive sales with substantial year on year growth. Sales of traditional knitted gloves were stronger in the second half of the year as increased production improved product availability. The knitting plant in North Carolina, USA was closed and the Mexico knitting plants’ results improved significantly due to this consolidation and improved production process.

 

Benefits are beginning to flow from our growing and innovative proprietary selling programs – Safety Net in Europe and Ansell Value Proposition in North America.

 

Professional Healthcare

 

Sales of $381.8 million were lower than the prior period by 15.6% while operating profit of $40.5 million was lower by 24.9%. Operating profit margin decreased from 11.9% to 10.6%.

 

This segment accounted for approximately 34% of Ansell Healthcare’s revenue and 27% of operating profit.

 

In the USA, recovery in the surgical business was slower then expected as we continued to concentrate on our market share recovery program assisted by product improvements. Profitability in Europe and Australia was impacted by currency-associated price reductions and worldwide by examination glove competitive price pressures and latex cost increases. Surgical glove sales in Europe were lower in the first half following a strategic decision to reduce our reliance on private label customers in favour of sales of Ansell branded product. We did however gain market share in surgical gloves in France. Sales of examination gloves in Europe improved in the second half of the year as prices were adjusted to meet the competitive environment created by a stronger Euro.

 

Consumer Healthcare

 

Sales of $186.3 million were lower than the prior period by 13.8%, while operating profit of $31.6 million was lower by 26.2%. Operating profit margin decreased from 19.8% to 17.0%.

 

This segment accounted for approximately 17% of Ansell Healthcare’s revenues and 22% of operating profit.

 

Condom volumes increased by 7% year on year primarily due to bid contracts in both Brazil and India. Retail condom results were essentially flat in all regions, where new retail entrants and heightened competition in several markets, particularly the UK, adversely impacted sales growth and caused additional selling and advertising expenditure. We remained in partnership with Freudenburg Household Products, our global distributor of Household gloves. However Household glove sales in the second half of the year were below the same period in the prior year primarily due to reductions and clearances of older technology products in anticipation of deliveries in the coming year of the new Foamlined gloves.

 

20


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5A OPERATING RESULTS (continued)

 

YEAR ENDED JUNE 2003 V JUNE 2002

 

Ansell Healthcare’s sales of $1,293.6 million were 8.5% lower than the previous year, while operating profit of $159.6 million was 1.7% lower. Both sales and operating profit were materially impacted by currency movements compared to the prior period.

 

Occupational Healthcare

 

Sales of $624.9 million were lower than the previous year by 2.4% while operating profit of $62.9 million was higher by 70%. Operating profit margin increased from 5.8% to 10.1%.

 

This segment accounted for approximately 48% of Ansell Healthcare’s total revenues and 39% of operating profit.

 

The premium HyFlex® family of lightweight, ergonomic gloves continued to show robust growth during fiscal year 2003. The Occupational Value Proposition (OVP) program targets major industrial glove users, and is designed to leverage Ansell’s expertise in hand injury prevention to offer an innovative program addressing the total cost of worker hand protection and productivity improvement.

 

During the period, the restructuring of Occupational Healthcare’s manufacturing operations started to produce improved operating profits from reduced manufacturing costs. The Troy plant was closed during fiscal year 2003.

 

Despite the sluggish global economy, Occupational Healthcare delivered positive volume, market share and profit growth.

 

Professional Healthcare

 

Sales of $452.6 million were lower than the prior period by 17.2% while operating profit of $53.9 million was lower by 41.9%. Operating profit margin decreased from 17% to 11.9%.

 

It accounts for approximately 35% of Ansell Healthcare’s revenue and 34% of operating profit.

 

During fiscal year 2003, outstanding performances in Asia Pacific and Europe were offset by first half surgeons’ gloves supply interruption in the USA and examination glove price reductions. Operating expenses were higher in the second half due to non-recurring airfreight costs in resupplying the surgeons’ gloves market and higher latex raw material costs. Surgeons’ gloves supply improved markedly in the second half, and distributor inventories returned to normal levels.

 

Concern about latex sensitivity among healthcare workers, increased awareness of hand hygiene and better infection control continue to drive growth, especially in the powder-free and synthetic segments of the market. In Germany, France, the UK, the Nordic region and Australia, Ansell saw very high conversion rates to powder-free gloves.

 

The emergence of the SARS epidemic and global awareness of the virus in fiscal year 2003 helped drive some Asian markets to disposable (single-use) products. SARS also focused the worldwide healthcare industry on the importance of better infection control procedures and the role of high-quality gloves as barriers against infection.

 

The examination glove market also continued to convert to powder-free and synthetic gloves. Due to the lower barriers of entry into this market, there has been an increased supply of lower-cost gloves and difficulty in differentiating our premium products, resulting in a deterioration of pricing. However, substantial cost increases in natural rubber latex raw material forced some producers of low-end examination gloves to increase their selling prices, leading to a period of more stable prices in the premium segment through the second half of the year.

 

21


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5A OPERATING RESULTS (continued)

 

Consumer Healthcare

 

Sales of $216.1 million were lower than the prior period by 4.8%, while operating profit of $42.8 million was higher by 30.3%. Operating profit margin increased from 14.4% to 19.8%.

 

Consumer Healthcare is approximately 17% of Ansell Healthcare’s revenues and 27% of operating profit. Consumer Healthcare ranks in the global top 3 in the condom segment, covering both retail and public sectors.

 

The European Region saw gains in market share in the UK and France, based significantly on the new “Xtra Pleasure“ condom. This success was replicated in the Asia Pacific Region, with strong improvement in New Zealand, Malaysia and Thailand. In the Americas Region, USA total branded retail condom market share held steady, while the important Public Sector segment remained strong.

 

DISCONTINUED BUSINESSES

 

YEAR ENDED JUNE 2004 V JUNE 2003

 

The business disposed of during 2001/2002 did not trade during the year.

 

YEAR ENDED JUNE 2003 V JUNE 2002

 

The business disposed of during 2001/2002 did not trade during the year.

 

22


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5B LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

 

The Company operates internationally and in many different economic climates but inflation has not had a material effect on the Company’s results of operations. The Company does not have material subsidiaries in any economies that have been subject to hyperinflation.

 

The Company operates a Central Treasury from its office in Melbourne, Australia. The Treasury manages Ansell’s external debt, invests excess cash held centrally and acts to hedge all foreign exchange exposures worldwide. The Company has small bank borrowings outside Australia and cash is generated in operating subsidiaries around the world in a number of currencies. Where possible excess funds are accumulated at the Central Treasury.

 

Cash and deposits at 30 June 2004 were $318.1 million, compared with $299.8 million at 30 June 2003 and $276.9 million at 30 June 2002. Cash and deposits at 30 June 2004 included restricted deposits of $10.3 million ($13.8 million at 30 June 2003 and $18.4 million at 30 June 2002) which have been set aside to cover the provisions established to address any remaining liability of members of the Group to claims arising with respect to the Accufix Pacing Lead.

 

The Company believes its working capital is sufficient for the Company’s present requirements.

 

Net cash from operating activities

 

Net cash provided by operating activities for 2003/2004 was $179.2 million compared to $161.6 million in 2002/2003 and $113.1 million in 2001/2002. This included $7.1 million of non-recurring payments compared to $26.8 million in the previous year and $82.7 million in 2001/2002. In 2002/2003 payments in respect of Ansell Healthcare’s restructuring program of $15.1 million were a major component of these non-recurring payments.

 

Payments in respect of the Accufix Pacing Leads litigation and settlement totalled $3.1 million compared with $2.7 million in 2002/2003 and $10.7 million in 2001/2002. Payments under operating leases for the year totalled $20.0 million compared with $24.1 million in 2002/2003 and $37.5 million in 2001/2002. The Group anticipates payments of $11.8 million over the next fiscal year to 30 June 2005 in respect of current operating lease commitments, with a further $30.1 million payable during the period 1 July 2005 to 30 June 2009 and $14.4 million in subsequent years.

 

Net cash used in investing activities

 

Net cash used in investing activities was $6.4 million compared to $4.0 million provided by investing activities in 2002/2003 and $874.5 million provided by investing activities in 2001/2002. The 2001/2002 fiscal year included $936.4 million of proceeds from the sale of the Pacific Automotive and Pacific Brands businesses.

 

23


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5B LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES (continued)

 

Capital expenditure for the year was $13.8 million, compared to $15.4 million in 2002/2003 and $34.3 million in 2001/2002. There are no material commitments for capital expenditure at 30 June 2004. The following table presents a summary of capital expenditure by Business Segment for the past three years:

 

     For Years Ended 30 June

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Occupational Healthcare

   6    3    7

Professional Healthcare

   5    9    13

Consumer Healthcare

   3    3    2

Discontinued Businesses

   —      —      12

Corporate Services

   —      —      —  
    
  
  

Total

   14    15    34
    
  
  

 

Net cash used in financing activities

 

Net cash used in financing activities was $153.4 million, compared with $117.8 million in 2002/2003 and $1,041.1 million in 2001/2002. The strong cash flows of the Company enabled repayment of borrowings totalling $36.6 million during the year following repayments of $79.1 million and $936.9 million in the previous two years and an on market buy back of over 11 million shares for $65.4 million in 2003/2004 and $8.2 million in 2002/2003. A further off market buy back of up to $155 million has been approved for 2004/2005.

 

Net debt (i.e. borrowings including bills payable less cash) again reduced during the year falling from $186.4 million in 2002/2003 to $119.3 million at the end of 2003/2004. This reduction further improved balance sheet ratios for the Group with Net Debt to Equity falling from 22.0% to 14.7% and Net Liabilities to Equity decreasing from 53.1% to 46.3%.

 

The Company’s long–term debt has been rated by the U.S. credit rating agencies Standard & Poor’s Rating Group and Moody’s Investors Service Inc. since 1988-89. The Company’s current ratings are as follows:

 

     Long Term

   Outlook

   Short Term

Moody’s

   Ba1    Stable    Not Prime

Standard & Poor’s

   BB+    Stable    B

 

The current ratings from both rating organisations were updated during the year.

 

The Company’s borrowing portfolio at 30 June 2004 had an average maturity of 816 days (previous year 699 days), and was approximately 77% fixed and 23% floating. The average cost of debt for the year was 6.15%, down from the previous year’s 6.44%.

 

Net interest expense and borrowing costs for the year was $16.8 million compared to the previous year’s $26.5 million and $54.7 million in 2001/2002. The reduced costs resulted from the continued reduction in net debt, a lower cost of funds as older high-cost borrowings matured and were repaid or replaced by new lower-cost borrowings and a better return on cash.

 

On 30 April 2004, the Company entered into a new Revolving Credit Facility comprising a US$200 million facility for 5 years and a US$50 million facility for 364 days. It is envisaged that the 5 year facility will be used to repay maturing Medium Term Notes while the short-term facility will remain available as required. The new facility will result in a reduction in future borrowing costs. There are a number of financial covenants attaching to this new facility including restrictions on the level of borrowings of non guarantor subsidiaries, ensuring the assets of the guarantor subsidiaries are in excess of a specified percentage of total group assets and ensuring certain financial ratios are maintained. The interest rate for this facility is determined based on market rates at the time amounts are drawn down.

 

Currency Restrictions

 

The Company operates in a number of countries such as China, India, Sri Lanka and Malaysia where Central Banks in those countries have imposed currency restrictions and Malaysia has pegged its currency rate to the US dollar. These restrictions do not affect the daily operations of the relevant subsidiaries and to date have not restricted the flow of capital, interest or dividends. The Company anticipates that these restrictions will not have a material adverse affect on its operations.

 

24


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5C RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT

 

Ansell Healthcare spends about approximately 1.3% of sales on research and development. Product and process innovation is essential to continuing profitable growth, and approximately 10% of total sales currently come from products developed in the previous three years. Note 4 to the Financial Statements included in Items 17 and 18 contains more detailed information concerning the Company’s research and development expenditures.

 

The Company’s commitment to innovation and new product development was further enhanced with the establishment of Ansell Healthcare’s Science and Technology Centre in Shah Alam, outside Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia. Eleven members of the total 70-member technical staff hold PhDs, while another 16 hold masters degrees in the fields of chemistry, chemical engineering, materials and fiber technologies. Ansell also has a smaller fibre-technology centre in Seneca, South Carolina. Starting in April 2004, Ansell established small application engineering groups in four (4) of its plants to focus on technology transfer as it applies to new product & process development. These satellite centers are located in Surat Thani, Thailand; Redditch, UK; and Bermudez and Salvarcar in Mexico.

 

While Science and Technology was heavily involved in advancing process-related technologies for improved quality and cost-savings, the group also delivered a range of new products to the market during the past year. New products that generate, or will likely generate, significant sales are coated microthin surgical gloves, condoms with desensitizing and warming lubricants, foam-lined household gloves, a glove that magnetically detects metal particles for use in food processing, as well as a new ultrahigh cut resistant HyFlex® CR variant.

 

We maintain relationships with several medical and materials research institutions, such as the University of Sydney (Australia), Drexel University, Johns Hopkins University (USA) and Clemson University. Ansell also supports ongoing research at the University of Tampere in Finland and the Medical College of Wisconsin, USA. Ansell Healthcare’s sponsored research includes the identification and isolation of natural rubber latex proteins, linked to latex allergies in some people, as well as more accurate testing methods. We use the results of this research to improve the product quality and we encourage the researchers to publish their findings in the scientific journals as part of the AnsellCares® program.

 

The AnsellCares® Scientific Advisory Board, established in 1992, is composed of some of the leading latex allergy researchers worldwide. The Advisory Board’s charter is to direct research into critical hand barrier protection issues, such as latex and chemical allergy, factors affecting glove barrier integrity and the development of synthetic glove polymers. Research groups on three continents are responsible for numerous scientific breakthroughs, and have presented their work at many national and international allergy conferences. The output from Ansell Healthcare’s Advisory Board has paved the way for a greater understanding of these complex issues and, through publication and dissemination, has allowed us to reduce the allergen content of Ansell Healthcare’s products. It has also provided clinicians with guidelines on how to better manage latex-sensitive healthcare workers and patients, and to reduce the risk of sensitisation for future generations. The AnsellCares® program includes accredited continuing medical education programs, video presentations, technical bulletins, newsletters, and periodic lectures and seminars.

 

5D TREND INFORMATION

 

Please refer to Item 4B – Business Overview and Item 5A – Operating Results.

 

5E OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

 

The Company has no off-balance sheet arrangements that have or are reasonably likely to have a current or future effect on the Company’s financial condition, changes in financial condition, revenues or expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.

 

25


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5F CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS

 

     PAYMENTS DUE BY PERIOD IN $ MILLIONS

CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS


   Total

   LESS
THAN 1
YEAR


   1-3 YEARS

   3-5 YEARS

   MORE
THAN 5
YEARS


Long-Term Debt Obligations

   236.0    —      121.3    101.6    13.1

Operating Lease Obligations

   56.3    11.8    17.2    12.9    14.4

Purchase Obligations

   —      —      —      —      —  

Other Long-Term Liabilities

   47.4    —      11.5    8.2    27.7
    
  
  
  
  

Total

   399.7    11.8    150.0    122.7    55.2
    
  
  
  
  

 

5G SAFE HARBOUR

 

Not applicable

 

5H CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

The preparation of the Company’s consolidated financial statements requires our management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported turnover and costs during the reported period. On an ongoing basis, our management evaluates its estimates and judgements in relation to assets, liabilities, contingent liabilities, turnover and costs. Management bases its estimates and judgements on historical experience and on other various factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis of making judgements about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions and conditions.

 

Our management has identified the following critical accounting policies.

 

Long-Lived Assets – Valuation

 

Fixed assets, goodwill and brand names are assessed to ensure carrying values do not exceed estimated recoverable amounts. The carrying value of each long-lived asset is reviewed annually to evaluate whether the carrying amount is recoverable. Assets may be reviewed more regularly if an event or change in circumstances indicates that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. If the asset is determined to be impaired, an impairment loss will be recorded, and the asset written down, based upon the amount by which the asset carrying amount exceeds the higher of net realisable value and value in use. Value in use is generally determined by discounting expected future cash flows using a risk-adjusted discount rate. Future cash flows are estimated based on production and sales plans, commodity prices (considering current and historical prices, price tends and related factors), operating costs, and planned capital costs. These estimates are subject to risk and uncertainty, hence there is a possibility that changes in circumstances will alter these projections, which may impact the recoverability of these assets.

 

Taxation

 

Full provision is made for deferred taxation on all timing differences which have arisen but not reversed at the balance sheet date, except as follows:

 

    tax payable on the future remittance of the past earnings of subsidiaries, associates and joint ventures is provided only to the extent that dividends have been accrued as receivable or a binding agreement to distribute all past earnings exists;

 

    deferred tax is not recognised on the difference between book values and fair values of non-monetary assets arising on acquisitions or purchased fixed assets which have subsequently been revalued unless there is a binding agreement to sell such an asset and the gain or loss expected to arise has been recognised; and

 

    deferred tax assets are recognised only to the extent that it is virtually certain that they will be recovered.

 

26


PART I

 

Item 5 : Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

5H CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued)

 

Provision for Doubtful Accounts

 

The Company maintains a provision for doubtful accounts, as well as provisions for sales rebates and allowances. Significant management judgements and estimates must be made and used in connection with establishing these provisions. Actual results could be different from the Company’s current estimates, possibly resulting in increased future charges to earnings.

 

The Company provides for doubtful accounts for all individual receivables judged to be unlikely for collection. This provision is based on management’s analysis of the age of the receivable balances, historical bad debts write-off experience and general customer creditworthiness.

 

The Company provides for sales rebates and allowances based on existing agreements with customers.

 

Inventory Valuation

 

The Company uses certain estimates and judgements to properly value inventory. In general, the Company’s inventories are recorded at the lower of actual cost, manufactured cost or market value. The Company has an ongoing process of evaluating inventories for obsolescence and excess quantities. Inventories that are considered obsolete are written down to an estimated net sales value where such value is below cost.

 

Rationalisation and Restructuring

 

Provisions for rationalisation and restructuring are only recognised when a detailed plan has been approved and the restructuring has either commenced or been publicly announced or firm contracts related to the restructuring have been entered into. Costs related to ongoing activities are not provided for.

 

Contingencies, Accufix Pacing Lead Related Expenses and Insurance Claims

 

The consolidated entity provides for certain specifically identified or obligated costs when these amounts are reasonably determinable.

 

The Group has no significant long term contractual obligations for the purchase of raw materials. The Group enters into lease arrangements for office and warehouse facilities in the normal course of business with such leases ranging from one to twenty years.

 

27


PART I

 

Item 6 :  Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6A DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT

 

The business of Ansell Limited is managed by a Board of Directors of such number of not fewer than four and not more than eight as the Directors determine. At the date of this report there are six Directors in office, of which Mr D. Tough is Chief Executive Officer and Managing Director. Mr. H. Boon resigned on 30 June 2004 and was replaced as Chief Executive Officer and Managing Director by Mr. D. Tough effective 1 July 2004. There are no family relationships (within the meaning of Item 6 of Form 20-F) between any director or executive officer and any other director or executive officer.

 

As of 30 June 2004 the Directors of Ansell Limited were as follows:

 

Name


   Age

   Position

  

Year of
Initial

Appointment


  

Expiration
of

Current
Term (1)


 

Edward Tweddell

   63    Chairman    2001    2005  

Peter L. Barnes (2)

   61    Director    2001    2004  

L. Dale Crandall

   63    Director    2002    2005 (3)

Herbert J. Elliott

   66    Director    2001    2004  

Michael J. McConnell(4)(5)

   38    Director    2004    2007  

 

(1) Other than the Chief Executive Officer, the directors are subject to re-election at the Annual General Meeting next following their appointment and retirement by rotation every three years. At least one third of the Company’s Directors (those who have served the longest since last being re-elected) retire each year and may offer themselves for re-election by the shareholders.

 

(2) Mr Peter L. Barnes was re-elected by a vote of shareholders at the Annual General Meeting held in October 2004.

 

(3) Mr L. Dale Crandall was appointed a Director in November 2002 and his appointment was confirmed by a vote of shareholders at the Annual General Meeting held in October 2003.

 

(4) Mr. Michael J. McConnell was appointed to the Board on 16 April 2004 having actively served as alternate to Mr. Stanley P. Gold since October 2002. Mr. McConnell’s appointment was confirmed by a vote of shareholders at the Annual General Meeting held in October 2004.

 

(5) Mr. Stanley P. Gold has served as alternate to Mr. Michael J. McConnell since 16 April 2004.

 

As of 30 June 2004 the Executive Officers (1) who were not Directors were:

 

Name


  

Position


   Year of
Initial
Appointment


  

Commenced

employment

with Ansell
Limited


Phil Corke

   Senior Vice President, Human Resources & Communications    1998    1998

Werner Heintz

   Senior Vice President & Regional Director – Europe    2001    1999

Rustom Jilla

   Senior Vice President & Chief Financial Officer    2002    2002

Neil O’Donnell

   Senior Vice President & Regional Director – Asia Pacific    2001    1988

William Reed

   Senior Vice President & Regional Director – Americas    2001    1989

William G Reilly, Jr.

   Senior Vice President & General Counsel    2000    2000

 

(1) Executive Officers serve at the discretion of the Board of Directors.

 

28


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6A DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT (continued)

 

The following is a brief biography of each of the Directors and Executive Officers of Ansell Limited as at 30 June 2004 and as at the date of this report:

 

Edward Tweddell, BSC, MBBS (HONS.), FRACGP, FAICD

 

Chairman and Non-executive Director since October 2001. A Director of Australia Post and CSIRO, he is also Chairman of the Nepenthe Group Pty Ltd.

 

Dr Tweddell’s experience includes 10 years with a multi-national pharmaceutical company primarily involved in medical affairs and drug development, an appointment as President and Chief Executive of a consumer-products healthcare company in Japan, and 8 years as Chief Executive of an Australian-based pharmaceutical company.

 

Resident Adelaide. Age 63

 

Peter L Barnes, B.COM, (HONS.) MBA MELB

 

Appointed Non-executive Director in October 2001. He is Chairman of Samuel Smith & Son Pty Limited and a Director of The News Corporation Limited and Metcash Trading Limited. He is also President of the Winemakers Federation of Australia and a Member of the National Food Industry Council.

 

Mr Barnes has experience in senior roles in finance, marketing and general management in the international arena. His background includes a long career with a leading global consumer marketing organisation in USA, Europe, Asia and Australia.

 

Resident Sydney. Age 61

 

Doug D Tough, MBA, BBA

 

Managing Director and Chief Executive Officer since 1 July 2004.

 

Prior to joining Ansell, Mr. Tough spent 17 years with Cadbury Schweppes plc in a number of international and domestic leadership roles, most recently as President and Chief Executive Officer of its largest division world wide, Dr Pepper/Seven Up, North America.

 

Resident USA. Age 55

 

L. Dale Crandall, MBA UC BERKELEY, CPA

 

Non-executive Director since November 2002. Director of Union Bank of California, Covad Communications Group and BEA Systems, Trustee of Dodge & Cox Mutual Funds.

 

Mr Crandall has a background in accounting and finance and is a former Group Managing Partner for Southern California for Price Waterhouse. He was formerly President and Chief Operating Officer of Kaiser Foundation Health Plan and Hospitals in the United States.

 

Resident USA. Age 63

 

Herbert J Elliott, AC, MBE, MA CANTAB

 

Non-executive Director since February 2001. Chairman of the Telstra Foundation Limited and Director of Fortescue Metals Group Limited and Board member of Athletics Australia.

 

Mr Elliot has experience in marketing and general management, including an appointment as President and Chief Executive of North America for Puma, the sporting goods company.

 

Resident Perth. Age 66

 

Michael J McConnell AB, MBA (HONS) VIRGINIA

 

Managing Director Shamrock Capital Advisors Inc. and Shamrock Holdings Inc. and Chairman of Shamrock’s Investment Committee. He is also a Director of Neo Technology Ventures.

 

Mr. McConnell was appointed to the Board in April 2004 having actively served as Alternate Director to Mr. Stanley Gold since October 2002.

 

Mr McConnell has an investment banking background having served with Kidder Peabody and Merrill Lynch. He received an AB from Harvard University in Economics, and an MBA with honours from The Darden School of The University of Virginia.

 

Resident USA. Age 38

 

29


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6A DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT (Continued)

 

Stanley P Gold, AB, JD (Alternate to Mr. Michael J McConnell since April 2004)

 

Non-executive Director since October 2001. President and Chief Executive Officer of Shamrock Holdings, Inc. and President of Shamrock Capital Advisors Inc.

 

Resident USA. Age 61

 

EXECUTIVE OFFICERS WHO ARE NOT DIRECTORS

 

Phil Corke

 

Senior Vice President Human Resources and Communications

 

Phil Corke has been with Ansell since 1998 when he was appointed Senior Vice President of Human Resources. Prior to joining Ansell, he held senior human resources positions with Alpharma Inc., Textran Inc. and the Bristol-Myers group in the United Kingdom and the United States.

 

Werner Heintz

 

Senior Vice President and Regional Director – Europe

 

Mr Heintz joined Ansell in 1999 as Managing Director Ansell Protective Products Europe, Middle East and Africa. In February 2001 he assumed the position of Regional Director Europe, Middle East and Africa. Prior to joining Ansell, he was the European Marketing Director for Nynas, a leading producer and distributor of bitumen and specialty oils.

 

Rustom Jilla

 

Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

 

Mr Jilla joined Ansell Limited in 2002. Mr Jilla has extensive experience in financial roles with global companies and prior to joining Ansell was Vice President Financial Operations of Perkin Elmer Inc. This followed a successful career with BOC Group Plc from 1988-2000, in the United States and New Zealand, in planning, product management and finance culminating in the role of Vice President Finance, BOC Edwards Americas.

 

Neil O’Donnell

 

Senior Vice President and Regional Director – Asia Pacific.

 

Neil O’Donnell has been with Ansell since 1988 and has held a number of senior marketing roles in Australia and in the Asia Pacific region. He has been the Regional Director for the Asia Pacific region since February 2001, working to build markets throughout Asia, following a period where he ran the domestic Australian marketing operations. Prior to joining Ansell Mr. O’Donnell spent most of his career with Duracell Australia, the last eight years as CEO.

 

William Reed

 

Senior Vice President and Regional Director – Americas

 

Mr Reed has been with Ansell since 1989 following the acquisition of the Edmont Industrial glove business from Becton Dickinson and Co. He has been Senior Vice President and Regional Director of the Americas since February 2001. He was Executive Vice President and Regional Director of the Occupational Healthcare Division for the Americas from 1996 and was previously Americas Regional Director for the Consumer Division. Prior to 1993, he was Regional Director of Europe, based in Brussels.

 

William G. Reilly, Jr.

 

Senior Vice President and General Counsel

 

Mr Reilly has been with Ansell since 2000 when he was appointed Senior Vice President & General Counsel. Prior to joining Ansell, Mr Reilly was Associate General Counsel of C.R. Bard Inc. from 1990 to 2000. Prior to Bard, Mr Reilly held increasingly responsible positions as senior counsel with The Hertz Corporation, McKesson Corporation, Dresser Industries and GAF Corporation.

 

30


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6B COMPENSATION

 

The aggregate amount of remuneration paid or accrued by the Company on a worldwide basis during 2003-2004 as compensation to its Directors and its executive officers named below as a group was $10,543,867.

 

In accordance with the provisions of Australian law, amounts notionally attributed to pension and retirement benefits are deemed to be remuneration and such amounts are included in the total amount set out in the preceding paragraph.

 

The following table sets out the remuneration provided to the Directors and the most highly remunerated officers of the Company and the Group (including those based overseas) for the financial year.

 

NON

EXECUTIVE

DIRECTORS


  

Cash salary
and fees (a)
(b)

A$


  

Cash bonus
(c)

A$


  

Superannuation

Contributions
(d)

A$


  

Notional Value

of Equity

Compensation
(e)

A$


  

Termination
benefits

A$


  

Other (f)

$A


  

Total

A$


E D Tweddell Chairman

   234,375    —      21,094    —      —      —      255,469

P L Barnes

   91,875    —      8,287    —      —      —      100,162

L D Crandall

   82,500    —      7,425    —      —      —      89,925

H J Elliott

   82,500    —      7,425    —      —      —      89,925

M J McConnell (g)

   17,187    —      1,547    —      —      —      18,734

S P Gold(h)

   65,625    —      5,906    —      —      —      71,531
MANAGING DIRECTOR AND OFFICERS(O) OF THE COMPANY AND THE GROUP

H Boon(i)(j)(l) Group Managing

Director and Chief Executive Officer

   966,981    419,545    356,636    537,500    2,204,960    714,893    5,200,515

P Corke (i)(l)

   320,613    149,685    20,123    97,573    —      43,119    631,113

W Heintz(k)(m)

   386,845    190,824    125,926    152,988    —      259,624    1,116,207

R Jilla(i)(l)

   398,978    190,009    29,162    407,732    —      51,223    1,077,104

N O’Donnell

   196,000    61,985    39,004    99,176    —      32,160    428,325

W Reed(i)(l)

   363,401    122,118    19,605    142,945    —      58,032    706,101

W Reilly (i)(l)

   334,866    159,351    19,092    97,572    —      22,139    633,020

D Tough (i)(l)(n)

   124,715    —      —      —      —      1,021    125,736

 

(a) Comprises the cost to the Company of cash salary, non-cash benefits, expatriate assignment costs and associated taxes.

 

(b) Includes fees in connection with Board and Board Committee responsibilities.

 

(c) Performance-based payments pursuant to the Company’s short-term incentive program.

 

(d) For Directors includes notional contributions at the rate that satisfies Australian Superannuation Guarantee requirements. No amounts were required to be paid to the Australian Superannuation fund in respect of the year ended 30 June 2004 upon advice of the Trustee. For US based Executives, includes contributions to US benefit or non-qualified pension plans as applicable and to a European pension plan for Mr Heintz. For Messrs Boon and O’Donnell it also includes an imputed notional contribution to the Australian superannuation fund calculated at an actuarial rate.

 

31


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6B COMPENSATION (continued)

 

(e) In accordance with the requirements of Accounting Standards, remuneration includes a proportion of the fair value of options or Performance Share Rights (PSRs) granted or outstanding during the year pursuant to the Company’s equity-based long term incentive plan. The fair value is determined as at grant date and is progressively allocated over the vesting period for these securities. The amount included as remuneration is not related to nor indicative of the benefit (if any) that individual executives may ultimately realise should the options or PSRs vest. No amount in respect of options or PSRs has been included in the determination of the remuneration of the Chief Executive Officer as the vesting period for these instruments commenced after balance date.

 

The fair value of options or PSRs is calculated at the date of the grant using binomial tree techniques. The fair values and the factors and assumptions used in determining the fair values of the tranches of options and PSRs applicable for the 2004 financial year are as follows:

 

Instrument


   Number
Issued


   Grant Date

   Expiry
Date


   Fair Value
per Option/
PSR


   Exercise
Price


   Share
Price
on
Grant
Date


   Estimated
Volatility


    Risk
Free
Interest
Rate


    Dividend
Yield


 

Options

   1,000,000    12/4/2002    30/6/2006    $2.15    $ 6.32    $ 6.40    30.0 %   6.0 %   0.0 %

Options

   300,000    23/9/2002    23/9/2012    $2.66 -$2.70    $ 6.97    $ 6.88    20.0 %   5.3 %   0.0 %

Options

   525,000    30/6/2004    30/6/2014    $2.35 -$2.38    $ 7.40    $ 7.74    20.0 %   6.1 %   2.0 %

PSRs

   437,500    19/2/2003    30/6/2005    $6.07      N/A    $ 6.07    20.0 %   N/A     0.0 %

PSRs

   515,000    18/12/2003    30/6/2006    $5.89 -$6.12      N/A    $ 6.19    20.0 %   N/A     2.0 %

PSRs

   150,000    30/6/2004    30/6/2007    $6.94 -$7.22      N/A    $ 7.74    20.0 %   N/A     2.0 %

 

Estimated volatility is based on an analysis of historical share price data.

 

(f) Includes cash benefits such as motor vehicle allowances, home office expenses, executive insurance, housing allowances and statutory amounts paid on termination of including accumulated annual leave and long service leave.

 

(g) Mr M J McConnell was appointed as a director on 16 April 2004.

 

(h) Mr S P Gold retired as a director and was appointed alternate director for Mr McConnell on 16 April 2004.

 

(i) US-based Officers.

 

(j) Notional value of Equity Compensation includes the notional value of 500,000 options granted in April 2002. The options, which have an exercise price of $6.32 for each share acquired, vested upon achievement of performance conditions applicable to the 2004 year.

 

(k) European-based Officer.

 

(l) US-based Officers are paid in US$. The average exchange rate for the period, as set out in the Financial Statements, is US$0.7016 = A$1.00.

 

(m) Europe-based Officer paid in €. The average exchange rate for the period is €0.5775 = A$1.00.

 

(n) Mr Tough was appointed as an Executive on 11 May 2004 and Chief Executive Officer and Managing Director on 1 July 2004.

 

(o) The Officers included in this disclosure are those executives having, during the year, the greatest authority for managing the Group. Other personnel who have not had such authority may have received remuneration at a level in excess of that shown for the executives named above.

 

The Company had agreements with each of the Non-executive Directors, which provided for benefits upon termination. These agreements were terminated at 30 June 2003.

 

The Company has operated two share plans for employees and Directors.

 

    the Pacific Dunlop Executive Share Plan (“Executive Plan”); and

 

    the Pacific Dunlop Employee Share Plan (“Employee Plan”).

 

No issue of shares has been made under either Plan since February 1994. The Board determined during 1996 that no further issues of shares would be made under the Executive Plan.

 

32


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6B COMPENSATION (continued)

 

The Executive Plan is no longer available for new share issues. Shares issued under the Executive Plan to selected employees (“Executives”) were paid up to 5 cents and were subject to restrictions for a determined period (for the 1993/94 issue – 8¼ years). While partly paid, the shares are not transferable, carry no voting rights and no entitlement to dividends (but are entitled to participate in bonus or rights issues as if fully paid). The price payable for shares issued under the Executive Plan varies according to the event giving rise to a call being made. Market price at the date of the call is payable if an Executive ceases employment with the Company (other than for death, retrenchment, retirement) prior to expiration of the restriction period. Once restrictions cease, the price payable upon a call being made will be the lesser of $10.00 ($2.50 for issues prior to 13 September 1991) or the last sale price of the Company’s ordinary shares on the Australian Stock Exchange Limited. The aggregate number of Executive Plan Shares on issue could not exceed 5% of the total issued capital of the Company.

 

The number of Executive Plan Shares outstanding at 30 June 2004 was 738,000 and as of 31 October 2004 was 387,000 shares. During the fiscal year, the amounts outstanding on 184,100 existing Executive Plan Shares were fully paid. From the end of the fiscal year through 31 October 2004, the amounts outstanding on an additional 351,000 Executive Plan Shares were fully paid.

 

Under Australian law, the Company is not required to disclose and does not otherwise disclose the number of Executive Plan Shares held by each executive officer individually, unless such executive officer is also a Director. There were no Executive Plan Shares held by Directors of Ansell Limited as of 30 June 2004.

 

In addition to the Executive Plan, the Company maintains an Employee Plan under which 149,763 fully paid Ordinary Shares were held as of 30 June 2004 by employees of the Company and 145,102 shares (including Ordinary Shares issued as bonus shares) were held as of 31 October 2004. The Employee Plan permits full-time and part-time employees, who have completed three or more years continuous service with the Company and who do not participate in the Executive Plan, to acquire 20 ordinary shares in the capital of the Company for each completed year of service. The shares are issued at market value as of the date of issue, payable as to 50 cents per share by the employee, the balance financed by an interest free loan from the Company (provided that no loans will be made in contravention of applicable law, including Section 13(k) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) repayable, at latest, on cessation of employment. The US GAAP compensation cost component of this plan is zero for all years presented.

 

The shares are not transferable while a loan remains outstanding, but carry voting rights and entitlement to dividends (although dividends are applied in reduction of the loan). As of 30 June 2004, no offer to employees was outstanding. The aggregate number of Employee Plan Shares on issue may not exceed 5% of the total issued capital of the Company.

 

Issues of shares under the Employee Plan to date have been in 1986–1987 at $23.60 per share, in 1987–1988 at $20.05 per share, in 1988–1989 at $20.65 per share, in 1990–1991 at $22.10 per share, in 1991–1992 at $21.50 per share and in 1993–1994 at $25.00 per share. Holders of Employee Plan Shares at June 1987, May 1989 and October 1993 became entitled to bonus shares (stock dividends) totalling 1,960,062 shares in respect of bonus issues (stock dividends) declared in June 1987, May 1989 and October 1993.

 

During the 2003-2004 fiscal year, the loan liability of members in respect of 60,916 fully paid ordinary shares was discharged. From the end of the fiscal year through 31 October 2004 the loan liability in respect of an additional 4,661 fully paid shares was discharged. No new shares were issued during 2003-2004 under the Employee Plan.

 

The Company’s accounting policy in respect of the Employee Plan is to recognise the paid-up capital upon allotment and the receivable created by the loan to employees to acquire the shares. In respect of the Executive Plan, no amount is recognised upon issue, apart from the capital paid-up on the shares, as the amount of the call payable is not known at the time of issue. Once a call has been made upon the shares and paid, the Company recognises the increase in paid-up capital. A loss of $4,366 pre tax in respect of the Employee Share Plan was recognised for the year 2003-2004, compared to a loss of $13,288 pre tax for the year 2002-2003 and in 2001-2002 a loss pre tax of $535,381.

 

33


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6B COMPENSATION (continued)

 

The Company adopted the Ansell Limited Stock Incentive Plan (“Stock Incentive Plan”) for the benefit of key employees of the Company. The Stock Incentive Plan provides for equity-based awards in the form of stock options and performance share rights (“PSRs”). The Board administers the Stock Incentive Plan and determines the employees eligible for awards, and the type and amount of awards that will be granted to each eligible employee. The Board can unilaterally amend or terminate the Stock Incentive Plan at any time.

 

In general, grants are made annually, each award being three equal tranches. Each tranche is subject to performance targets set by the Board in respect of each of the three successive years. These rights entitle the holder to an equivalent number of fully-paid ordinary shares upon achievement of the performance targets. The options may be exercised at a price based on the average of the Ansell share price on the five days preceding the grant. PSRs, when vested, are converted to fully-paid ordinary shares at no cost to the executive. Upon vesting participants are permitted to sell shares to cover tax liabilities and up to 50% of the remaining vested tranche. The balance remains restricted for a further 12 months. PSRs that have vested but remain restricted attract dividends.

 

During 2004 525,000 options and 150,000 PSRs were granted to Mr Tough upon his appointment as an executive, pursuant to the Plan. The options, which are subject to performance conditions, have an exercise price of $7.40, are not exercisable until one year after they vest and will lapse if not exercised on or before 30 June 2014. The PSRs convert to shares at no cost to the executive upon satisfaction of performance conditions. Both the options and PSRs were granted in three tranches, and are subject to the achievement of long-term performance targets and stretch targets established by the Board. Targets for financial year 2005 and future years are yet to be finalised and are subject to further Board consideration of the next stage of the Company’s development under the leadership of the new Chief Executive Officer. The vesting period for both the options and PSRs commenced 1 July 2004.

 

The options granted to Mr Boon have now vested. The first tranche of 500,000 options are now exercisable at $6.32 for each share acquired. The second tranche of 500,000 options may be exercised, again at $6.32 for each share acquired, after 30 June 2005. Both tranches of options may only be exercised prior to 30 June 2006.

 

During the 2003 financial year Mr Jilla was granted 300,000 options in three equal tranches of 100,000 options, each with an exercise price of $6.97 and subject to certain performance targets aligned to EBITA of the Ansell Healthcare business and the achievement of certain financial ratios for the 2003-2005 financial years. In respect of the first two tranches the performance targets have been met and these options have vested. The first tranche is exercisable after 30 June 2004, the second after 30 June 2005. These options expire on 23 September 2012.

 

During 2003 437,500 PSRs, exercisable in three equal tranches, were granted to senior Group executives pursuant to the Plan. The performance targets applicable to the first two tranches have been met and those tranches have vested. The third tranche is subject to the achievement of performance targets for the 2005 financial year.

 

During 2004 a further 665,000 PSRs, exercisable in three equal tranches, were granted to executives (including those granted to Mr Tough). The performance targets in respect of the first tranche of PSRs granted in the current year (with the exception of those

 

granted to Mr Tough) have been achieved and these PSRs have vested. The second and third tranches are subject to the achievement of performance targets for the 2005 and 2006 financial years respectively.

 

In relation to the 2005 financial year the performance condition applicable to options and PSR’s issued to executives other than Mr Tough is that the EBITA for the Ansell Healthcare business meets or exceeds US$115 million. Performance targets for periods beyond financial year 2005 are under review pending Board consideration of the next stage of the Company’s development under the leadership of the recently-appointed Chief Executive Officer.

 

34


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6C BOARD PRACTICES

 

The Board works under a set of well established corporate governance policies that reinforce the responsibilities of all Directors in accordance with the requirements of the Australian Corporations Act, the Australian Stock Exchange (ASX), the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and the NASDAQ Stock Market. In addition, many of the governance elements are enshrined in the Company’s Constitution.

 

The Board regularly reviews and updates its corporate governance policies, to ensure that the Company’s policies remain in accordance with best practice. The Board is aware of, and has had regard to developments in Australia and overseas in relation to corporate governance “best practice.”

 

The Board has for some time satisfied the majority of the recommendations of the ASX Corporate Governance Council and has incorporated its provisions in its annual review of corporate governance practices.

 

The corporate governance section of the Company’s website contains various materials relating to corporate governance, including Board charter, Committee charters, Code of Conduct and other information. The link to the corporate governance section of the Ansell website is www.ansell.com.

 

Board Responsibilities

 

The Board has ultimate responsibility to set policy regarding the business and affairs of the Company and its subsidiaries for the benefit of the shareholders and other stakeholders of the Company. The Board is accountable to shareholders for the performance of the Group.

 

The Board has the following responsibilities and functions, namely, to:

 

    review and approve corporate strategies, budgets, plans and policies developed by management and evaluate performance of the Group against those strategies and business plans in order to:

 

    monitor the performance of functions delegated to the executive team including the progress of major capital expenditures, capital management, acquisitions, divestitures and strategic commitments; and

 

    assess the suitability of the Company’s overall strategies, business plans and resource allocation;

 

    appoint a Chief Executive Officer for the ongoing management of the business and its strategies;

 

    regularly evaluate the performance of the Chief Executive Officer and Senior Management and ensure appropriate executive succession planning is conducted;

 

    monitor financial and business results (including the audit process) to understand at all times the financial position of the Group;

 

    ensure regulatory compliance and maintain adequate risk management processes;

 

    report to shareholders; and

 

    implement a culture of compliance with the highest legal and ethical standards and business practices to ensure social accountability.

 

In carrying out its duties, the Board meets formally over one or two days at least six times a year, with additional meetings held as required to address specific issues. Directors also participate in meetings of various Board Committees, which assist the full Board in examining particular areas or issues.

 

It is also the Company’s practice for Directors to visit a number of the Company’s facilities in each year. During the 2004 financial year, Board meetings were held in conjunction with visits to Ansell facilities in Europe and South-east Asia.

 

The Board delegates management of the Company’s resources to the executive team under the leadership of the Chief Executive Officer, to deliver the strategic direction and achieve the goals determined by the Board. Any powers not specifically reserved for the Board have been delegated to the executive team.

 

35


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6C BOARD PRACTICES (continued)

 

Risk Management and Code of Conduct

 

Ansell places high priority on risk identification and management throughout all its operations and has processes in place to review their adequacy. These include:

 

    a comprehensive risk control program that includes property protection and health, safety and environmental audits using underwriters, self-audits, engineering and professional advisers; and

 

    a process to identify and measure business risk.

 

The Company also has in place a system of internal controls for the identification and management of financial risk including a system of internal sign-offs to ensure the Company is in compliance with its legal obligations, including those which arise under the US Sarbanes-Oxley Act. The Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer also provide assurances to the Board as to the integrity of the Company’s risk management and internal compliance and control systems and financial reports.

 

Ansell is committed to upholding the highest legal, moral and ethical standards in all of its corporate activities and has adopted a Code of Conduct, which aims to strengthen its ethical climate and provide basic guidelines for situations in which ethical issues arise.

 

The Code of Conduct applies to Directors, executives, management and employees, sets high standards for ethical behaviour and business practice beyond complying with the law, and is based on the following key principles whereby Ansell:

 

    strives to uphold high ethical standards in all corporate activities;

 

    is committed to competing lawfully, fairly and ethically in the marketplace, consistent with its aim of providing quality products to its customers;

 

    is committed to pursuing sound growth and earnings goals, by operating in the best interests of the Company and shareholders;

 

    strives to treat all employees and applicants with fairness, honesty and respect;

 

    expects all employees to work together for the common good and to avoid placing themselves in a position that is in conflict with the interests of the Company;

 

    is committed to good corporate citizenship and participating actively in and improving the communities in which the Company does business; and

 

    expects all employees to conduct themselves in accordance with the guiding principles.

 

It is the policy of Ansell to comply with the letter and spirit of all applicable laws, including those relating to employment, discrimination, health, safety, medical device, consumer protection, privacy, intellectual property, antitrust, securities and the environment. The Company has also developed procedures to ensure that employees are aware of and discharge their obligations under relevant privacy laws in their handling of information provided to the Group. No Director, officer, executive or manager of Ansell has authority to violate any law or to direct another employee or any other person to violate any law on behalf of the Company.

 

The Company has appointed a Compliance Officer to assist in the administration of the Code of Conduct. As part of its commitment to legal and ethical conduct, the Company expects its employees to report information about actual or suspected violations of the Code of Conduct or of the law.

 

The Code of Conduct also sets out the Company’s policies in respect of ethical issues such as conflicts of interest, social accountability and fair dealing. In addition, the Company has developed specific policies in relation to several matters covered in the Code of Conduct. These policies, along with the Code of Conduct are publicly available on the Company’s website, www.ansell.com.

 

36


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6C BOARD PRACTICES (continued)

 

Risk Management and Code of Conduct (continued)

 

The Company’s ethical practices and procedures are reviewed regularly, and processes are in place to promote and communicate these policies within the Company. Employees and Directors are encouraged to participate in Company sponsored compliance programs presented by or on behalf of the Company to ensure that they remain up to date regarding relevant legal and industry developments. Assistance is also available to clarify whether particular laws apply and how they may be interpreted.

 

Board Composition

 

The Board’s policy is that there should be a majority of independent, Non-executive Directors. This is a requirement embodied in the Company’s Constitution, ensuring that all Board discussions or decisions have the benefit of predominantly outside views and experience, and that the majority of Directors are free from interests and influences that may create a conflict with their duty to the Company. Maintaining a balance of experience and skills is an important factor in Board composition.

 

The requirement under the Constitution is for at least twice as many Non-executive Directors as Executive Directors. As an additional safeguard in preserving independence, an Executive Director cannot hold the office of Chairman.

 

The Board has adopted the definition of independence set out in the IFSA Blue Book (December 2002).1 The Board has developed guidelines to determine materiality thresholds for the purposes of that definition. Broadly speaking, these guidelines seek to determine whether the director is generally free of any interest and any business or other relationship which could, or could reasonably be perceived to, materially interfere with the director’s ability to act in the best interests of the Company.

 

The Company currently has 6 Directors, 1 of whom is an Executive Director (the Chief Executive Officer who is also Managing Director). The remaining 5 Directors are Non-executive, 4 of whom, including the Chairman, are “independent.” The Board considers that, in addition to the Managing Director, Mr McConnell is not independent by virtue of his position as an officer of Shamrock Capital Advisors Inc., a related body corporate of Shamrock Holdings of California Inc. a substantial shareholder.

 

In addition Mr Gold who retired as a Director in April 2004, has been appointed as an alternate to Director to represent Mr McConnell. This allows the Board to continue to benefit from the experience and insight of Mr Gold from time to time. For the purpose of completeness Mr Gold does not meet the definition of independence, due to his financial interests in Trefoil International III, L.P., a related body corporate of Shamrock Holdings of California Inc.

 

Any Director can seek independent professional advice at the Company’s expense in the furtherance of his or her duties, subject to prior discussion with the Chairman. If this occurs, the Chairman must notify the other Directors of the approach, with any resulting advice received to be generally circulated to all Directors.


1 Corporate Governance, A Guide for Fund Managers and CorporationsBlue Book, Investment and Financial Services Association, December 2002 (copy available at www.ifsa.com.au).

 

37


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6C BOARD PRACTICES (continued)

 

Board Review and Election Processes

 

The Board periodically conducts a formal review of its performance in meeting shareholder and stakeholder expectations. Such reviews include:

 

    comparing Board performance against agreed external benchmarks;

 

    assessment and consideration of the effectiveness and composition of the Board;

 

    an assessment of the performance of the Chief Executive Officer and Managing Director by the Non-executive Directors;

 

    assessing whether corporate governance principles are appropriate and reflect “good practice” (by way of self-assessment using a structured approach); and

 

    assessing whether the expectations of differing shareholder groups have been met.

 

New Directors are nominated by the Board, as described below, and then must face a vote of shareholders at the next Annual General Meeting in order to be confirmed in office. The criteria for considering new candidates for the Board are set by the Nomination, Remuneration and Evaluation Committee. All Directors other than the Managing Director are required to seek re-election at least once in every three years on a rotating basis.

 

Appointment Terms

 

In order to ensure that composition of the Board will change over time, the Board has a general policy that Non-executive Directors should not serve for a period exceeding 12 years, and that the Chairman should not serve in that role for more than 10 years.

 

In order to ensure that Directors are able to fully discharge their duties to the Company, all Directors must consult with the Chairman of the Board, and advise the Nomination, Remuneration and Evaluation Committee, prior to accepting a position as a Non-executive Director of another company.

 

Remuneration

 

In June 2003, the Board resolved to discontinue the practice of paying retirement benefits to Non-executive Directors (notwithstanding that the payment of retirement benefits had previously been approved by shareholders). The retirement benefits of existing Non-executive Directors were quantified and paid as at 30 June 2003 as detailed in the Annual Review 2003. The Company has no ongoing liability regarding those amounts. In addition to their fees, Non-executive Directors now only receive Company sponsored superannuation contributions at rates that accord with statutory requirements.

 

Dealings in Shares

 

The Company has adopted a policy on dealing in Ansell shares by Directors and employees generally which is publicly available on the Company’s website www.ansell.com

 

Subject to the restriction that persons may not deal in any securities when they are in possession of price-sensitive information, Directors and employees generally may only buy or sell Ansell shares in the periods immediately following any price-sensitive announcements, including the half-year and full year results and Annual General Meeting. At other times, Directors dealing in Ansell shares must obtain prior approval from the Chairman.

 

Conflict of Interest

 

In order to ensure that any ‘interests’ of a Director in a particular matter to be considered by the Board are brought to the attention of each Director, the Company has developed protocols, consistent with obligations imposed by the Corporations Act and the Listing Rules, to require each Director to disclose any contracts, offices held, interests in transactions and other directorships which may involve any potential conflict. Appropriate procedures have been adopted to ensure that, where the possibility of a material conflict arises, relevant information is not provided to the Director, and the Director does not participate in discussion on the particular issue, or vote in respect of the matter at the meeting where the matter is considered.

 

38


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6C BOARD PRACTICES (continued)

 

Board Committees

 

The Board has established two standing Committees, being the:

 

    Audit Committee; and

 

    Nomination, Remuneration and Evaluation Committee.

 

The Board periodically reviews the charter of each Committee.

 

The Board also delegates specific functions to ad hoc Committees of Directors on an “as needs” basis. The powers delegated to these Committees are set out in Board resolutions.

 

Senior executives attend Board and Committee meetings by invitation, whenever particular matters arise that require management presentations or participation.

 

Audit Committee

 

The members of the Audit Committee during the year were all “independent” Non-executive Directors and comprised:

 

    Mr P L Barnes (Chair);

 

    Mr L D Crandall; and

 

    Mr H J Elliott.

 

Members of the Audit Committee are financially literate and the Board is of the opinion that the members of the Committee possess sufficient financial expertise and knowledge of the industry in which the Company operates.

 

The Audit Committee reviews the financial statements, adequacy of financial controls and the annual audit arrangements, both internal and external. It monitors the controls and financial reporting systems, applicable Company policies, national and international accounting standards and other regulatory or statutory requirements.

 

The Committee also liaises with the Company’s internal auditors and Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, reviews the scope of their activities, reviews the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm’s remuneration and independence, and advises the Board on their remuneration, appointment and removal. It is Board policy that the lead external audit partner and review partner not serve for more than 5 consecutive years. The Board has adopted a policy in relation to the provision of non-audit services by the Company’s Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm that is based on the principle that work that may detract from the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm’s independence and impartiality, or be perceived as doing so, should not be carried out by the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm. The Company’s Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm has also confirmed its independence to the Directors in accordance with applicable laws and standards.

 

The Committee also reviews the processes in place for the identification, management and reporting of business risk, and reviews the findings reported.

 

The Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Group Chief Accountant, Director - Internal Audit, other relevant Company officers (as required) and the principal external audit partner participate at meetings of the Committee.

 

39


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6C BOARD PRACTICES (continued)

 

Nomination, Remuneration and Evaluation Committee

 

The members of the Nomination, Remuneration and Evaluation Committee during the year were all Non-executive Directors and comprised:

 

    Dr E D Tweddell (Chair);

 

    Mr P L Barnes; and

 

    Mr S P Gold (until 16 April 2004); and

 

    Mr M J McConnell (from 16 April 2004),

 

a majority of whom are “independent” Non-executive Directors.

 

This Committee’s charter provides for it to periodically review the structure and performance of the Board, Board Committees and individual Directors and recommend changes when necessary. This includes identifying suitable candidates for appointment as Non-executive Directors.

 

In doing so, the Committee establishes the policies and criteria for Non-executive Director selection. The criteria include a candidate’s personal qualities, professional and business experience, and availability and time to commit to all aspects of the Board’s program.

 

The Committee also considers matters including succession and senior executive compensation policy, including short and long-term incentive plans and the Company’s recruitment, retention and termination policies, and advises the Board accordingly. The Committee makes recommendations to the Board regarding the specific remuneration of the Chief Executive Officer (including base pay, incentive payments, equity awards, retirement rights and service contracts). The remuneration of Non-executive Directors is a matter that is determined by the Board, although the Committee may request management or external consultants to provide necessary information upon which the Board may make its determination.

 

The Committee has available to it the services of independent professional advisers to assist in the search for high calibre people at all levels and ensure that the terms and conditions offered by the Company are competitive with those offered by comparable companies.

 

Disclosure to Investors

 

The Company has implemented procedures to ensure that it provides relevant and timely information to its shareholders and to the broader investment community, in accordance with its obligations under the ASX continuous disclosure regime. The Company’s Continuous Disclosure policy is available on its website, at www.ansell.com.

 

In addition to the Company’s obligations to disclose information to the ASX and to distribute information to shareholders, the Company publishes annual and half-year reports, media releases and other investor publications on its website.

 

The Board encourages full participation of shareholders at the Annual General Meeting to ensure a high level of accountability and discussion of the Group’s strategy and goals. The company invites the external auditor to attend the Annual General Meeting and be available to answer shareholder questions about the conduct of the audit and the preparation and content of the Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

 

40


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6C BOARD PRACTICES (continued)

 

ATTENDANCE AT BOARD AND BOARD COMMITTEE MEETINGS DURING THE YEAR ENDED 30 JUNE 2004

 

     Board

    Audit

   Nomination,
Remuneration
and Evaluation


 
     Held

   Attd

    Held

   Attd

   Held

   Attd

 

Directors – Continuing

                                

E D Tweddell

   7    7     —      —      4    4  

P L Barnes

   7    7     5    5    4    3  

H Boon

   6    6     —      —      —      —    

L D Crandall

   7    7     5    5    —      —    

H J Elliott

   7    7     5    5    —      —    

M J McConnell

   2    2     —      —      —      —    

S P Gold

   5    5 *   —      —      4    3 *

 

Held – Indicates the number of meetings held while each Director was in office.

 

Attd – Indicates the number of meetings attended during the period that each Director was in office.

 

Mr S P Gold retired on 16 April 2004. Mr M J McConnell was appointed on 16 April 2004.

 

Mr M J McConnell, who was previously an alternate for Mr Gold, attended two Board meetings as a director.

 

* Mr S P Gold who retired as a Director and was appointed as an alternate for Mr McConnell, did not attend any Board meetings as a Director but was represented at five meetings by his alternate. Mr Gold was represented at two meetings of the Nomination, Remuneration and Evaluation Committee by his alternate.

 

6D EMPLOYEES

 

As of 30 June 2004 Ansell Limited employed 11,530 full time equivalent employees (12,013 as at 30 June 2003 and 12,160 as at 30 June 2002) .

 

Approximately 16% of the total workforce of Ansell, who are predominantly located outside of Australia, belong to trade unions, while the length of the union contracts is typically 3 years. Management believes it has good relations with its unions.

 

The following is an analysis of the Group’s employees by geographic location (information regarding activities undertaken by employees is not available):

 

Location


   2004

   2003

   2002

Americas

              

USA (including Mexico)

   1,943    1,935    2,120

Canada

   44    44    44

Asia Pacific

              

Australia

   87    87    104

India

   1,540    1,847    1,774

Malaysia

   3,543    3,679    3,711

Sri Lanka

   1,919    1,959    1,861

Thailand

   2,033    2,030    2,089

Rest of Asia

   6    9    12

Europe

              

Belgium

   171    125    124

United Kingdom

   157    172    197

France

   51    66    54

Rest of Europe

   36    60    70
    
  
  

Total

   11,530    12,013    12,160
    
  
  

 

41


PART I

 

Item 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6E SHARE OWNERSHIP

 

The relevant interests of each of those Directors in the share capital of the Company as at the date of this Report, as notified to the Australian Stock Exchange Limited pursuant to the Listing Rules and section 205G of the Corporations Act, were:

 

     1

   2

   3

E D Tweddell

   34,220    —      —  

P L Barnes

   11,685    —      —  

D D Tough

   —      675,000    —  

L D Crandall

   8,108    —      —  

H J Elliott

   8,976    —      —  

M J McConnell

   26,406    —      —  

S P Gold (alternate to M J McConnell)

   15,239    —      16,428,840

 

1. Beneficially held in own name, or in the name of a trust, nominee company or private company.

 

2. Beneficial Executive Share Options (525,000) and Performance Share Rights (PSRs) (150,000). These were granted upon Mr Tough’s appointment in May 2004.

 

3. Non-beneficial. Mr Gold has an indirect interest in these shares by virtue of a 10% limited partnership interest in Trefoil International III, LP which is a related body corporate of Shamrock Holdings of California Inc.

 

Note: In addition, Mr H Boon who retired on 30 June 2004, held, as at the date of his retirement, 56,701 share beneficially in his own name or in the name of a trust, nominee company or private company and 1,000,000 options pursuant to the Ansell Limited Stock Incentive Plan.

 

No director holds more than one percent of the Company’s ordinary shares beneficially or of record.

 

Non-executive Directors’ Share Plan

 

Shareholders approved the participation by Non-executive Directors in the Plan in October 2000 and April 2002 (on amended terms). Since receiving shareholder approval, shares have been purchased on ASX under the Plan at the prevailing market price on behalf of each of the then current Non-executive Directors.

 

Details of securities acquired on ASX on behalf of Non-executive Directors under the Ansell Non-executive Directors Share Plan during the financial year are set out below in accordance with ASX Listing Rule 10.15A.

 

Director


   Number of shares
acquired


   Date of Acquisition

  

Acquisition Price

A$


Dr E D Tweddell

   853
904
842
749
   19/09/2003
16/12/2003
17/03/2004
16/06/2004
   $
$
$
$
6.84
6.46
6.94
7.80
    
  
  

Mr P L Barnes

   337
355
330
293
   19/09/2003
16/12/2003
17/03/2004
16/06/2004
   $
$
$
$
6.84
6.46
6.94
7.80
    
  
  

Mr L D Crandall

   1,943
1,777
296
264
   19/09/2003
16/12/2003
17/03/2004
16/06/2004
   $
$
$
$
6.84
6.46
6.94
7.80
    
  
  

Mr H J Elliott

   300
318
296
264
   19/09/2003
16/12/2003
17/03/2004
16/06/2004
   $
$
$
$
6.84
6.46
6.94
7.80
    
  
  

Mr M J McConnell

   1,406    16/06/2004    $ 7.80
    
  
  

 

42


PART I

 

ITEM 6 : Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

6E SHARE OWNERSHIP (continued)

 

Non-executive Directors’ Share Plan (continued)

 

In addition, Mr S P Gold participated in the Plan prior to his retirement as a Director of the Company, acquiring:

 

    1,943 shares on 19/09/2003 at $6.84 per share;

 

    1,777 shares on 16/12/2003 at $6.46 per share;

 

    2,176 shares on 17/03/2004 at $6.94 per share; and

 

    278 shares on 16/06/2004 at $7.80 per share (being purchases from fees paid for the period 1-16 April 2004).

 

Executives Share Ownership

 

The relevant interests of senior executives in the share capital of the Company as at the date of this Report, were:

 

     1

   2

   3

Mr P. Corke

   2,772    —      31,667

Mr W. Heintz

   8,333    —      46,667

Mr R. Jilla

   6,000    300,000    50,000

Mr N. O’Donnell

   5,000    —      30,000

Mr W. Reed

   3,602    —      45,000

Mr W. Reilly

   5,545    —      31,667

 

1. Beneficially held in own name, or in the name of a trust, nominee company or private company.

 

2. Beneficial Executive Share Options. Options were granted on 23 September 2002, have an exercise price of $6.97 and an expiry date of 23 September 2012. Tranches 1 & 2 have a fair value at 30 June 2004 of $2.66 and Tranche 3 has a fair value of $2.70.

 

3. Performance Share Rights (PSR’s). The award of a PSR by the Company entitles the participant to receive one fully paid ordinary share in the Company at the end of a Performance Period. The number of PSR’s that vest will be contingent on the degree to which performance measures and, as appropriate, service conditions established at the time of the grant are met. Grants of PSR’s to each executive comprise three equal tranches, each tranche subject to performance hurdles for vesting to occur.

 

The shareholdings of each Executive Officer represents less than 1% of the Company’s shares on issue.

 

43


PART I

 

Item 7 :  Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions

 

7A MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS

 

To the best of its knowledge, Ansell Limited is not directly, or indirectly, controlled by any corporation, by any foreign government or by any other natural or legal person(s) severally or jointly. Ansell Limited does not know of any arrangement, the operation of which may result in a change of control of Ansell Limited.

 

The names of substantial shareholders in the Company and the number of fully paid ordinary shares in which each has an interest as at 1 February 2005 are as follows:

 

    

No. of Fully

Paid Shares


  

% of
Issued

Capital


 

Perpetual Investments

   23,209,414    14.55 %

Barclays Global Investors (Group)

   13,183,909    8.27 %

Maple-Brown Abbott Ltd.

   12,710,924    7.97 %

CDC IXIS Asset Mgt (Group)

   7,672,861    4.81 %

 

None of the Company’s substantial shareholders has voting rights that differ from those granted to Ansell Limited’s ordinary shareholders by the Company’s Constitution.

 

Voting rights as governed by the Constitution of the Company provide that each ordinary shareholder present in person or by proxy at a meeting shall have:

 

(a) on a show of hands, one vote only;

 

(b) on a poll, one vote for every fully paid ordinary share held.

 

On 30 June 2004, 285,234 ADSs (equivalent to 1,140,936 Ordinary Shares, which represents approximately 0.6% of the Ordinary Shares then outstanding) were outstanding and held by 135 registered holders with addresses in the United States.

 

7B RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

 

Refer to Notes 28 and 34 to the Financial Statements included in Item 18 for additional details of Related Party Transactions.

 

7C INTERESTS OF EXPERTS AND COUNSEL

 

Not Applicable

 

44


PART I

 

Item 8 : Financial Information

 

8A CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS AND OTHER FINANCIAL INFORMATION

 

The Consolidated Financial Statements are included herein as Item 18.

 

Refer to Note 26 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for details of legal proceedings.

 

The Company has no fixed policy on dividend distribution. The payment of dividends is at the discretion of the Board.

 

8B SIGNIFICANT CHANGES

 

There have been no significant events subsequent to the end of the financial year. However, since the end of the financial year, the detail of the US GAAP differences pertaining to the consolidated financial statements of the South Pacific Tyres partnership, which are filed by Ansell Limited in accordance with Rule 3.09 of Regulation S-X, have been fully reassessed by the partners.

 

This reassessment resulted in restatements of Ansell’s equity accounted US GAAP results in 2001, 2002 and 2003. The full detail of the restatements is set out in Notes 39 and 40 to the consolidated financial statements. The cumulative effect of the restatements for the three years ended 30 June 2003 is $432,145. The cumulative impact of SPT restatements prior to 2001 of $2.8 million (net of tax) has been adjusted against opening equity under US GAAP.

 

In addition, further restatement of 2003 results has been made in respect of the cumulative impacts of changes in accounting principles arising on adoption of SFAS 142 and SFAS 143. This resulted in a charge of $5.3 million (net of nil tax).

 

An additional minimum liability of $7.9 million in respect of the Company’s US pension plans has been recorded in Other Comprehensive Income in 2003.

 

45


PART I

 

Item 9 : The Offer and Listing

 

9A OFFER AND LISTING DETAILS

 

The following table sets out for the periods indicated ($A) the highest and lowest market quotation for the Ordinary Shares reported on the Daily Official List of The Australian Stock Exchange Limited and (US$) the highest and lowest bid prices for ADSs quoted on the NASDAQ National Market System.

 

    

$A

Ordinary Shares


  

US$

Per ADS(1)


Period


   High

   Low

   High

   Low

Last 5 Financial Years

                   

Fiscal Year 2004

   7.900    5.840    22.810    15.500

Fiscal Year 2003

   7.690    4.960    17.900    12.100

Fiscal Year 2002

   7.010    3.400    15.310    6.550

Fiscal Year 2001

   8.400    4.000    19.375    8.205

Fiscal Year 2000

   12.400    6.850    31.875    14.220

By Quarter 2004-2005

                   

First Quarter

   8.840    7.580    25.700    21.711

Second Quarter

   9.300    8.740    28.880    25.510

By Quarter 2003-2004

                   

First Quarter

   6.950    5.840    18.310    15.500

Second Quarter

   7.220    6.190    20.020    18.090

Third Quarter

   7.170    6.320    22.220    19.260

Fourth Quarter

   7.900    7.310    22.810    20.200

By Quarter 2002-2003

                   

First Quarter

   7.150    6.450    15.480    13.800

Second Quarter

   7.690    6.670    17.200    14.500

Third Quarter

   7.650    4.960    17.900    12.100

Fourth Quarter

   6.370    5.250    16.220    12.200

Last 6 Months

                   

February 2005

   10.130    9.190    31.920    29.000

January 2005

   9.450    8.860    28.500    26.810

December 2004

   9.300    8.930    28.880    27.360

November 2004

   9.190    9.040    28.750    27.200

October 2004

   9.050    8.740    26.650    25.510

September 2004

   8.840    8.500    25.700    23.750

 

(1) Each ADS represents four Ordinary Shares.

 

The total market capitalisation of Ansell Limited at 30 June 2004 was $1,362 million. The total market capitalisation of Ansell Limited at 28 February 2005, was $1,617 million and the closing price for Ansell Limited ordinary shares on the ASX on that date was $10.11.

 

9B PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

 

Not Applicable

 

46


PART I

 

Item 9 : The Offer and Listing

 

9C MARKETS

 

The principal trading market for Ansell Limited’s Ordinary Shares (“Ordinary Shares”), is the Australian Stock Exchange Limited (ASX). The Ordinary Shares are also listed on the London Stock Exchange and the Stock Exchange of New Zealand. The Company’s American Depositary Shares (“ADSs”), represented by American Depositary Receipts (“ADR’s”) issued by Morgan Guaranty Trust Company of New York, as Depositary (the “Depositary”), are traded in the United States in the over-the-counter market and are quoted on the NASDAQ National Market System.

 

The stock market operated by the ASX is the principal stock exchange in Australia. The exchange operates by way of the Stock Exchange Automated Trading System (SEATS) which is a fully computerised system.

 

Trading on SEATS takes place each business day between the hours of 10:00am and 4:00pm, Australian Eastern Standard Time or Australian Eastern Summer Time. At 4:05pm each day, the ASX subsequently matches any buy and sell orders in the system, which are at the same price. The prices of all listed Shares are continuously quoted while the market is open and the system prioritises the orders first by price and second by placement in the system.

 

Exchange participants can cross stock between buying and selling orders, at the buy or sell quote provided those quotes are no more than one marketable bid apart and can cross outside this range in amounts of A$1 million or more. Transactions on the ASX are settled on the third business day following the trade date.

 

9D SELLING SHAREHOLDERS

 

Not Applicable

 

9E DILUTION

 

Not Applicable

 

9F EXPENSES OF THE ISSUE

 

Not Applicable

 

47


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10A SHARE CAPITAL

 

Not Applicable

 

10B CONSTITUTION

 

The Company adopted its current Constitution on 12 April 2002. Set out below is a summary of the Constitution’s key provisions.

 

Under Australian company law, a company is permitted, but not required, to have an objects clause or statement of purposes in its Constitution. The Company’s constitution does not contain an objects clause. Pursuant to the provisions of the Corporations Act 2001, (Cth), (the “Corporations Act”) the Company has the legal capacity of an individual and all of the powers of a body corporate.

 

Rule 38(b) of the Company’s Constitution permits the Directors to exercise all the powers of the Company, at their discretion, including:

 

(a) to raise or borrow money;

 

(b) to charge any of the Company’s property or business or any amount unpaid on its shares; and

 

(c) to issue debentures or give any other security for a debt, liability or obligation of the Company or of any other person.

 

These borrowing powers, as with any provision of the Constitution, can be amended by the shareholders of the Company passing a special resolution at a general meeting.

 

Rule 5 permits the Company to issue shares and grant options for shares on such terms and with such rights and restrictions as decided by the Directors. The issue and terms of issue of preference shares must be approved by the Company’s shareholders in general meeting as required by the Corporations Act.

 

The Constitution contains provisions consistent with ASX Listing Rules, which permit the Company to divest holdings of less than a marketable parcel (i.e. holdings which are worth less than $A500).

 

Rule 53 provides that, subject to any rights or restrictions attached to any shares or class of shares, the profits of the Company are divisible amongst the holders of ordinary shares (being the only class of shares currently on issue) in proportion to the capital paid up, or credited as paid, upon the shares held by them respectively.

 

Rule 32 provides that the maximum number of Directors is 8 and the minimum number is 4. There is no age limit prescribed in the Company’s Constitution for Directors. All Directors of the Company, other than the Managing Director, are required to seek re-election at least once in every three years on a rotating basis.

 

Rule 37(f) of the Company’s Constitution permits a Director who has an interest in a matter that is being considered at a meeting of Directors to, despite that interest, vote, be present and be counted in a quorum at the meeting, unless prohibited by the Corporations Act. The Corporations Act prohibits a Director of the Company from being present at a meeting of Directors during consideration of, or voting upon, a matter in which that Director has a material personal interest. This does not apply to voting on Directors’ compensation. However, the total aggregate remuneration payable to the Non-executive Directors may not exceed the maximum amount approved by shareholders at a general meeting from time to time pursuant to rule 35(a) of the Company’s Constitution.

 

Rule 60 of the Constitution provides Directors with a right to access Company documents consistent with existing rights under the Corporations Act. Rule 61 of the Constitution provides for the provision of an indemnity and the maintenance of insurance in favour of certain Directors and officers of the Company and its related bodies corporate to the levels required by the Corporations Act.

 

As previously indicated, rule 53 provides for each share to participate in those of the Company’s profits the Board determines to distribute in proportion to the amount paid up on those shares, subject to any right or restriction attaching to a share or class of shares. In the event of liquidation, rule 59 permits the liquidator, with the sanction of a special resolution to divide among shareholders the whole or any part of the Company’s property and decide how the division is to be carried out as between the members or different classes of members.

 

48


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10B CONSTITUTION (continued)

 

Rule 58 provides that where the assets available upon a winding up are insufficient to repay all of the capital paid on shares, the losses will be borne by shareholders in proportion to the capital paid or that ought to have been paid on the shares at the commencement of the winding up. If surplus assets remain upon a winding up after having repaid the whole of the capital paid up, the excess is to be distributed amongst shareholders in proportion to the capital paid or that ought to have been paid on the shares at the commencement of the winding up.

 

There are no redemption or sinking fund provisions in the Constitution. However, the Corporations Act requires the approval of shareholders to the issue of preference shares with a right of redemption (or authorisation of the Board to issue such shares). Any amount of the issue price of a share that remains unpaid may, subject to any rights or restrictions attaching to a share, be called for payment by the Board pursuant to rule 10. However, once the full amount of the issue price of a share has been paid, a shareholder is not liable to contribute any further capital to the Company in respect of that share. The Company’s Constitution does not contain any provision discriminating against any existing or prospective shareholder as a result of such shareholder owning a substantial number of shares, nor does it contain any provisions pertaining to the changing of the rights of shareholders.

 

The provisions of the Constitution dealing with general meetings and proxies reflect the requirements in relation to the matters imposed by the Corporations Act. The Company is required by the Corporations Act to hold an annual general meeting at least once in each calendar year. In addition, the Corporations Act and rule 23 provide that the Directors (including any single Director) may at any time convene a general meeting of shareholders and the Directors must convene a general meeting upon the requisition of at least 100 shareholders or the holders of 5% of the votes that may be cast at the meeting. The Constitution does not impose any conditions upon the admission of shareholders to a general meeting, however, rule 25(a) permits the chair of a general meeting to take any action he or she considers appropriate for the safety of persons attending the meeting and the orderly conduct of the meeting and may refuse a person admission to, or require a person to leave and remain out of, the meeting if the person is disruptive.

 

The Company continues to rely on an exemption from the quorum requirement set forth in Nasdaq Marketplace Rule 4350(f). In accordance with Australian law, the Company’s Constitution provides that the quorum requirement is met at a general shareholder meeting if five or more shareholders entitled to vote on a resolution at the meeting are present.

 

Rule 30(a) provides, subject to any rights or restrictions attached to any shares or class of shares, that every shareholder present at a meeting has one vote on a show of hands and each share, on a poll is:

 

(a) if fully paid – entitled to one vote;

 

(b) if partly paid – entitled to a fraction of one vote which the amount paid (not credited) on the share bears to the total amounts paid and payable (excluding amounts credited).

 

The Constitution contains no limitations on the rights to own securities. In the event of a partial or proportional takeover bid being made for shares in the Company, rule 69 requires that a resolution to approve the takeover scheme be passed at a general meeting of shareholders before any registration of a transfer giving effect to the proportional takeover can be made. The Constitution contains no governing by-law provisions governing the ownership threshold above which shareholder ownership must be disclosed.

 

In addition to the information contained above, the Corporations Act:

 

(a) provides a code that regulates “takeovers” (changes in control) of Australian companies that applies, in general, where a shareholder becomes entitled to 20% or more of the issued shares of a company; and

 

(b) provides for disclosure of share ownership once a person and his or her associates become entitled to 5% or more of the issued shares in a company.

 

The Foreign Acquisition and Takeovers Act 1975 (Cth) regulates the acquisition of interests in Australian companies by foreign nationals in excess of 15% of the issued shares of a company. There are no conditions imposed under the Constitution governing changes in capital that are more stringent than required by Australian company law.

 

49


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10C MATERIAL CONTRACTS

 

There have been no material contracts entered into by the Company over the last two years.

 

50


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10D EXCHANGE CONTROLS

 

Except for restrictions on foreign exchange transactions with ministers and senior officials of the Government of Zimbabwe and the supporters of the former Milosevic regime, the Reserve Bank of Australia (“RBA”) does not inhibit the import and export of funds, and no permission is required by Ansell Limited for the movement of funds in and out of Australia. Under Part 4 of the Charter of the United Nations Act 1945 and the Charter of the United Nations (Terrorism and Dealing with Assets) Regulations 2002 (Cth) (“Regulations”), anybody holding financial or other assets of persons or entities listed as terrorists by either the Minister of Foreign Affairs in the Commonwealth Gazette or on the website of the Committee established by Resolution 1267 (1999) of the Security Council of the United Nations, is prohibited from dealing with those assets. It is also a criminal offence to make assets available to such persons or entities. The Iraq (Reconstruction and Repeal of Sanctions) Regulations 2003 (Cth) imposes a freeze on the financial resources of the previous government of Iraq, Saddam Hussein, other senior officials of his regime, and their immediate families. Accordingly, at the present time, remittance of any dividends, interest or other payment by Ansell Limited to non-resident holders of Ansell Limited’s securities in the United States is not restricted by exchange controls or other limitations, unless the non-resident holder is a person or entity listed by the Minister or on the Committee website under the Regulations.

 

Ansell Limited has 175,962,865 Ordinary Shares (excluding Employee Plan Shares, as defined in “Compensation of Directors and Executive Officers” and shares bought back by the Company prior to 30 June 2004 but not cancelled at that date) on issue as at 30 June 2004. Non-residents of Australia may freely hold and vote Ordinary Shares, subject to compliance with the Foreign Acquisitions and Takeovers Act 1975 of Australia (the “Foreign Takeovers Act”). Takeovers of Australian companies by foreign interests are subject to review and approval by the Treasurer of the Commonwealth of Australia under the Foreign Takeovers Act. Technically, the statute applies to any acquisition of 15% or more of the outstanding shares of an Australian company that has total assets valued $5 million or more ($3 million or more if greater than 50% of the assets of the company are in the form of rural land) or any acquisition which results in one foreign person or group of associated foreign persons controlling 15% or more of total voting power. In addition, the statute applies to any acquisition by non-associated foreign persons resulting in foreign persons controlling, in the aggregate, 40% or more of total voting power or ownership.

 

Since the Australian government’s Economic Statement of February 1992, the policy of the body which reviews foreign investment (the Foreign Investment Review Board) is that only acquisitions of shares in companies which have assets in excess of $50 million will require approval. The Corporations Act also regulates acquisitions giving rise to ownership of substantial amounts of a company’s shares.

 

The Corporations Act prohibits any person (including a corporation), whether foreign or not, from acquiring a relevant interest in voting shares in a company if, after the acquisition, that person’s or any other person’s voting power in the company increases from 20% or below to more than 20%, or increases from a starting point that is above 20% and below 90%.

 

A person is considered to have voting power in respect of a share under the Corporations Act if the person or an associate (as defined in the Corporations Act) is the holder of the share, or has, or is deemed under the Corporations Act to have, power (whether direct or indirect and whether legally enforceable or not and irrespective of certain restrictions and restraints on such powers and other matters and things as specified in the Corporations Act):

 

(1) to exercise, or to control the exercise of, the right to vote attached to that share; or

 

(2) to dispose of, or to control the exercise of a power to dispose of, that share.

 

This prohibition is subject to certain exceptions which must be strictly complied with to be applicable. Some of the more significant exceptions are as follows:

 

    Section 611, item 1 of the Corporations Act permits a person to acquire more than 20% of the voting shares of a company under a formal takeover bid, being an offer to the shareholders of the target company to acquire their shares. The takeover bid may be an off-market bid or a market bid; and

 

    under Section 611, item 9 of the Corporations Act, a person who is already entitled to at least 19% of the voting shares is permitted to increase their voting power by not more than 3% in any period of six months.

 

51


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10D EXCHANGE CONTROLS (CONTINUED)

 

Dividends paid to holders of Ordinary Shares who are non-residents of Australia are subject to certain Australian withholding tax requirements. See “Taxation-Australian Taxation.”

 

Dividends paid to United States Holders (as defined below) are also subject to United States federal income tax requirements, although those paid to non-United States Holders generally are not.

 

AMERICAN DEPOSITARY RECEIPTS

 

The following is a summary of all material provisions of the Second Amended and Restated Deposit Agreement (including any exhibits thereto, the “Deposit Agreement”) dated as of 26 March 1999 among the Company, Morgan Guaranty Trust Company of New York, as depositary (the “Depositary”), and the registered Holders from time to time of the ADR’s issued thereunder (“ADR’s”). This summary does not purport to be complete and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the Deposit Agreement. Copies of the Deposit Agreement are available for inspection at the principal office of the Depositary in New York, New York (the “Principal New York Office”), which is presently located at 60 Wall Street, New York, New York 10260. Terms used herein and not otherwise defined shall have the respective meanings set forth in the Deposit Agreement.

 

ADR’s evidencing American Depository Shares (“ADSs”) are issuable by the Depositary pursuant to the terms of the Deposit Agreement. Each ADS represents, as of the date hereof, the right to receive four Shares deposited under the Deposit Agreement (together with any additional Shares deposited thereunder and all other securities, property and cash received and held thereunder at any time in respect of or in lieu of such deposited Shares, the “Deposited Securities”) with the Custodian under the Deposit Agreement (together with any successor or successors thereto, the Custodian).

 

An ADR may evidence any number of ADSs. Only persons in whose name ADR’s are registered on the books of the Depositary will be treated by the Depositary and the Company as Holders. As the context requires, the term ADR refers to certificated receipts as well as to ADSs reflected on the direct registration system maintained by the Depositary.

 

DEPOSIT, TRANSFER AND WITHDRAWAL

 

In connection with the deposit of Shares under the Deposit Agreement, the Depositary or the Custodian may require the following in a form satisfactory to it:

 

(a) a written order directing the Depositary to issue to, or upon the written order of, the person or persons designated in such order an ADR or ADR’s evidencing the number of ADSs representing such deposited Shares (a “Delivery Order”);

 

(b) proper endorsements or duly executed instruments of transfer in respect of such deposited Shares;

 

(c) instruments assigning to the Custodian or its nominee any distribution on or in respect of such deposited Shares or indemnity therefore; and,

 

(d) proxies entitling the Custodian to vote such deposited Shares until such Shares are transferred and recorded on the register of shareholders of the Company in the name of the Depositary or its nominee.

 

As soon as practicable after the Custodian receives Deposited Securities pursuant to any such deposit or pursuant to the form of ADR, the Custodian shall present such Deposited Securities for registration of transfer into the name of the Depositary or its nominee, to the extent such registration is practicable, at the cost and expense of the person making such deposit (or for whose benefit such deposit is made) and shall obtain evidence satisfactory to it of such registration. Deposited Securities shall be held by the Custodian for the account and to the order of the Depositary at such place or places and in such manner as the Depositary shall determine. Deposited Securities may be delivered by the Custodian to any person only under the circumstances expressly contemplated in the Deposit Agreement.

 

52


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10D EXCHANGE CONTROLS (CONTINUED)

 

After any such deposit of Shares, the Custodian shall notify the Depositary of such deposit and of the information contained in any related Delivery Order by letter, first class airmail postage prepaid, or, at the request, risk and expense of the person making the deposit, by cable, telex or facsimile transmission. After receiving such notice from the Custodian, the Depositary, subject to the terms and conditions of the Deposit Agreement, shall properly issue at the Transfer Office, which is presently located at the Principal New York Office, to or upon the order of any person named in such notice, an ADR or ADR’s registered as requested and evidencing the aggregate ADSs to which such person is entitled.

 

Subject to the terms and conditions of the Deposit Agreement, the Depositary may so issue ADR’s for delivery at the Transfer Office only against deposit with the Custodian of:

 

(a) Shares in form satisfactory to the Custodian;

 

(b) rights to receive Shares from the Company or any registrar, transfer agent, clearing agent or other entity recording Share ownership or transactions; or,

 

(c) other rights to receive Shares (until such Shares are actually deposited pursuant to (a) or (b) above, “Pre-released ADR’s”) only if:

 

  (i) Pre-released ADR’s are fully collateralised (marked to market daily) with cash or U.S. government securities held by the Depositary for the benefit of Holders (but such collateral shall not constitute “Deposited Securities”);

 

  (ii) each recipient of Pre-released ADR’s agrees in writing with the Depositary that such recipient (a) owns such Shares, (b) assigns all beneficial right, title and interest therein to the Depositary, (c) holds such Shares for the account of the Depositary and (d) will deliver such Shares to the Custodian as soon as practicable and promptly upon demand therefore; and

 

  (iii) all Pre-released ADR’s evidence not more than 30% of all ADSs (excluding those evidenced by Pre-released ADR’s), provided, however, that the Depositary reserves the right to change or disregard such limit from time to time as it deems appropriate. The Depositary may retain for its own account any earnings on collateral for Pre-released ADR’s and its charges for issuance thereof.

 

At the request, risk and expense of the person depositing Shares, the Depositary may accept deposits for forwarding to the Custodian and may deliver ADR’s at a place other than its office. Every person depositing Shares under the Deposit Agreement is deemed to represent and warrant that such Shares are validly issued and outstanding, fully paid, non-assessable and free of pre-emptive rights, that the person making such deposit is duly authorised to do so and that such Shares (A) are not “restricted securities” as such term is defined in rule 144 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act of 1933”) unless at the time of deposit they may be freely transferred in accordance with rule 144(k) and may otherwise be offered and sold freely in the United States or (B) have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933. Such representations and warranties shall survive the deposit of Shares and issuance of ADR’s.

 

Subject to the terms and conditions of the Deposit Agreement, upon surrender of an ADR in form satisfactory to the Depositary at the Transfer Office, the Holder thereof is entitled to delivery at the Custodian’s office of the Deposited Securities at the time represented by the ADSs evidenced by such ADR. At the request, risk and expense of the Holder thereof, the Depositary may deliver such Deposited Securities at such other place as may have been requested by the Holder. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Deposit Agreement or the ADR’s, the withdrawal of Deposited Securities may be restricted only for the reasons set forth in General Instruction I.A. (1) of Form F-6 (as such instructions may be amended from time to time) under the Securities Act of 1933.

 

DISTRIBUTIONS ON DEPOSITED SECURITIES

 

Subject to the terms and conditions of the Deposit Agreement, to the extent practicable, the Depositary will distribute by mail to each Holder entitled thereto on the record date set by the Depositary therefor at such Holder’s address shown on the ADR Register, in proportion to the number of Deposited Securities (on which the following distributions on Deposited Securities are received by the Custodian) represented by ADSs evidenced by such Holder’s ADR’s:

 

53


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10D EXCHANGE CONTROLS (CONTINUED)

 

DISTRIBUTIONS ON DEPOSITED SECURITIES (continued)

 

(a) Cash :

 

Any U.S. dollars available to the Depositary resulting from a cash dividend or other cash distribution or the net proceeds of sales of any other distribution or portion thereof authorised in the Deposit Agreement (“Cash”), on an averaged or other practicable basis, subject to:

 

  (i) appropriate adjustments for taxes withheld,

 

  (ii) such distribution being impermissible or impracticable with respect to certain Holders, and

 

  (iii) deduction of the Depositary’s expenses in (1) converting any foreign currency to U.S. dollars by sale or in such other manner as the Depositary may determine to the extent that it determines that such conversion may be made on a reasonable basis, (2) transferring foreign currency or U.S. dollars to the United States by such means as the Depositary may determine to the extent that it determines that such transfer may be made on a reasonable basis, (3) obtaining any approval or license of any governmental authority required for such conversion or transfer, which is obtainable at a reasonable cost and within a reasonable time and (4) making any sale by public or private means in any commercially reasonable manner.

 

(b) Shares:

 

  (i) Additional ADR’s evidencing whole ADSs representing any Shares available to the Depositary resulting from a dividend or free distribution on Deposited Securities consisting of Shares (a “Share Distribution”), and

 

  (ii) U.S. dollars available to it resulting from the net proceeds of sales of Shares received in a Share Distribution, which Shares would give rise to fractional ADSs if additional ADR’s were issued therefore, as in the case of Cash.

 

(c) Rights:

 

  (i) Warrants or other instruments in the discretion of the Depositary representing rights to acquire additional ADR’s in respect of any rights to subscribe for additional Shares or rights of any nature available to the Depositary as a result of a distribution on Deposited Securities (“Rights”), to the extent that the Company timely furnishes to the Depositary evidence satisfactory to the Depositary that the Depositary may lawfully distribute the same (the Company has no obligation to so furnish such evidence), or

 

  (ii) to the extent the Company does not so furnish such evidence and sales of Rights are practicable, any U.S. dollars available to the Depositary from the net proceeds of sales of Rights as in the case of Cash, or

 

  (iii) to the extent the Company does not so furnish such evidence and such sales cannot practicably be accomplished by reason of the non-transferability of the Rights, limited markets therefore, their short duration or otherwise, nothing (and any Rights may lapse). Subject to Australian law, the Company will, in connection with any offer of such Rights, make such Rights generally transferable or consent to the transfer thereof by foreign investors not resident in Australia; and

 

(d) Other Distributions:

 

  (i) Securities or property available to the Depositary resulting from any distribution on Deposited Securities other than Cash, Share Distributions and Rights (“Other Distributions”), by any means that the Depositary may deem equitable and practicable, or

 

  (ii) to the extent the Depositary deems distribution of such securities or property not to be equitable and practicable, any U.S. dollars available to the Depositary from the net proceeds of sales of Other Distributions as in the case of Cash.

 

54


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10D EXCHANGE CONTROLS (CONTINUED)

 

DISTRIBUTIONS ON DEPOSITED SECURITIES (continued)

 

Such U.S. dollars available will be distributed by checks drawn on a bank in the United States for whole dollars and cents (any fractional cents being withheld without liability for interest and added to future Cash distributions). To the extent that the Depositary determines in its discretion that any distribution is not practicable with respect to any Holder, the Depositary may make such distribution as it so determines is practicable, including the distribution of foreign currency, securities or property (or appropriate documents evidencing the right to receive foreign currency, securities or property) or the retention thereof as Deposited Securities with respect to such Holder’s ADR’s (without liability for interest thereon or the investment thereof). There can be no assurance that the Depositary will be able to effect any currency conversion or to sell or otherwise dispose of any distributed or offered property, subscription or other rights, Shares or other securities in a timely manner or at a specified rate or price, as the case may be.

 

DISCLOSURE OF INTERESTS

 

To the extent that the provisions of or governing any Deposited Securities may require disclosure of or impose limits on beneficial or other ownership of Deposited Securities, other Shares and other securities and may provide for blocking transfer, voting or other rights to enforce such disclosure or limits, Holders and all persons holding ADR’s agree to comply with all such disclosure requirements and ownership limitations and to cooperate with the Depositary in the Depositary’s compliance with any Company instructions in respect thereof, and, in the Deposit Agreement, the Depositary has agreed to use reasonable efforts to comply with such Company instructions.

 

RECORD DATES

 

The Depositary may, after consultation with the Company if practicable, fix a record date (which shall be as near as practicable to any corresponding record date set by the Company) for the determination of the Holders who shall be entitled to receive any distribution on or in respect of Deposited Securities, to give instructions for the exercise of any voting rights, to receive any notice or to act in respect of other matters and only such Holders shall be so entitled.

 

VOTING OF DEPOSITED SECURITIES

 

As soon as practicable after receipt from the Company of notice of any meeting or solicitation of consents or proxies of holders of Shares or other Deposited Securities, the Depositary shall mail to Holders a notice stating:

 

(a) such information as is contained in such notice and any solicitation materials;

 

(b) that each Holder on the record date set by the Depositary therefore will be entitled to instruct the Depositary as to the exercise of the voting rights, if any, pertaining to the Deposited Securities represented by the ADSs evidenced by such Holder’s ADR’s; and

 

(c) the manner in which such instructions may be given, including instructions to give a discretionary proxy to a person designated by the Company. Upon receipt of instructions of a Holder on such record date in the manner and on or before the date established by the Depositary for such purpose, the Depositary shall endeavour in so far as practicable and permitted under the provisions of or governing Deposited Securities to vote or cause to be voted the Deposited Securities represented by the ADSs evidenced by such Holder’s ADR’s in accordance with such instructions. The Depositary will not itself exercise any voting discretion in respect of any Deposited Securities.

 

INSPECTION OF TRANSFER BOOKS

 

The Deposit Agreement provides that the Depositary will keep books at its Transfer Office for the registration, registration of transfer, combination and split-up of ADR’s, which at all reasonable times will be open for inspection by the Holders and the Company for the purpose of communicating with Holders in the interest of the business of the Company or a matter related to the Deposit Agreement.

 

55


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10D EXCHANGE CONTROLS (CONTINUED)

 

REPORTS AND OTHER COMMUNICATIONS

 

The Depositary shall make available for inspection by Holders at the Transfer Office any reports and communications received from the Company which are both:

 

(a) received by the Depositary as the holder of the Deposited Securities; and

 

(b) made generally available to the holders of such Deposited Securities by the Company. The Depositary shall also send to the Holders copies of such reports when furnished by the Company. Any such reports and communications furnished to the Depositary by the Company shall be furnished in English.

 

On or before the first date on which the Company makes any communication available to holders of Deposited Securities or any securities regulatory authority or stock exchange, by publication or otherwise, the Company shall transmit to the Depositary a copy thereof in English or with an English translation or summary. The Company has delivered to the Depositary, the Custodian and any Transfer Office, a copy of all provisions of or governing the Shares and any other Deposited Securities issued by the Company or any affiliate of the Company and, promptly upon any change thereto, the Company shall deliver to the Depositary, the Custodian and any Transfer Office, a copy (in English or with an English translation) of such provisions as so changed. The Depositary and its agents may rely upon the Company’s delivery thereof for all purposes of the Deposit Agreement.

 

CHANGES AFFECTING DEPOSITED SECURITIES

 

Subject to the terms and conditions of the Deposit Agreement, the Depositary may, in its discretion, amend the form of ADR or distribute additional or amended ADR’s (with or without calling the ADR’s for exchange) or cash, securities or property on the record date set by the Depositary therefor to reflect any change in par value, split-up, consolidation, cancellation or other reclassification of Deposited Securities, any Share Distribution or Other Distribution not distributed to Holders or any cash, securities or property available to the Depositary in respect of Deposited Securities from (and, in the Deposit Agreement, the Depositary is authorised to surrender any Deposited Securities to any person and to sell by public or private sale any property received in connection with) any recapitalisation, reorganisation, merger, consolidation, liquidation, receivership, bankruptcy or sale of all or substantially all the assets of the Company, and to the extent the Depositary does not so amend the ADR or make a distribution to Holders to reflect any of the foregoing, or the net proceeds thereof, whatever cash, securities or property results from any of the foregoing shall constitute Deposited Securities and each ADS shall automatically represent its pro rata interest in the Deposited Securities as then constituted.

 

AMENDMENT AND TERMINATION OF DEPOSIT AGREEMENT

 

The ADR’s and the Deposit Agreement may be amended by the Company and the Depositary, provided that any amendment that imposes or increases any fees or charges (other than stock transfer or other taxes and other governmental charges, transfer or registration fees, cable, telex or facsimile transmission costs, delivery costs or other such expenses), or that shall otherwise prejudice any substantial existing right of Holders, shall become effective 30 days after notice of such amendment shall have been given to the Holders.

 

Every Holder of an ADR at the time any amendment to the Deposit Agreement so becomes effective shall be deemed, by continuing to hold such ADR, to consent and agree to such amendment and to be bound by the Deposit Agreement as amended thereby. In no event shall any amendment impair the right of the Holder of any ADR to surrender such ADR and receive the Deposited Securities represented thereby, except in order to comply with mandatory provisions of applicable law.

 

56


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10D EXCHANGE CONTROLS (CONTINUED)

 

AMENDMENT AND TERMINATION OF DEPOSIT AGREEMENT (continued)

 

Any amendments or supplements which:

 

(i) are reasonably necessary (as agreed by the Company and the Depositary) in order for (a) the ADSs to be registered on Form F-6 under the Securities Act of 1933 or (b) the ADSs or Shares to be traded solely in electronic book-entry form; and

 

(ii) do not in either such case impose or increase any fees or charges to be borne by Holders, shall be deemed not to prejudice any substantial rights of Holders. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if any governmental body should adopt new laws, rules or regulations which would require amendment or supplement of the Deposit Agreement or the form of ADR to ensure compliance therewith, the Company and the Depositary may amend or supplement the Deposit Agreement and the ADR at any time in accordance with such changed rules. Such amendment or supplement to the Deposit Agreement in such circumstances may become effective before a notice of such amendment or supplement is given to Holders or within any other period of time as required for compliance.

 

The Depositary may, and shall at the written direction of the Company, terminate the Deposit Agreement and the ADR’s by mailing notice of such termination to the Holders at least 30 days prior to the date fixed in such notice for such termination. After the date so fixed for termination, the Depositary and its agents will perform no further acts under the Deposit Agreement and the ADR’s, except to receive and hold (or sell) distributions on Deposited Securities and deliver Deposited Securities being withdrawn.

 

As soon as practicable after the expiration of six months from the date so fixed for termination, the Depositary shall sell the Deposited Securities and shall thereafter (as long as it may lawfully do so) hold in a segregated account the net proceeds of such sales, together with any other cash then held by it under the Deposit Agreement, without liability for interest, in trust for the pro rata benefit of the Holders not theretofore surrendered. After making such sale, the Depositary shall be discharged from all obligations in respect of the Deposit Agreement and the ADR’s, except to advise Holders of such termination, account for such net proceeds and other cash. After the date so fixed for termination, the Company shall be discharged from all obligations under the Deposit Agreement except for its obligations to the Depositary and its agents.

 

CHARGES OF DEPOSITARY

 

The Depositary may charge each person to whom ADR’s are issued against deposits of Shares including deposits in respect of Share Distributions, Rights and Other Distributions and each person surrendering ADR’s for withdrawal of Deposited Securities, U.S. $5.00 for each 100 ADSs (or portion thereof) evidenced by the ADR’s delivered or surrendered. The Company will pay all other charges and expenses of the Depositary and any agent of the Depositary (except the Custodian) pursuant to agreements from time to time between the Company and the Depositary, except:

 

  (i) stock transfer or other taxes and other governmental charges (which are payable by Holders or persons depositing Shares),

 

  (ii) cable, telex and facsimile transmission and delivery charges incurred at the request of persons depositing, or Holders delivering Shares, ADR’s or Deposited Securities (which are payable by such persons or Holders),

 

  (iii) transfer or registration fees for the registration of transfer of Deposited Securities on any applicable register in connection with the deposit or withdrawal of Deposited Securities (which are payable by persons depositing Shares or Holders withdrawing Deposited Securities; there are no such fees in respect of the Shares as of the date of the Deposit Agreement), and

 

  (iv) expenses of the Depositary in connection with the conversion of foreign currency into U.S. dollars (which are paid out of such foreign currency).

 

57


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10D EXCHANGE CONTROLS (CONTINUED)

 

LIABILITY OF HOLDERS FOR TAXES

 

If any tax or other governmental charge shall become payable by or on behalf of the Custodian or the Depositary with respect to the ADR’s, any Deposited Securities represented by the ADSs evidenced thereby or any distribution thereon, such tax or other governmental charge shall be paid by the Holder thereof to the Depositary. The Depositary may refuse to effect any registration, registration of transfer, split-up or combination thereof or, subject to the terms and conditions of the Deposit Agreement, any withdrawal of such Deposited Securities until such payment is made.

 

The Depositary may also deduct from any distributions on or in respect of Deposited Securities, or may sell by public or private sale for the account of the Holder thereof any part or all of such Deposited Securities (after attempting by reasonable means to notify the Holder thereof prior to such sale), and may apply such deduction or the proceeds of any such sale in payment of such tax or other governmental charge, the Holder thereof remaining liable for any deficiency, and shall reduce the number of ADSs evidenced thereby to reflect any such sales of Deposited Securities.

 

In connection with any distribution to Holders, the Company will remit to the appropriate governmental authority or agency all amounts (if any) required to be withheld and owing to such authority or agency by the Company; and the Depositary and the Custodian will remit to the appropriate governmental authority or agency all amounts (if any) required to be withheld and owing to such authority or agency by the Depositary or the Custodian.

 

If the Depositary determines that any distribution in property other than cash (including Shares or rights) on Deposited Securities is subject to any tax that the Depositary or the Custodian is obligated to withhold, the Depositary may dispose of all or a portion of such property in such amounts and in such manner as the Depositary deems necessary and practicable to pay such taxes, by public or private sale, and the Depositary shall distribute the net proceeds of any such sale or the balance of any such property after deduction of such taxes to the Holders entitled thereto.

 

GENERAL LIMITATIONS

 

The Depositary, the Company, their agents and each of them shall:

 

(a) incur no liability,

 

  (i) if law, regulation, the provisions of or governing any Deposited Securities, act of God, war or other circumstance beyond its control shall prevent, delay or subject to any civil or criminal penalty any act which the Deposit Agreement or the form of ADR provides shall be done or performed by it, or

 

  (ii) by reason of any exercise or failure to exercise any discretion given it in the Deposit Agreement or the form of ADR;

 

(b) assume no liability except to perform its obligations to the extent they are specifically set forth in the ADR and the Deposit Agreement without gross negligence or bad faith;

 

(c) in the case of the Depositary and its agents, be under no obligation to appear in, prosecute or defend any action, suit or other proceeding in respect of any Deposited Securities or the ADR;

 

(d) in the case of the Company and its agents under the Deposit Agreement, be under no obligation to appear in, prosecute or defend any action, suit or other proceeding in respect of any Deposited Securities or the ADR’s, which in its opinion may involve it in expense or liability, unless indemnity satisfactory to it against all expense (including fees and disbursements of counsel) and liability be furnished as often as may be required; and

 

58


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10D EXCHANGE CONTROLS (CONTINUED)

 

GENERAL LIMITATIONS (continued)

 

(e) not be liable for any action or inaction by it in reliance upon the advice of or information from legal counsel, accountants, any person presenting Shares for deposit, any Holder, or any other person believed by it to be competent to give such advice or information. The Depositary, its agents and the Company may rely and shall be protected in acting upon any written notice, request, direction or other document believed by them to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper party or parties. The Depositary and its agents will not be responsible for any failure to carry out any instructions to vote any of the Deposited Securities (so long as any such inaction is in good faith), for the manner in which any such vote is cast (so long as any such action is in good faith) or for the effect of any such vote. The Depositary and its agents may own and deal in any class of securities of the Company and its affiliates and in ADR’s.

 

The Company has agreed to indemnify the Depositary and its agents under certain circumstances and the Depositary has agreed to indemnify the Company against losses incurred by the Company to the extent such losses are due to the negligence or bad faith of the Depositary. No disclaimer of liability under the Securities Act of 1933 is intended by any provision hereof.

 

Prior to the issue, registration, registration of transfer, split-up or combination of any ADR, the delivery of any distribution in respect thereof, or, subject to the terms and conditions of the Deposit Agreement, the withdrawal of any Deposited Securities, the Company, the Depositary or the Custodian may require:

 

(a) payment with respect thereto of

 

  (i) any stock transfer or other tax or other governmental charge,

 

  (ii) any stock transfer or registration fees in effect for the registration of transfers of Shares or other Deposited Securities upon any applicable register, and

 

  (iii) any applicable charges as provided in the form of ADR;

 

(b) the production of proof satisfactory to it of

 

  (i) the identity and genuineness of any signature, and

 

  (ii) such other information, including without limitation, information as to citizenship, residence, exchange control approval, beneficial ownership of any securities, compliance with applicable law (including, but not limited to evidence of compliance with the Corporations Act, the Banking (Foreign Exchange) Regulations or the Foreign Acquisitions and Takeovers Act 1975 of Australia), regulations, provisions of or governing Deposited Securities and terms of the Deposit Agreement and the ADR’s, as it may deem necessary or proper; and

 

(c) compliance with such regulations as the Depositary may establish consistent with the Deposit Agreement. The issuance of ADR’s, the acceptance of deposits of Shares, the registration, registration of transfer, split-up or combination of ADR’s or, subject to the terms of the Deposit Agreement, the withdrawal of Deposited Securities may be suspended, generally or in particular instances, when the ADR Register or any register for Deposited Securities is closed or when any such action is deemed advisable by the Depositary or the Company.

 

GOVERNING LAW

 

The Deposit Agreement is governed by and shall be construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York.

 

59


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10E AUSTRALIAN TAXATION

 

The following discussion outlines certain Australian tax considerations relevant to United States persons who are ADS holders or holders of Ordinary Shares. However, the discussion is by no means exhaustive of all possible Australian tax considerations.

 

The analysis below is based upon existing Australian tax law and established interpretations of that law as at the date of this report and is subject to change in Australian law, as well as any further changes to the double taxation convention between the United States and Australia (“the Treaty”), as amended by the protocol to the Treaty signed by the parties on September 27, 2001 (the “Protocol to the Treaty”), occurring after that date.

 

ADS holders and/or holders of Ordinary Shares are advised to consult their own tax advisors as to the Australian tax consequences of their ownership of the ADSs and/or Ordinary Shares.

 

TAXATION OF DISTRIBUTIONS

 

Under the Treaty, dividends paid to a shareholder of Ansell Limited who is a resident of the United States within the meaning of the Treaty, including an ADS holder who is beneficially entitled to the dividends, may be subject to Australian withholding tax at a rate not exceeding 15% of the gross dividend. The Protocol to the Treaty provides that the dividend withholding tax rate may be decreased to 5% for US corporate shareholders directly holding 10% or more of the voting power in Ansell Limited.

 

As withholding tax is a final tax, no other Australian tax is payable on the dividend. This withholding tax limitation does not apply to a shareholder whose holding is effectively connected with a permanent establishment in Australia or through which the shareholder carries on business in Australia, or in the case of a shareholder who performs independent personal services in Australia, with a “fixed base” situated in Australia.

 

Dividends paid to a non-resident of Australia will not be subject to Australian dividend withholding tax to the extent that the dividends have been franked. The concept of franking reflects that the underlying profits from which the dividends have been sourced are subject to Australian corporate income tax. No other Australian tax is payable on a fully franked dividend.

 

Any dividend withholding tax suffered on the unfranked amount of the dividend is reduced to the extent that the dividend consists of a Foreign Dividend Account amount (FDA amount).

 

A dividend will consist of an FDA amount to the extent to which it is declared to consist of an FDA amount by the corporation paying the dividend. A corporation is able to declare an FDA amount where it has a surplus in its Foreign Dividend Account at the time of paying the dividend. The main component of the Foreign Dividend Account will be tax exempt dividends received from foreign companies in which the corporation has a voting interest amounting to at least 10% of the voting power, as well as dividends received from 100% owned Australian companies to the extent they are declared to consist of an FDA amount.

 

Dividends received by a United States citizen who is resident in Australia, or a United States corporation that is resident in Australia, will be treated as assessable income for Australian income tax purposes. If the dividends are wholly or partly franked, the additional amount representing the franking credits is also included in assessable income, with a “tax offset” being available equal to the franking credits. The tax offset acts to reduce the tax liability on the dividend income. In order to be entitled to claim the tax offset in relation to the franked dividend amount, the recipient of the dividend must be a “qualified person.” Broadly, to be a qualified person, two tests must be satisfied namely the “holding period rule” and the “related payments rule.”

 

In broad terms, if individual shareholders have held the Shares at risk for 45 days (excluding the dates of acquisition and disposal), they are able to claim a tax offset for the amount of any franking credits attaching to the dividend.

 

60


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10E AUSTRALIAN TAXATION (CONTINUED)

 

Ansell Limited will provide all shareholders with a dividend notice which specifies the franked and unfranked amount of each dividend, and the amount (if any) of dividend withholding tax deducted and to the extent to which non-resident withholding tax is not payable because the dividend consists of an FDA amount.

 

The Protocol to the Treaty has amended the existing convention in a number of ways and with respect to dividends they continue to be taxable in both countries, but with changed limits on the tax that the source country may charge some types of residents of the other country who are beneficially entitled to the income. The Protocol has effect in Australia from 1 July 2003 in respect of the withholding tax on dividends, royalties and interest, and from the year of income beginning on or after 1 July 2004 in respect of Australian tax applicable to other income, profits or gains.

 

Ansell Limited declared an unfranked dividend of 11 cents a share in March 2004. The dividend is unfranked due to the increase in profit contributed by the overseas operations relative to the Australian operations (only Australian tax paid creates franking credits) and the existence of tax losses in Australia.

 

TAXATION OF FUTURE SHARE DISPOSALS

 

A United States citizen who is resident in Australia, or a United States corporation that is resident in Australia may be liable to pay Australian income tax in respect of the profit or capital gain (if any) derived upon disposal of the ADSs or Ordinary Shares.

 

No income or other tax is payable in Australia on any profit arising from the disposal of the ADSs or Ordinary Shares held by persons not resident in Australia except in the following circumstances.

 

Shares Held on Revenue Account

 

Australian tax may arise if the ADSs or Ordinary Shares are trading stock of the holder, or if an ordinary incident of the holder’s business represents the sale of securities for a profit, and, in either case, the profit is attributable to sources in Australia.

 

To the extent an amount would be included in a non-Australian tax resident holder’s assessable income under both the capital gains tax provisions and the ordinary income provisions, the capital gain amount would generally be reduced, so that the holder would not be subject to double tax on any part of the gain.

 

Non-Australian tax resident holders who are assessable under the ordinary income provisions in respect of gains made on shares held on revenue account would be assessed for such gains at the Australian tax rates for non-Australian tax residents, which start at a marginal rate of 29% for individuals. Some relief from Australian income tax may be available to such non-Australian tax resident holders under the Treaty.

 

Shares held on Capital Account

 

Australian tax may arise if the sale is subject to Australian capital gains tax. Any gain arising upon disposal by a non-resident of the ADSs or Ordinary Shares may be subject to Australian capital gains tax if the asset has the necessary connection with Australia. The ADS or ordinary shares will be taken to have the necessary connection with Australia if at any time during the period of 5 years preceding the disposal (of ADSs or Ordinary Shares acquired after 19 September 1985) the non-resident (together with associates, if any) owns or owned 10% or more of the issued capital of Ansell Limited.

 

According to Australian income tax law, a taxpayer makes a capital gain if the capital proceeds they receive on the disposal of shares exceed the cost base of those Shares. If the capital proceeds received on disposal are less than the reduced cost base, the taxpayer makes a capital loss.

 

The cost base and reduced cost base of any Share is generally the amount paid to acquire the share plus any associated costs incurred (e.g. brokerage fees). Cost base adjustments may be required (and capital gains may arise) should a distribution representing a return of capital or certain other non-assessable amounts be paid.

 

61


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10E AUSTRALIAN TAXATION (CONTINUED)

 

Where a taxpayer makes a capital gain, they must include the “net capital gain” in their Australian taxable income (in the income year in which the disposal occurred). The net capital gain is calculated as the current year capital gain less any current year or prior year unused Australian capital losses. Current or prior year Australian revenue losses may also be offset against net capital gains. Capital losses cannot be offset against other Australian sourced taxable income.

 

Australian capital gains tax is generally imposed at a taxpayer’s normal rate of tax, which starts at a marginal tax rate of 29% for non-Australian tax resident individuals.

 

A further reduction in the amount included in the taxpayer’s taxable income in respect of a net capital gain may apply for certain shareholders if the Shares had been held for 12 months or more. For individuals (whether the Shares were held by the individual directly or indirectly through a trust) the rate of discount is 50%. Capital losses must be applied to calculate a net capital gain before applying the discount capital gains tax provisions.

 

Treaty

 

These two exceptions are also subject to the operation of the Treaty between Australia and the United States, which may affect Australia’s right to tax non-residents of Australia who hold ADSs or Ordinary Shares. Owners of ADSs and Ordinary Shares are advised to consult their own tax advisors as to the tax consequences of the operation of the Treaty.

 

Dual Residency

 

If a shareholder were a resident of both Australia and another country under those countries’ domestic taxation laws, that shareholder may be subject to tax as an Australian resident. Owners of ADSs and Ordinary Shares should obtain specialist taxation advice in these circumstances.

 

International Tax Reform

 

For completeness, as part of Australia’s reform of international tax arrangements, the Australian Government will examine the feasibility of a more targeted capital gains tax exemption for capital gains on the disposal by non-residents of some or all of their non-portfolio interests in Australian companies, to the extent the capital gains has an underlying foreign source. At this stage, it is uncertain as to whether any such exemption will be introduced.

 

OTHER TAXES

 

No Australian State or Federal estate duty or other inheritance taxes will be payable in respect of ADSs or Ordinary Shares upon the death of the holder thereof, regardless of the holder’s domicile. For capital gains purposes, the death of the holder will not produce a deemed disposal, except if the ADSs or ordinary shares are bequeathed to a tax exempt entity or to a beneficiary who is not an Australian resident. In all other circumstances, the liability for tax on any gain is effectively transferred to the deceased’s legal representatives or beneficiaries for payment following disposal of the ADSs or Ordinary Shares by that person, subject to those matters referred to above. A deemed disposal or a disposal subsequently by the beneficiary will have the consequences set out above.

 

STAMP DUTY

 

No Australian stamp duty will be payable on the acquisition of ADSs or on any subsequent transfer of an ADS, provided that the ADR evidencing such ADS remains at all times outside Australia, that the instrument of transfer is not executed in Australia and remains at all times outside Australia, and that the Depository and the Custodian maintain no register of ADSs in Australia.

 

No stamp duty is payable on a transfer of Ordinary Shares, whilst the Ordinary Shares are quoted on the Australian Stock Exchange (ASX) or a recognised stock exchange. If the Ordinary Shares cease to be quoted on the ASX or a recognised exchange, any transfer of Ordinary Shares will ordinarily be subject to stamp duty at the rate of 0.6% of the consideration paid or the unencumbered value of the shares at the time of such transfer. Such stamp duty will need to be paid prior to the transfer of the Ordinary Shares being registered by Ansell Limited.

 

If the transfer of Ordinary Shares is effected by stockbrokers on the Australian Stock Exchange, each of the transferor and the transferee will be required to pay half of the stamp duty payable. If the transfer of the Ordinary

 

62


PART I

 

Item 10 : Additional Information

 

10E AUSTRALIAN TAXATION (CONTINUED)

 

Shares is not effected by stockbrokers on the Australian Stock Exchange, the transferee of the Ordinary Shares will generally be required to pay the stamp duty payable.

 

AUSTRALIAN FOREIGN SOURCE INCOME RULES

 

Australia has a dual foreign tax credit/exemption system for relief from double taxation of dividends, whereby dividends received from foreign companies are either fully taxable in Australia, (with a credit available for both the foreign withholding tax paid and the income tax paid by the companies on their underlying profits) or exempt (with no foreign tax credit). Further, the taxation of the income of Ansell Limited’s foreign subsidiaries may be affected by the provisions of Australia’s Controlled Foreign Companies (CFC) legislation.

 

Under the Australian CFC provisions, income earned by foreign subsidiaries in certain specified countries, being “comparably taxed” countries generally would be exempt from Australian tax. However, certain forms of income earned by foreign subsidiaries in all other countries could be “attributed” to Ansell Limited or its Australian subsidiaries and be subject to Australian tax on an accruals basis, with a foreign tax credit available for relief from double taxation. This accruals-based system does, however, provide exemptions for foreign subsidiaries, which are engaged predominantly in an active business.

 

All non-portfolio dividends (i.e. a dividend paid to a company where that company holds 10% or more of the voting power in the dividend paying company) received from comparable tax countries and certain other countries on the limited exemption list are exempt from Australian tax. However, with effect from 1 July 2004, the exemption for foreign sourced non-portfolio dividends and certain foreign branch profits received by Australian companies and CFCs has been extended to cover profits repatriated from all listed and unlisted countries. Because these dividends are exempt, no credit is allowed for foreign taxes paid. Otherwise, dividends received from other countries will generally be taxed in Australia, with a foreign tax credit available for relief from double taxation for foreign taxes paid.

 

International Tax Reform

 

As part of the international tax reform process, a number of measures have also been legislated recently dealing with reforming Australia’s CFC measures. Specifically, Australian companies and their subsidiaries will be exempt from capital gains on the sale of non-portfolio interests in foreign companies which have underlying active business. The Australian Government also removed the obligation to attribute certain income of CFCs operating in comparable-tax countries (by introducing an exemption) and in relation to certain service income of CFCs.

 

The capital gains exemption applies from 1 April 2004 and applies to specified capital gains tax events relating to shares in foreign companies occurring after that date. The other CFC measure applies from 1 July 2004 and applies in relation to statutory accounting periods of CFCs beginning on or after that date.

 

10F DIVIDENDS AND PAYING AGENTS

 

Not Applicable

 

10G STATEMENT BY EXPERTS

 

Not Applicable

 

10H DOCUMENTS ON DISPLAY

 

The documents referred to in this report can be inspected at the Company’s Head Office at 678 Victoria Street, Richmond, Victoria, Australia.

 

10I SUBSIDIARY INFORMATION

 

Not Applicable

 

63


PART I

 

Item 11 : Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

 

The Company uses derivative financial instruments, principally foreign exchange and interest rate related, to reduce its exposure to movements in foreign exchange rate and interest rate movements.

 

The Company has adopted certain principles in relation to derivative financial instruments:

 

(i) it does not trade in a derivative that is not used in the hedging of an underlying business exposure of the Company;

 

(ii) derivatives acquired must be able to be recorded on the Company’s treasury management systems, which contain extensive internal controls; and

 

(iii) the Company does not deal with counter-parties rated lower than A- by Standard and Poor’s or A3 by Moody’s Investors Service for any overnight transactions.

 

The Company follows the same credit policies, legal processes, monitoring of market and operational risks in the area of derivative financial instruments, as they do in relation to financial assets and liabilities on the Statement of Financial Position, where internal controls operate.

 

The Company is involved in a range of derivative financial instruments, which can be defined in the following broad categories:

 

(i) Forward / Future Contracts

 

These transactions enable the Company to buy or sell specific amounts of foreign exchange, financial instruments or commodities at an agreed rate/price at a specified future date. Maturities of these contracts are principally between six months and two years.

 

(ii) Options

 

This is a contract between two parties, which gives the buyer of a put or call option the right, but not the obligation, to transact at a specified interest rate/exchange rate or commodity price at a future date, generally for a premium. Maturities of these contracts are principally between three months and two years.

 

(iii) Swaps

 

These agreements enable parties to swap interest rate (from or to a fixed or floating basis) or currency (from one currency to another currency) positions for a defined period of time. Maturities of the contracts are principally between two and five years.

 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS HELD OR ISSUED FOR PURPOSES OTHER THAN TRADING

 

Gains and losses on derivatives used as hedges are accounted for on the same basis as the underlying physical exposures they hedge. Accordingly, hedge gains and losses are included in the Statement of Financial Performance when the gain or loss arising on the related physical exposures are recognised in the Statement of Financial Performance.

 

When hedging an underlying interest rate exposure, with a derivative financial instrument, all gains and losses are accounted for on an accrual basis, thereby adjusting the underlying physical cost to the hedged rate over the life of the transaction. Gains or losses resulting from the termination of an interest rate swap contract where the underlying borrowing remains, are deferred on the Statement of Financial Position and then amortised over the life of the borrowing. Where the transaction is a single event, such as a foreign exchange exposure, the hedge gain or loss is taken to account on the actual exposure date.

 

Gains and losses on derivative financial instruments which hedge transactions are in the first instance deferred and later recognised in the Statement of Financial Performance when the hedged transaction occurs. Such deferrals only occur where the future transaction remains assured. Where a transaction is modified or extinguished any associated derivative financial instrument is also modified or extinguished and any gain or loss that no longer relates to an exposure is immediately taken to the Statement of Financial Performance.

 

64


PART I

 

Item 11 : Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS HELD OR ISSUED FOR TRADING PURPOSES

 

The Company and the consolidated entity do not trade in derivative financial instruments or hold them for speculative purposes.

 

FUTURE TRANSACTIONS

 

On a continuing basis, the Company monitors its future exposures and on some occasions hedges all or part of these exposures. The transactions that may be covered are future cash flows of overseas controlled entities and future foreign exchange requirements.

 

These exposures are then monitored and may be modified from time to time. These transactions predominantly do not exceed 12 months duration and hedge transactions the Company expects to occur in this time frame.

 

The following table shows the Company’s deferred gains and (losses), both realised and unrealised, that are currently held on the Statement of Financial Position and the expected timing of recognition as revenue or expense:

 

     Interest Rate

   Foreign Exchange

 

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

    2003

   2002

 

Exposures

                                

Less than 1 year

   —      —      —      (0.1 )   1.9    (0.5 )

Realized Swaps Deferred

                                

Less than 1 year

   0.7    0.4    0.1    —       —      —    

1 to 2 years

   0.7    0.8    0.7    —       —      —    

2 to 5 years

   4.9    0.9    2.2    —       —      —    

Greater than 5 years

   —      —      —      —       —      —    

 

65


PART I

 

Item 11 : Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

 

INTEREST RATE RISK

 

The Company’s exposure to interest rate risk and the effective weighted average interest rate for classes of financial assets and financial liabilities is set out below:

 

$ in millions


   Weighted
Average
Effective
Interest
Rate


    Floating

    Interest Rate Fixed
Maturities


   Non
Interest
Bearing


   Total

       1 year
or less


    1 to 5
years (1)


    Over 5
years


     

Net Financial Assets/(Liabilities) 2004

     %                                

Financial Assets

                                      

On-Balance Sheet

                                      

Cash on hand and at bank

   1.1 %   20.5     —       —       —      50.2    70.7

Short-term deposits

   4.8 %   231.8     —       15.6     —      —      247.4

Receivables – trade

   N/A     —       —       —       —      183.0    183.0

Receivables – other

   6.1 %   62.8     —       —       —      46.5    109.3

Investments (excl. associated companies)

   N/A     —       —       —       —      141.4    141.4
          

 

 

 
  
  

Total Financial Assets 2004

         315.1     —       15.6     —      421.1    751.8
          

 

 

 
  
  

Financial Liabilities

                                      

Recognised

                                      

Payables – trade

   N/A     —       —       —       —      124.1    124.1

Payables – other

   N/A     —       —       —       —      38.6    38.6

Bank overdraft

   1.5 %   3.3     —       —       —      —      3.3

Bank and other loans

   5.6 %   321.2     —       101.7     —      —      422.9

Provisions (including certain employee entitlements)

   N/A     —       —       —       —      41.0    41.0

Unrecognised

                                      

Net interest rate swaps

   2.0 %   (147.4 )   121.1     26.3     —      —      —  
          

 

 

 
  
  

Total Financial Liabilities 2004

         177.1     121.1     128.0     —      203.7    629.9
          

 

 

 
  
  

Net Financial Assets/(Liabilities) 2004

         138.0     (121.1 )   (112.4 )   —      217.4    121.9
          

 

 

 
  
  

Net Financial Assets/(Liabilities) 2003

                                      

Financial Assets

                                      

Recognised

                                      

Cash on hand and at bank

   1.3 %   61.4     —       —       —      —      61.4

Short-term deposits

   3.9 %   238.4     —       —       —      —      238.4

Receivables – trade

   N/A     —       —       —       —      197.5    197.5

Receivables – other

   5.4 %   62.7     —       —       —      59.2    121.9

Investments (excl. associated companies)

   N/A     —       —       —       —      141.4    141.4
          

 

 

 
  
  

Total Financial Assets 2003

         362.5     —       —       —      398.1    760.6
          

 

 

 
  
  

Financial Liabilities

                                      

Recognised

                                      

Payables – trade

   N/A     —       —       —       —      130.1    130.1

Payables – other

   N/A     —       —       —       —      27.5    27.5

Bank overdraft

   3.2 %   1.3     —       —       —      1.3    2.6

Bank and other loans

   6.4 %   370.0     24.2     75.0     —      —      469.2

Provisions (including certain employee entitlements)

   N/A     —       —       —       —      39.4    39.4

Unrecognised

                                      

Net interest rate swaps

   2.5 %   (319.4 )   168.8     150.6     —      —      —  
          

 

 

 
  
  

Total Financial Liabilities 2003

         51.9     193.0     225.6     —      198.3    668.8
          

 

 

 
  
  

Net Financial Assets/(Liabilities) 2003

         310.6     (193.0 )   (225.6 )   —      199.8    91.8
          

 

 

 
  
  

 

(1) Analysis of Fixed Rate Maturities 1 to 5 years

 

     1-2 yrs

   2-3 yrs

   3-4 yrs

   4-5 yrs

   Total

2004

                        

Bank & Other Loans

   101.7    —      —      —      101.7

Net Interest Rate Swaps

   26.3    —      —      —      26.3
    
  
  
  
  
     128.0    —      —      —      128.0
    
  
  
  
  

2003

                        

Bank & Other Loans

   75.0    —      —      —      75.0

Net Interest Rate Swaps

   123.5    —      27.1    —      150.6
    
  
  
  
  
     198.5    —      27.1    —      225.6
    
  
  
  
  

 

66


PART I

 

Item 11 : Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

 

INTEREST RATE RISK (continued)

 

Provisions, including amounts contained within income tax, deferred income tax, contingencies, rationalisation and restructure, Accufix Pacing Lead related expenses and insurance claims amounting to $57.7 million (2003 – $64.4 million; 2002 - $86.5 million) are not included within the table above as it is considered that they do not meet the definition of a financial instrument.

 

A separate analysis of debt by currency can be found at Note 19 to the Financial Statements – Interest Bearing Liabilities.

 

CREDIT RISK AND NET FAIR VALUE

 

Recognised Financial Instruments

 

(i) Credit Risk

 

The credit risk on financial assets, excluding investments, of the Company which have been recognised on the Statement of Financial Position, is the carrying amount, net of any provision for doubtful debts. The Company minimises concentrations of credit risk by undertaking transactions with a large number of customers and counter parties in various countries.

 

The Company is not materially exposed to any individual overseas country or individual customer.

 

(ii) Net Fair Value

 

The Company considers that the carrying amount of recognised financial assets and financial liabilities approximates their net fair value.

 

Unrecognised Financial Instruments

 

Credit risk on unrecognised derivative contracts is minimised, as counterparties are recognised financial intermediaries with acceptable credit ratings determined by a recognised rating agency. It is not felt that there is a material exposure to any single counterparty or group of counterparties. The Company’s exposure is almost entirely (over 99%) to banks.

 

67


PART I

 

Item 11 : Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

 

CREDIT RISK AND NET FAIR VALUE (continued)

 

The following table displays:

 

(i) Face Value:

 

This is the contract’s value upon which a market rate is applied to produce a gain or loss, which becomes the settlement value of the derivative financial instrument.

 

(ii) Credit Risk:

 

This is the maximum exposure to the Company in the event that all counterparties who have amounts outstanding to the Company under derivative financial instruments, fail to honour their side of the contracts. The Company’s exposure is almost entirely to banks (see (v) below). Amounts owed by the Company under derivative financial instruments are not included.

 

(iii) Net Fair Value:

 

This is the amount at which the instrument could be extinguished between willing parties in a normal market in other than a liquidation or forced sale environment. The net amount owed by / (owing to) financial institutions under all derivative financial instruments would have been $1.6 million (2003 - $(11.1) million, 2002 – ($23.8) million) if all contracts were closed out on 30 June 2004.

 

     Face Value

   Credit Risk

   Net Fair Value

 

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Foreign Exchange Contracts

                                                

Purchase/Sale Contracts:

                                                

-U.S. dollars

   77.0    112.0    329.7    0.4    0.3    1.6    0.2     (0.4 )   (7.3 )

-Australian dollars

   22.0    47.5    49.4    —      1.8    —      —       1.8     —    

-Other currencies

   33.4    44.8    216.5    0.2    —      2.5    0.1     (0.9 )   2.4  

Cross Currency Swaps:

                                                

-U.S. dollars

   53.8    69.4    96.5    1.9    2.7    2.2    1.9     2.7     (1.5 )

-Other Currencies

   —      —      16.5    —      —      —      —       —       (2.1 )

Foreign Exchange Options

                                                

Zero Cost Collar:

                                                

-Euro/U.S. dollars

   193.5    103.5    —      2.2    0.8    —      0.7     (2.6 )   —    

Premium Paid (put)

                                                

-Euro/U.S. dollars:

   —      19.8    —      —      0.2    —      —       0.2     —    

Interest Rate Contracts

                                                

Interest Rate Swaps:

                                                

-U.S. dollars

   141.0    369.4    435.1    0.4    0.3    3.0    (1.2 )   (10.9 )   (14.5 )

-Australian dollars

   50.0    100.0    300.0    —      —      —      (0.1 )   (1.0 )   (0.8 )

-Other currencies

   —      —      17.5    —      —      —      —       —       —    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  

 

 

Total

   570.7    866.4    1,461.2    5.1    6.1    9.3    1.6     (11.1 )   (23.8 )
    
  
  
  
  
  
  

 

 

 

From time to time in the ordinary course of business, the Company enters into forward exchange contracts to hedge a proportion of anticipated purchase and sale commitments denominated in foreign currencies (principally US dollars). The amount of anticipated future purchases and sales is forecast in light of current market conditions and commitments from customers. Hedge contracts are used to cover the next available trading exposure until all contracts are fully utilised. Hedge cover generally does not exceed 3 months.

 

(iv) Market/Liquidity Risk:

 

The Company seeks to reduce the risk of:

 

(a) being forced to exit derivative financial instrument positions at below their real worth; or

 

(b) finding it cannot exit the position at all, due to lack of liquidity in the market;

 

By:

 

(a) dealing only in liquid contracts dealt by many counterparties; and

 

(b) dealing only in large and highly liquid and stable international markets.

 

68


PART I

 

Item 11 : Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

 

CREDIT RISK AND NET FAIR VALUE (continued)

 

(v) Credit Risk by Maturity:

 

The following table indicates the value of amounts owing by counterparties by maturity. Based on the Group policy of not having overnight exposures to an entity rated lower than A- by Standard & Poor’s or A3 by Moody’s Investors Service, it is felt the risk to the Company of the counterparty default loss is not material.

 

     Foreign Exchange
Related Contracts


   Interest Rate
Contracts


   Foreign Exchange
Options


   Total

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

   2003

   2002

Term

                                                           

0 to 6 mths

   0.6    2.1    4.1    —      0.3    —      1.1    0.4    —      1.7    2.8    4.1

6 to 12 mths

   0.1    —      —      —      —      —      1.1    0.6    —      1.2    0.6    —  

1 to 2 yrs

   —      0.2    —      —      —      3.0    —      —      —      —      0.2    3.0

2 to 5 yrs

   1.8    2.5    2.2    0.4    —      —      —      —      —      2.2    2.5    2.2

5 to 10 yrs

   —      —      —      —      —      —      —      —      —      —      —      —  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  

Total

   2.5    4.8    6.3    0.4    0.3    3.0    2.2    1.0    —      5.1    6.1    9.3
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  

 

(vi) Historical Rate Rollovers:

 

It is the Company’s policy not to engage in historical rate rollovers except in circumstances where the maturity date falls on a bank holiday. In these instances, settlement occurs on the next trading day.

 

69


PART I

 

Item 12 : Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities

 

Not Applicable

 

70


PART II

 

Item 13 : Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies

 

Not Applicable

 

71


PART II

 

Item 14 : Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders

 

Not Applicable

 

72


PART II

 

Item 15 : Controls and Procedures

 

Not Applicable

 

73


PART II

 

Item 16

 

16A AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT

 

The Company’s Board of Directors has determined that Mr. L.D. Crandall, a member of the Company’s Audit Committee, is a financial expert and is independent as that term is defined.

 

16B CODE OF ETHICS

 

The Company has adopted a Code of Conduct which applies to Directors, executives, management and employees. The Code of Conduct is posted on the Company’s website – refer to Item 6C Board Practices for further details.

 

16C PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

 

  (a) Audit Fees

 

Audit and Review of Financial Reports

($ in Thousands)


   Consolidated

   The
Company


   2004

   2003

   2004

   2003

Auditors of Ansell Limited and Australian entities – KPMG

   1,013    1,183    927    983

Other Member firms of KPMG

   1,423    1,661    —      —  
    
  
  
  

Total

   2,436    2,844    927    983
    
  
  
  

 

  (b) Audit-Related Fees

 

Other Audit and Assurance Services (including disposals and

acquisitions) ($ in Thousands)


   Consolidated

   The
Company


   2004

   2003

   2004

   2003

Auditors of Ansell Limited and Australian entities – KPMG (1)

   131    259    131    90

Other Member firms of KPMG (2)

   77    78    —      —  
    
  
  
  

Total

   208    337    131    90
    
  
  
  

 

(1) Includes audit of local statutory accounts and Ansell’s US GAAP financial statements and audit of a warranty claim.

 

(2) Includes the audit of defined benefit pension plans in the USA and the audit of local statutory accounts of foreign subsidiaries.

 

  (c) Tax Fees

 

Taxation and Other Services

($ in Thousands)


   Consolidated

   The
Company


   2004

   2003

   2004

   2003

Auditors of Ansell Limited and Australian entities – KPMG

   40    32    40    32

Other Member firms of KPMG

   150    90    —      —  
    
  
  
  

Total

   190    122    40    32
    
  
  
  

Represents fees for tax compliance services in respect of statutory lodgements.

 

  (d) All Other Fees

 

     Consolidated

   The
Company


($ in Thousands)


   2004

   2003

   2004

   2003

Auditors of Ansell Limited and Australian entities – KPMG

   —      —      —      —  

Other Member firms of KPMG

   —      —      —      —  
    
  
  
  

Total

   —      —      —      —  
    
  
  
  

 

  (e) The Audit Committee is required to approve in advance all audit and non-audit services provided by the Company’s external auditors. Non-audit services that are perceived to be materially in conflict with the role of auditor, should not be provided by the external auditor. These services are expected to include investigations and consulting advice and subcontracting of operational activities normally undertaken by management and where the external auditor may ultimately be required to express an opinion on its own work.

 

  (f) Not applicable.

 

74


PART II

 

Item 16

 

16D EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES

 

Not Applicable

 

16E PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER

 

Period


   Total
Number of
Shares
Purchased


  

Average
Price Paid
per Share

$A


   Total Number of
Shares Purchased as
Part of Publicly
Announced Plans or
Programs


   Maximum Number
of Shares that May
Yet Be Purchased
Under the Plans or
Programs


1 July – 31 July 2003

   504,923    5.82    504,923    12,086,657

1 August – 31 August 2003

   249,220    6.22    249,220    11,837,437

1 September – 30 September 2003

   459,537    6.72    459,537    11,377,900

1 October – 31 October 2003

   459,234    6.86    459,234    10,918,666

1 November – 30 November 2003

   1,303,541    6.82    1,303,541    9,615,125

1 December – 31 December 2003

   2,538,783    6.39    2,538,783    7,076,342

1 January – 31 January 2004

   2,393,205    6.41    2,393,205    4,683,137

1 February – 29 February 2004

   636,168    6.41    636,168    4,046,969

1 March – 31 March 2004

   682,653    6.99    682,653    3,364,316

1 April – 30 April 2004

   563,500    7.05    563,500    2,800,816

1 May – 31 May 2004

   192,757    7.43    192,757    11,807,243

1 June – 30 June 2004

   5,531    7.50    5,531    11,801,712
    
  
  
    

Total

   9,989,052    6.46    9,989,052     
    
  
  
    

 

The Company announced on 16 April 2003 that it would undertake an on-market buy-back of up to 10 million shares. As at 30 June 2003 the Company had bought back 1,408,420 shares. During fiscal year 2004 the on-market buyback was extended by up to a further 4 million shares with 9,790,764 shares being acquired between 1 July 2003 and 30 April 2004 when purchases ceased under this program.

 

On 3 May 2004, the Company announced that it would undertake a further on-market buy-back of up to 12 million shares over the following 12 month period. As at 30 June 2004, the Company had bought back 198,288 shares under this program. Purchase of shares under this program were suspended while consideration was given to an alternative off-market buy-back proposal.

 

On 10 August 2004 the Company announced that the Board was considering a proposal for an off-market buy-back of 17 million shares. The off-market buy-back proposal was approved by shareholders at the Company’s Annual General Meeting on 14 October 2004.

 

75


PART II

 

Item 17 : Financial Statements

 

Not Applicable

 

76


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE

 

of Ansell Limited and its Controlled Entities as at 30 June 2004

 

           Consolidated

 
     Note

   

2004

$m


   

2003

$m


   

2002

$m


 

Revenue

                        

Total revenue

   3     1,131.1     1,320.1     3,190.4  

Expenses

                        

Cost of goods sold

         662.1     830.4     1,493.3  

Selling, distribution and administration

         289.8     310.3     504.8  

Depreciation and amortisation

         46.7     56.5     82.3  

Write-down of assets

         9.8     6.1     176.5  

Net assets of businesses disposed

         —       —       922.4  

Other

   4 (b)   —       —       —    
          

 

 

Total expenses, excluding borrowing costs

         1,008.4     1,203.3     3,179.3  

Borrowing costs

   4 (a)   29.4     37.8     70.2  

Share of net profit of associates and joint venture entities

   38     —       0.3     1.9  
          

 

 

Profit/(loss) from ordinary activities before income tax expense

         93.3     79.3     (57.2 )

Income tax expense/(benefit) attributable to ordinary activities

   8     20.7     26.8     55.8  
          

 

 

Net profit/(loss) from ordinary activities after income tax expense

         72.6     52.5     (113.0 )

Outside equity interests in net profit after income tax

   10     1.9     2.6     2.8  
          

 

 

Net profit/(loss) after income tax attributable to Ansell Limited shareholders

   6     70.7     49.9     (115.8 )
          

 

 

Non-owner transaction changes in equity

                        

Net exchange difference on translation of financial statements of self-sustaining foreign operations

   6     (7.4 )   (71.3 )   (69.6 )
          

 

 

Total valuation adjustments attributable to Ansell Limited shareholders recognised directly in equity

         (7.4 )   (71.3 )   (69.6 )
          

 

 

Total changes in equity from non-owner related transactions attributable to Ansell Limited shareholders

   7     63.3     (21.4 )   (185.4 )
          

 

 

Earnings/(loss) per share is based on net profit/(loss) after income tax attributable to Ansell Limited shareholders

                        
           cents

    cents

    cents

 

Basic earnings per share

   35     39.1     26.7     (61.9 )

Diluted earnings per share

   35     39.0     26.6     (61.7 )

 

The above statements of financial performance should be read in conjunction with the accompanying notes.

 

77


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION

 

of Ansell Limited and its Controlled Entities as at 30 June 2004

 

          Consolidated

 
     Note

  

2004

$m


   

2003

$m


   

2002

$m


 

Current Assets

                       

Cash assets

   11    307.8     286.0     258.5  

Cash assets - restricted deposits

   11    10.3     13.8     18.4  

Receivables

   12    228.7     262.4     293.7  

Inventories

   13    190.5     187.9     235.1  

Prepayments

        11.7     10.9     15.8  
         

 

 

Total Current Assets

        749.0     761.0     821.5  
         

 

 

Non-Current Assets

                       

Receivables

   12    63.6     57.0     66.7  

Investments accounted for using the equity method

   14    —       —       13.3  

Other financial assets

   14    141.4     141.4     145.8  

Property, plant and equipment

   15    227.8     262.9     332.5  

Intangible assets

   16    293.4     324.5     403.2  

Deferred tax assets

   17    24.2     32.0     49.7  

Other

        —       —       —    
         

 

 

Total Non-Current Assets

        750.4     817.8     1,011.2  
         

 

 

Total Assets

        1,499.4     1,578.8     1,832.7  
         

 

 

Current Liabilities

                       

Payables

   18    159.4     154.4     192.7  

Interest bearing liabilities

   19    190.2     151.8     107.6  

Provisions

   20    52.0     57.5     85.4  

Current tax liabilities

   20    2.6     3.1     1.9  

Other

   21    —       1.1     1.2  
         

 

 

Total Current Liabilities

        404.2     367.9     388.8  
         

 

 

Non-Current Liabilities

                       

Payables

   18    3.3     3.2     3.7  

Interest bearing liabilities

   19    236.0     320.0     516.5  

Provisions

   20    23.9     21.7     23.3  

Deferred tax liabilities

   20    20.2     21.5     24.4  
         

 

 

Total Non-Current Liabilities

        283.4     366.4     567.9  
         

 

 

Total Liabilities

        687.6     734.3     956.7  
         

 

 

Net Assets

        811.8     844.5     876.0  
         

 

 

Equity

                       

Contributed equity

   5    1,383.9     1,448.3     1,455.5  

Reserves

   6    (275.6 )   (268.9 )   (176.2 )

Accumulated losses

   6    (306.7 )   (345.7 )   (417.0 )
         

 

 

Total equity attributable to Ansell Limited shareholders

        801.6     833.7     862.3  

Outside equity interests

   10    10.2     10.8     13.7  
         

 

 

Total Equity

        811.8     844.5     876.0  
         

 

 

 

The above statements of financial position should be read in conjunction with the accompanying notes.

 

78


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

of Ansell Limited and its Controlled Entities for the year ended 30 June 2004

 

           Consolidated

 
     Note

   

2004

$m


   

2003

$m


   

2002

$m


 

Cash Flows Related to Operating Activities

                        

Receipts from customers (excluding non-recurring and Accufix Research Institute)

         1,155.9     1,357.0     2,356.5  

Payments to suppliers and employees (excluding non-recurring and Accufix Research Institute)

         (950.6 )   (1,159.9 )   (2,124.8 )
          

 

 

Net receipts from customers (excluding non-recurring and Accufix Research Institute)

         205.3     197.1     231.7  

Income taxes paid

         (15.9 )   (8.6 )   (25.5 )

Dividends received

         —       2.6     0.3  
          

 

 

Net cash provided by Operating Activities (excluding non-recurring and Accufix Research Institute)

         189.4     191.1     206.5  

Non-recurring payments to suppliers and employees

         (7.1 )   (26.8 )   (82.7 )

Payments to suppliers and employees net of customer receipts

                        

(Accufix Research Institute)

         (3.1 )   (2.7 )   (10.7 )
          

 

 

Net Cash (Used in)/Provided by Operating Activities

   31 (a)   179.2     161.6     113.1  
          

 

 

Cash Flows Related to Investing Activities

                        

Payments for businesses, net of cash acquired

         —       —       (40.9 )

Payments for property, plant and equipment

         (13.8 )   (15.4 )   (34.3 )

Proceeds from sale of businesses, net of cash disposed

         —       —       936.4  

Proceeds from sale of plant and equipment in the ordinary course of business

         5.3     6.1     12.1  

Loans repaid

         3.4     4.2     1.2  

Proceeds from sale of other investments

         —       9.1     —    

Payments for other investments

         (1.3 )   —       —    
          

 

 

Net Cash (Used in)/Provided by Investing Activities

         (6.4 )   4.0     874.5  
          

 

 

Cash Flows Related to Financing Activities

                        

Proceeds from borrowings

         104.3     7.8     737.0  

Repayments of borrowings

         (140.9 )   (86.9 )   (1,673.9 )
          

 

 

Net repayments of borrowings

         (36.6 )   (79.1 )   (936.9 )

Proceeds from issues of shares

         1.0     1.0     1.2  

Payments for share buy-back

         (65.4 )   (8.2 )   —    

Dividends paid

         (32.7 )   (1.7 )   (48.3 )

Interest received

         9.0     8.0     13.1  

Interest and borrowing costs paid

         (28.7 )   (37.8 )   (70.2 )
          

 

 

Net Cash (Used in)/Provided by Financing Activities

         (153.4 )   (117.8 )   (1,041.1 )
          

 

 

Net (Decrease)/Increase in Cash Held

         19.4     47.8     (53.5 )

Cash at the beginning of the financial year

         297.2     262.3     328.4  

Effects of exchange rate changes on the balances of cash held in foreign currencies at the beginning of the financial year

         (1.8 )   (12.9 )   (12.6 )
          

 

 

Cash at the End of the Financial Year

   31 (b)   314.8     297.2     262.3  
          

 

 

 

The above statements of cash flows should be read in conjunction with the accompanying notes.

 

79


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

INDUSTRY SEGMENTS

 

of Ansell Limited and its Controlled Entities for the year ended 30 June 2004

 

     Operating Revenue

   Operating Result

 
    

2004

$m


  

2003

$m


  

2002

$m


  

2004

$m


    2003
$m


   

2002

$m


 

INDUSTRY

                                 

Ansell Healthcare

                                 

Occupational Healthcare

   545.2    624.9    640.2    74.2     62.9     37.0  

Professional Healthcare

   381.8    452.6    546.9    40.5     53.9     92.7  

Consumer Healthcare

   186.3    216.1    227.1    31.6     42.8     32.6  
    
  
  
  

 

 

Total Ansell Healthcare

   1,113.3    1,293.6    1,414.2    146.3     159.6     162.3  

Unallocated Items

   17.8    26.5    27.9    (13.1 )   (22.4 )   (27.7 )
                   

 

 

                    133.2     137.2     134.6  

Discontinued Businesses

                                 

Trading

             808.6                61.0  
                   

 

 

Operating EBITA

                  133.2     137.2     195.6  

NON RECURRING

                                 

Discontinued Businesses

                                 

Net gain on sale of interests in Associated Companies

                        5.5        

Proceeds/Net gain on sale of

                                 

Controlled Entities and Businesses

             939.7                25.7  

Other

                  17.8              

Rationalisation/Restructuring

                                 

Ansell Healthcare

                        (4.6 )   (11.6 )

Other

                  (9.7 )   (5.5 )   (6.5 )

Write-down of assets

                                 

Ansell Healthcare

                  (8.8 )         (63.1 )

Exide Investment

                              (99.9 )

Other

                  (1.0 )   (1.5 )   (13.5 )
                   

 

 

                    131.5     131.1     26.7  

Goodwill amortisation

                  (21.4 )   (25.3 )   (29.2 )
                   

 

 

Earnings before Net Interest and Tax (EBIT)

                  110.1     105.8     (2.5 )

Borrowing Costs net of Interest Revenue

                  (16.8 )   (26.5 )   (54.7 )
                   

 

 

Operating Profit before Tax

                  93.3     79.3     (57.2 )

Tax

                  (20.7 )   (26.8 )   (55.8 )

Outside Equity Interests

                  (1.9 )   (2.6 )   (2.8 )
    
  
  
  

 

 

Total Consolidated

   1,131.1    1,320.1    3,190.4    70.7     49.9     (115.8 )
    
  
  
  

 

 

REGIONS

                                 

Asia Pacific

   168.2    173.7    170.7    41.4     35.9     32.9  

Americas

   544.7    656.0    799.5    65.0     80.2     99.1  

Europe

   400.4    463.9    444.0    39.9     43.5     30.3  
    
  
  
  

 

 

Total Ansell Healthcare

   1,113.3    1,293.6    1,414.2    146.3     159.6     162.3  
    
  
  
  

 

 

     Assets Employed

   Liabilities

 
    

2004

$m


  

2003

$m


  

2002

$m


  

2004

$m


    2003
$m


    2002
$m


 

INDUSTRY

                                 

Ansell Healthcare

                                 

Occupational Healthcare

   274.8    284.4    353.8    96.1     90.0     105.2  

Professional Healthcare

   277.4    310.8    376.6    68.1     63.9     81.5  

Consumer Healthcare

   110.4    111.5    135.3    37.2     39.4     44.3  
    
  
  
  

 

 

Total Ansell Healthcare

   662.6    706.7    865.7    201.4     193.3     231.0  

Unallocated Items

   15.6    24.8    34.3    463.8     512.7     682.5  

Discontinued Businesses

   209.7    223.0    252.6    22.4     28.3     43.2  

Goodwill and Brand names

   293.4    324.5    403.2                   

Cash

   318.1    299.8    276.9                   
    
  
  
  

 

 

Total Consolidated

   1,499.4    1,578.8    1,832.7    687.6     734.3     956.7  
    
  
  
  

 

 

REGIONS

                                 

Asia Pacific

   268.3    269.5    318.4    75.3     78.6     83.0  

Americas

   227.5    256.1    343.2    90.6     86.6     119.3  

Europe

   166.8    181.1    204.1    35.5     28.1     28.7  
    
  
  
  

 

 

Total Ansell Healthcare

   662.6    706.7    865.7    201.4     193.3     231.0  
    
  
  
  

 

 

 

The above industry segments report should be read in conjunction with the accompanying notes, including Note 30.

 

80


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

1. SUMMARY OF SI GNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

General

 

Ansell Limited is a multinational healthcare solutions provider of barrier protection products against injury, infection and contamination. The Company’s principal line of business, determined and reported on the basis of differing products and services, is the manufacture and supply of barrier protection products into the Occupational, Professional and Consumer healthcare markets.

 

The Ansell Healthcare group manufactures industrial gloves, medical gloves and consumer products including household gloves and condoms in the Asia Pacific region and America, and markets these products globally.

 

The significant policies which have been adopted in the preparation of this financial report are:

 

Basis of Preparation of Financial Report

 

The financial report is a general purpose financial report which has been prepared in accordance with Accounting Standards, Urgent Issues Group Consensus Views, other authoritative pronouncements of the Australian Accounting Standards Board and the Corporations Act 2001.

 

It has been prepared on the basis of historical costs and except where stated, does not take into account changing money values or fair values of non-current assets.

 

The accounting policies adopted in preparing the financial report have been consistently applied by each entity in the consolidated entity and are consistent with those of the previous year.

 

Comparative information is reclassified where appropriate to enhance comparability.

 

Principles of Consolidation

 

The consolidated financial statements of the Ansell Limited Group (“the consolidated entity”) include the financial statements of Ansell Limited (“the Company”), being the parent entity, and its controlled entities.

 

The consolidated financial statements incorporate the assets and liabilities of all entities controlled by the Company as at balance date and the results of all controlled entities for the year then ended. The effects of all transactions between entities in the consolidated entity are eliminated in full. Outside interests in the results and equity of controlled entities are shown separately in the consolidated Statement of Financial Performance and Statement of Financial Position respectively.

 

Results of controlled entities are included in the consolidated Statement of Financial Performance from the date on which control commences and continue to be included until the date control ceases to exist.

 

Revenue Recognition

 

Revenues are recognised at fair value of the consideration received net of the amount of goods and services tax (GST).

 

Sales Revenue

 

Sales revenue comprises revenue earned (net of returns, rebates and allowances which are accrued at expected levels as sales occur) from the provision of products to entities outside the consolidated entity. Sales revenue is recognised when the goods are shipped and title passes.

 

Interest Income

 

Interest income is recognised as it accrues.

 

Asset Sales

 

The net proceeds of asset sales are included as revenue of the consolidated entity. The profit or loss on disposal of assets is brought to account at the date control passes and a contract of sale has been signed.

 

The gain or loss on disposal is calculated as the difference between the carrying amount of the asset at the time of the disposal and the net proceeds on disposal.

 

Any related balance in the asset revaluation reserve is transferred to retained profits/accumulated losses on disposal.

 

Borrowing Costs

 

Borrowing costs include interest, amortisation of ancillary costs incurred in connection with the arrangement of borrowings and other related charges. Ancillary costs incurred in connection with the arrangement of term borrowings are capitalised and amortised over the life of the borrowings.

 

81


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

 

 

Goods and Services Tax

 

Revenues, expenses and assets are recognised net of the amount of GST, except where the amount of GST incurred is not recoverable from the Australian Tax Office (ATO). In these circumstances the GST is recognised as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset or as part of an item of the expense.

 

Receivables and payables are stated with the amount of GST included.

 

The net amount of GST recoverable from, or payable to, the ATO is included as a current asset or liability in the Statement of Financial Position.

 

Cash flows are included in the Statement of Cash Flows on a gross basis. The GST components of cash flows arising from investing and financing activities which are recoverable from, or payable to, the ATO are classified as operating cash flows.

 

Income Tax

 

The consolidated entity adopts the income statement liability method of tax effect accounting.

 

Income tax expense is calculated at current rates on the accounting profit adjusted for permanent differences and income tax over/under provided in the previous year. The estimated liability for income tax outstanding in respect of the period’s operations is included in the Statement of Financial Position as a current liability.

 

Future income tax benefits and liabilities arising because some items are included in accounting profit in a period different from that in which the items are assessed for income tax, are included in the Statement of Financial Position as a non-current asset and a non-current liability respectively. As provided for in Accounting Standard AASB 1020, these deferred tax balances have been offset, where applicable, in the financial statements of the individual entities. The eventual recoverability of future income tax benefits and payment of the non-current tax liability is contingent upon taxable income being earned in future periods, continuation of the relevant taxation laws and each relevant company continuing to comply with the appropriate legislation.

 

Future income tax benefits attributable to tax losses (including capital losses) are only recorded where virtual certainty of recovery exists.

 

Provision is made for overseas taxes, which may arise in the event of retained profits of foreign controlled entities being remitted to Australia, when the dividend is declared. Provision is made for capital gains tax, which may arise in the event of sale of revalued assets, only when such assets are sold.

 

Tax Consolidation

 

The Company is the head entity in the tax-consolidated group comprising all the Australian wholly owned subsidiaries set out in Note 37. The implementation date for the tax-consolidated group was 1 July 2002. There has been no material impact on the financial statements of the Company or consolidated entity as a result of adopting tax consolidation as all tax balances of the Company and all Australian wholly owned subsidiaries were written off in a prior period.

 

Receivables

 

Trade Debtors

 

Trade debtors are recognised as at the date they are invoiced and are principally on 30 day terms. A provision for doubtful debts is recognised when collection of the full amount is no longer probable.

 

Other Amounts Receivable

 

Other amounts receivable comprise amounts due as a result of transactions outside the normal course of trading.

 

Inventories

 

Stock on Hand and Work in Progress

 

Stock on hand and work in progress are consistently valued on the basis of the lower of cost and net realisable value. The methods generally adopted throughout the consolidated entity in determining costs are:

 

Raw Materials and Other Stock

 

Actual costs, determined on a first in, first out basis or standard costs approximating actual costs.

 

82


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

 

Inventories (continued)

 

Finished Goods and Work in Progress

 

Standard costs approximating actual costs include an appropriate allocation of manufacturing overheads. Obsolete and slow moving stocks are written down to net realisable value where such value is below cost. Net realisable value is determined on the basis of each inventory line’s normal selling pattern. Expenses of marketing, selling and distribution to customers are estimated and are deducted to establish net realisable value.

 

Investments

 

Associated Companies

 

An associate is an entity, other than a partnership, over which the consolidated entity exercises significant influence, where the investment in that entity is material and has not been acquired with a view to disposal in the near future.

 

Subsequent to 2002 the consolidated entity has no investments that meet the criteria for recognition as an associated company.

 

Other Companies

 

Investments in other listed and unlisted companies are carried at cost less any amount provided for diminution in value as determined by the Directors. Dividends are recognised when they are received.

 

Interest in Partnership

 

The consolidated entity’s 50% interest in the South Pacific Tyres partnership is carried as an investment at cost. The principal activity of the partnership is the manufacture and sale of tyres and related products.

 

Property, Plant and Equipment

 

Acquisition

 

Items of property, plant and equipment are initially recorded at cost and depreciated as set out below. The cost of property, plant and equipment constructed by the consolidated entity includes the cost of materials, direct labour and capitalised interest.

 

Depreciation and Amortisation

 

Depreciation and amortisation is calculated on a straight line basis so as to write off the net cost of each item of property, plant and equipment, excluding land, over its estimated useful life.

 

The expected useful lives are as follows:

 

Freehold buildings of the Company and all Australian controlled entities

   - 40 years

Freehold buildings of overseas controlled entities

   - 20 -40 years

Leasehold buildings

   - Life of lease

Plant and equipment

   - 3 to 10 years

 

Depreciation and amortisation rates and methods are reviewed annually for appropriateness.

 

Leases

 

Operating lease payments are expensed as incurred on a straight line basis over the term of the lease.

 

83


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

 

Recoverable Amount of Non-Current Assets Valued on Cost Basis

 

The carrying amounts of non-current assets valued on the cost basis are reviewed to determine whether they are in excess of their recoverable amount at balance date. If the carrying amount of a non-current asset exceeds its recoverable amount, the asset is written down to the lower amount. The write-down is recognised as an expense in the net profit or loss in the reporting period in which it occurs.

 

In assessing and measuring recoverable amounts of non-current assets the relevant cash flows have been discounted to their present value.

 

Brand Names

 

Brand names acquired since 1 July 1987 are recorded in the financial statements at cost. No amortisation is provided against the carrying value of these brand names on the basis that the lives of these assets are considered unlimited at this point in time.

 

Brand names have an unlimited legal life and the brand names recorded in the financial statements are not currently associated with products which are likely to become commercially or technically obsolete.

 

Payables

 

Trade and Other Creditors

 

Trade and other creditors are recognised for amounts to be paid in the future for goods and services received, whether or not billed to the Company or the consolidated entity. Trade liabilities are normally settled on 60 day terms.

 

Bills Payable

 

Bills payable are carried at the principal amount plus accrued interest.

 

Interest Bearing Liabilities

 

Bank and other loans are carried at their principal amount, subject to set-off arrangements. Interest is charged as an expense as it accrues.

 

Employee Entitlements

 

Wages, Salaries and Annual Leave

 

Liabilities for employee entitlements to wages, salaries and annual leave represent the amount which the consolidated entity has a present obligation to pay resulting from employees’ services provided up to the balance date calculated at undiscounted amounts based on expected wage and salary rates that will be paid when the obligation is settled and include related on-costs.

 

Long Service Leave and Post Retirement Health Benefits

 

The liability for employee entitlements to long service leave and post retirement health benefits represents the present value of the estimated future cash outflows to be made by the Company and the consolidated entity resulting from employees’ services provided up to the balance date.

 

The provision is calculated using estimated future increases in wage and salary rates including related on-costs and expected settlement dates based on turnover history and is discounted using rates attaching to national government securities at balance date which most closely match the terms of maturity of the related liabilities. The unwinding of the discount is treated as long service leave expense.

 

Provisions

 

A provision is recognised when there is a legal, equitable or constructive obligation as a result of a past event and it is probable that a future sacrifice of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation, the timing or amount of which is uncertain.

 

If the future sacrifice of economic benefits is material, a provision is determined by discounting the expected future cash flows required to settle the obligation at a pre-tax rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the liability. The unwinding of the discount is treated as part of the expense related to the particular provision.

 

84


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

 

Provisions (continued)

 

Rationalisation and Restructuring

 

Provisions for rationalisation and restructuring are only recognised when a detailed plan has been approved and the restructuring has either commenced or been publicly announced, or firm contracts related to the restructuring have been entered into. Costs related to ongoing activities are not provided for.

 

Contingencies, Accufix Pacing Lead Related Expenses and Insurance Claims

 

The consolidated entity provides for certain specifically identified or obligated costs when these amounts are reasonably determinable.

 

Dividends

 

A provision for dividends payable is recognised in the reporting period in which the dividends are declared.

 

Other Liabilities

 

Amounts due under contract

 

Amounts due under contract are carried at the outstanding consideration payable.

 

Superannuation Contributions

 

The Company and other controlled entities contribute to various defined benefit and accumulation superannuation funds as set out in Note 24. Employer contributions to these funds are charged against the operating profit as they are made. The Company and the controlled entities have no legal or constructive obligation to fund any deficit.

 

Employee and Executive Share Plans

 

The Company currently maintains two plans for employees of the consolidated entity - the Pacific Dunlop Employee Share Plan and the Ansell Limited Stock Incentive Plan. A further Plan, the Pacific Dunlop Executive Share Plan, was discontinued in 1996. Further information on these plans is set out in Note 25.

 

The consolidated entity has recorded a charge to the profit and loss for the current year of approximately $2.6 million based on the expected vesting of Performance Share Rights issued to executives pursuant to the Ansell Limited Stock Incentive Plan over the past two years. Australian Accounting Standards do not currently require the recognition of compensation expense in relation to issuance of shares to employees, however the Company considers the recognition of such to be consistent with appropriate accounting criteria given the movement towards the recognition of such compensation under Exposure Draft 108 Equity Based Compensation.

 

Accounting for Acquisitions (Goodwill)

 

Acquired businesses are accounted for on the basis of the cost method. Fair values are assigned at date of acquisition to all the identifiable underlying assets acquired and to the liabilities assumed. Specific assessment is undertaken at the date of acquisition of any appropriate additional costs to be incurred. A liability for restructuring costs is only recognised as at the date of acquisition when there is a demonstrable commitment to restructuring together with a detailed plan. Further, the liability is only recognised when there is little or no discretion to avoid payment to other parties to settle such costs and a reliable estimate of the amount of the liability can be made. Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase consideration plus incidental costs over the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired. Acquired goodwill is capitalised and amortised to the Statement of Financial Performance on a straight line basis over the future period of expected benefit.

 

The benefits from the goodwill acquired may exceed 20 years but the goodwill is written off over periods not exceeding 20 years in compliance with Australian Accounting Standards. The unamortised balance of goodwill is reviewed at least at each reporting date and any material diminution in value is charged to the Statement of Financial Performance. For the purposes of this review process, goodwill is allocated to cash generating units (which equate to the Group’s reportable business units i.e. Occupational, Professional and Consumer) upon acquisition. Acquired businesses can readily be allocated to one of the business units on the basis of products manufactured and/or marketed. Such manufacturing and marketing operations tend to cover more than one geographical region.

 

85


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

 

Foreign Currency Translations

 

Transactions in foreign currencies are recorded at the rate of exchange ruling on the date of each transaction. At balance date, amounts payable and receivable in foreign currencies are converted at the rates of exchange ruling at that date.

 

The financial statements of overseas controlled entities that are self sustaining foreign operations are maintained in their functional currencies and are converted to the Group’s reporting currency using the current rate method. Equity items are translated at historical rates. Variations occurring from year to year arising from this translation method are transferred to the foreign currency translation reserve until disposal, or partial disposal, of the operations.

 

Exchange differences arising on foreign currency amounts payable and receivable are brought to account in the Statement of Financial Performance. On consolidation, exchange differences on long term foreign currency amounts payable and receivable that hedge a net investment in an overseas controlled entity are transferred to the foreign currency translation reserve on a net of tax basis where applicable.

 

Derivatives

 

The Company and consolidated entity use derivative financial instruments, principally foreign exchange and interest rate related, to reduce their exposure to movements in foreign exchange rate and interest rate movements.

 

The consolidated entity has adopted certain principles in relation to derivative financial instruments:

 

  (i) it does not trade in a derivative that is not used in the hedging of an underlying business exposure of the consolidated entity;

 

  (ii) derivatives acquired must be able to be recorded on the consolidated entity’s treasury management systems, which contain extensive internal controls; and

 

  (iii) the consolidated entity does not deal with counter-parties rated lower than A- by Standard and Poor’s or A3 by Moody’s Investors Service for any overnight transactions.

 

The Company and consolidated entity follow the same credit policies, legal processes, monitoring of market and operational risks in the area of derivative financial instruments, as they do in relation to financial assets and liabilities on the Statement of Financial Position, where internal controls operate.

 

Derivative Financial Instruments Held or Issued for Purposes Other Than Trading

 

On a continuing basis, the consolidated entity monitors its future exposures and on some occasions hedges all or part of these exposures. The transactions which may be covered are future net cash flows of overseas controlled entities, future foreign exchange requirements and interest rate positions.

 

These exposures are then monitored and may be modified from time to time. The foreign exchange transactions predominantly do not exceed 12 months duration and hedge transactions the consolidated entity expects to occur in this time frame. From time to time minor mismatches occur in the forward book, however these mismatches are managed under strict guidelines, limits and internal controls with stop loss parameters. Interest rate derivative instruments can be for periods up to 5 years.

 

When hedging an underlying interest rate exposure, with a derivative financial instrument, all gains and losses are accounted for on an accrual basis, thereby adjusting the underlying physical cost to the hedged rate over the life of the transaction. Gains or losses resulting from the termination of an interest rate swap contract where the underlying borrowing remains, are deferred on the Statement of Financial Position and then amortised over the life of the borrowing. Where the transaction is a single event, such as a foreign exchange exposure, the hedge gain or loss is taken to account on the actual exposure date.

 

Gains and losses on derivative financial instruments which hedge transactions are in the first instance deferred and later recognised in the Statement of Financial Performance when the hedged transaction occurs. Such deferrals only occur where the future transaction remains assured. Where a transaction is modified or extinguished any associated derivative financial instrument is also modified or extinguished and any gain or loss that no longer relates to an actual exposure is immediately taken to the Statement of Financial Performance.

 

Derivative Financial Instruments Held or Issued for Trading Purposes

 

The Company and the consolidated entity do not trade in derivative financial instruments or hold them for speculative purposes.

 

86


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

 

Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with Australian generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reported period. The estimates and associated assumptions are based on historical experience and various factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances and are reviewed on an ongoing basis. Actual results could differ from these estimates. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognised in the period in which the estimate is revised if the revision affects only that period, or in the period of the revision and future periods if the revision affects both current and future periods.

 

Earnings per Share

 

Basic earnings per share (EPS) is calculated by dividing the net profit attributable to members of the parent entity for the reporting period, after excluding any costs of servicing equity other than ordinary shares, by the weighted average number of ordinary shares of the Company, adjusted for any bonus issue.

 

Diluted EPS is calculated by dividing the basic EPS earnings, adjusted by the after tax effect of financing costs associated with dilutive potential ordinary shares and the effect on revenues and expenses of conversion to ordinary shares associated with dilutive potential ordinary shares, by the weighted average number of ordinary and dilutive potential ordinary shares adjusted for any bonus issue.

 

87


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

2. IMPACT OF ADOPTING AUSTRALIAN EQUIVALENTS TO INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS

 

Ansell will be required to prepare financial statements using Australian equivalents to International Reporting Standards (IFRS) for the year ending 30 June 2006. Ansell will report for the first time in compliance with IFRS when the results for the half-year ending 31 December 2005 are released.

 

IFRS requires that entities reporting their financial statements for the first time under IFRS must also restate their comparatives using all IFRS with the exception of IAS 32 Financial Instruments: Disclosure and Presentation and IAS 39 Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement. This will mean the opening IFRS balance sheet will be a restated comparative balance sheet, dated 1 July 2004. Most adjustments required on transition to IFRS will be made, retrospectively, against opening accumulated losses on 1 July 2004, however transitional adjustments relating to those standards where comparatives are not required will only be made on 1 July 2005. Comparatives restated to comply with IFRS will be reported, for the first time, in the financial statements for the half-year ending 31 December 2005.

 

Ansell has established a project team to plan and implement the transition process to IFRS. As at 30 June 2004, the project team has completed an impact study to identify key areas that will be impacted by IFRS. The impact study addressed key differences in accounting policies and disclosures, business issues associated with Australian equivalents to IFRS and key milestones for IFRS implementation including a high-level project plan.

 

The key differences in accounting policies that are expected to arise from adopting IFRS are as follows:

 

    Intangible Assets - the amortisation of goodwill will be prohibited, and will be replaced by annual impairment testing of cash flows of the cash-generating unit to which the asset belongs.

 

    Impairment of Assets - the recoverable amount of an asset will be determined on a discounted cash flow basis, with strict tests for determining whether the value of goodwill or cash-generating units have been impaired.

 

    Superannuation - surpluses and deficits in defined benefit superannuation plans sponsored by entities within the consolidated entity will be recognised in the Statement of Financial Performance and Statement of Financial Position.

 

    Share-Based Payments - equity-based compensation in respect of options will be recognised as an expense in the periods during which the employee provides related services.

 

    Financial Instruments - derivative financial instruments will be carried at fair value in the Consolidated entity’s Statement of Financial Position.

 

The above should not be regarded as a complete list of changes to accounting policies that will result from the transition to Australian equivalents to IFRS, as some decisions have not yet been made where choices of accounting policies are available. For this reason it is not possible at this time to quantify the potential impact of the transition to Australian equivalents to IFRS on the consolidated entity’s financial performance and financial position.

 

3. TOTAL REVENUE

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Revenue from the Sale of Goods

   1,113.3    1,293.6    2,222.8

Revenues From Other Operating Activities

              

Dividend income

              

From shares in other companies

   —      —      0.3

Interest Received or Due and Receivable

              

From related parties

   3.5    3.3    2.5

From others

   9.0    8.0    13.0
    
  
  

Total revenue from other operating activities

   12.5    11.3    15.8
    
  
  

Revenue from Outside Operating Activities

              

Proceeds from the Sale of Non-Current Assets

   5.3    15.2    12.1

Proceeds Received from the Sale of Businesses

   —      —      939.7
    
  
  

Total revenue from outside operating activities

   5.3    15.2    951.8
    
  
  

Total Revenue

   1,131.1    1,320.1    3,190.4
    
  
  

 

88


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

4. PROFIT/(LOSS) FROM ORDINARY ACTIVITIES BEFORE INCOME TAX

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

(a) Profit/(loss) from ordinary activities before income tax has been arrived at after charging/(crediting) the following items:

                  

Borrowing Costs

                  

Interest Paid or Due and Payable:

                  

To others

   25.4     33.9     61.8  

Other Borrowing Costs

   4.0     3.9     8.4  
    

 

 

Total Borrowing Costs

   29.4     37.8     70.2  

Depreciation

                  

Buildings

   1.1     1.8     3.9  

Plant & equipment

   22.7     27.7     46.4  

Amortisation

                  

Leasehold land and buildings

   1.5     1.7     2.8  

Goodwill

   21.4     25.3     29.2  

Research and Development Costs Expensed as Incurred

   12.6     12.8     17.0  

Net Bad Debts Expense

   0.4     (0.6 )   0.8  

Amounts Set Aside to Provision for:

                  

Doubtful trade debts

   1.2     (2.5 )   (2.9 )

Employee entitlements

   13.0     10.8     29.2  

Rationalisation and restructuring costs

   9.7     10.1     20.3  

Rebates, allowances and warranty claims

   9.6     11.5     7.2  

Net foreign exchange loss/(gain)

   1.0     4.0     (0.4 )

Profits Arising from the Sale of Property, Plant and Equipment

   (0.8 )   (0.3 )   (7.6 )

Losses Arising from Sale of Property, Plant and Equipment

   —       0.2     13.2  

Operating Lease Rentals

   20.0     24.1     37.5  

Write-down in Value of Inventories

   3.7     5.9     3.0  

(b) Individually significant items included in profit/(loss) from ordinary activities before income tax expense

                  

Refund of Sales Tax

   17.8     —       —    

Write-down of Ansell Healthcare fixed assets

   (8.8 )   —       (63.1 )

GNB Workers Compensation costs

   (7.5 )   —       —    

Write-down of receivable/investment

   —       (6.1 )   (99.9 )

Net gain/(loss) on sale of controlled entities and businesses

   —       —       25.7  

(c) Auditors’ Remuneration ($ in Thousands)

                  

Audit and review of the financial reports:

                  

Auditors of Ansell Limited and Australian entities - KPMG

   1,013     1,183     1,653  

Other member firms of KPMG

   1,423     1,661     1,891  
    

 

 

     2,436     2,844     3,544  
    

 

 

Other services:

                  

Other audit and assurance services (including disposals and acquisitions)

                  

Auditors of Ansell Limited and Australian entities - KPMG

   131     259     4,944  

Other member firms of KPMG

   77     78     25  

Taxation and other services

                  

Auditors of Ansell Limited and Australian entities - KPMG

   40     32     439  

Other member firms of KPMG

   150     90     66  
    

 

 

Total other services

   398     459     5,474  
    

 

 

Total auditors remuneration

   2,834     3,303     9,018  
    

 

 

 

89


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

5. CONTRIBUTED EQUITY

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Issued and Paid up Capital

              

176,310,916 (2003 - 185,917,580 ; 2002 - 187,073,500)

              

ordinary shares, fully paid *

   1,383.8    1,448.2    1,455.4

738,000 (2003 - 922,100 ; 2002 - 1,174,600)

              

ordinary plan shares, paid to 5 cents

   0.1    0.1    0.1
    
  
  

Total Issued and Paid up Capital

   1,383.9    1,448.3    1,455.5
    
  
  

 

* includes 149,763 (2003 - 210,679 ; 2002 - 678,300) shares issued in accordance with the Employee

 

Share Plan and 198,288 (2003 - nil; 2002 - nil) shares bought back by the Company prior to 30 June 2004

but not cancelled as at that date.

 

Ordinary Shares Reconciliation

                

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   1,448.3     1,455.5     1,454.3

Increase in Contributed Equity:

                

Additional capital issued

   1.0     1.0     1.2

Decrease in Contributed Equity:

                

Share buy-back

   (65.4 )   (8.2 )   —  
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   1,383.9     1,448.3     1,455.5
    

 

 

 

Holders of ordinary shares are entitled to receive dividends as declared from time to time and are entitled to one vote per share at shareholders’ meetings. In the event of winding up of the Company ordinary shareholders rank after all other shareholders and creditors and are fully entitled to any proceeds of liquidation. Note 25 provides details of shares subject to options and Performance Share Rights granted under the Ansell Limited Stock Incentive Plan.

 

Share Buy-Back

 

The Company, on 30 April 2004, ceased buying back shares under the on-market buy back announced on 16 April 2003, after buying back 11,199,184 shares for a total outlay of $72.1 million representing 6% of ordinary shares issued on that date. On 3 May 2004, the Company announced that it would undertake a further on-market buy-back of up to 12 million shares over the following 12 month period. As at 30 June 2004, the Company had bought back 198,288 shares for $1.47 million.

 

Executive Share Plan

 

As previously reported, the Pacific Dunlop Executive Share Plan was closed to new members effective 12 September 1996, and no further issues of Executive Plan Shares will be made. During the financial year, the amounts outstanding on 184,100 existing Executive Plan shares were fully paid. Since the end of the financial year, the amounts outstanding on a further 23,800 Executive Plan shares have been fully paid. Shares allotted under the Pacific Dunlop Executive Share Plan have been paid to 5 cents per share. Refer to Note 25 ‘Ownership-Based Remuneration Schemes’ for details of price payable for shares issued under this plan.

 

Employee Share Plan

 

During the financial year, the loan liability of members in respect of 60,916 fully paid ordinary shares of $2.50 each was discharged. Since the end of the financial year, no further payments in respect of Employee Plan shares have been made. Under the Employee Share Plan, 50 cents was payable on subscription for each Plan share allotted to eligible employees, the balance of issue price being funded by way of interest free loans from the Company to the member. No new shares were issued during the financial year or up to the date of this Report under the Pacific Dunlop Employee Share Plan.

 

90


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

6. ACCUMULATED LOSSES AND RESERVES

 

     Consolidated  

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Asset revaluation reserve

   0.7     1.5     14.7  

General reserve

   3.3     1.8     2.7  

Foreign currency translation reserve

   (279.6 )   (272.2 )   (193.6 )
    

 

 

Total Reserves

   (275.6 )   (268.9 )   (176.2 )

Accumulated losses

   (306.7 )   (345.7 )   (417.0 )
    

 

 

Total Accumulated Losses and Reserves

   (582.3 )   (614.6 )   (593.2 )
    

 

 

Movements during the year:

                  

Asset Revaluation Reserve

                  

Balance at beginning of the financial year

   1.5     14.7     6.2  

Transfer from/(to) retained profits

   (0.8 )   (13.2 )   8.5  
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   0.7     1.5     14.7  
    

 

 

General Reserve

                  

Balance at beginning of the financial year

   1.8     2.7     3.0  

Transfer from/(to) retained profits

   1.5     (0.9 )   (0.3 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   3.3     1.8     2.7  
    

 

 

Foreign Currency Translation Reserve

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   (272.2 )   (193.6 )   (127.2 )

Transfers to retained profits

   —       (7.3 )   3.2  

Exchange fluctuations on assets and liabilities held in foreign currencies

                  

net loss on translation of net assets

   (16.8 )   (121.1 )   (120.3 )

net gain on hedge borrowings

   9.4     49.8     50.7  
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   (279.6 )   (272.2 )   (193.6 )
    

 

 

Accumulated Losses

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   (345.7 )   (417.0 )   (289.9 )

Transfer (to)/from reserves

   (0.7 )   21.4     (11.4 )

Net profit/(loss) after income tax attributable to Ansell Limited shareholders

   70.7     49.9     (115.8 )

Dividends provided for or paid *

   (31.0 )   —       0.1  
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   (306.7 )   (345.7 )   (417.0 )
    

 

 

 

* 2002 dividends represents an overprovision in the prior year.

 

Nature and purpose of reserves

 

Asset Revaluation

 

The asset revaluation reserve includes the net revaluation increments and decrements arising from the revaluation of non-current assets in accordance with AASB 1041. The balance of $0.7 million is not available for future asset write-downs as a result of using the deemed cost election for land and buildings when adopting AASB 1041.

 

General

 

The amount standing to the credit of the general reserve resulted from prior period allocations of retained profits for non-specific purposes and is available for release to retained profits.

 

Foreign currency translation

 

The foreign currency translation reserve records the foreign currency differences arising from the translation of self-sustaining foreign operations, the translation of transactions that hedge the Company’s net investment in a foreign operation or the translation of foreign currency monetary items forming part of the net investment in a self-sustaining operation. Refer to Significant Accounting Policy Note 1.

 

91


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

7. TOTAL EQUITY RECONCILIATION

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Total equity at the beginning of the financial year

   844.5     876.0     1,066.2  

Total changes in equity from non-owner related transactions attributable to Ansell Limited shareholders

   63.3     (21.4 )   (185.4 )

Transactions with owners as owners:

                  

Contributions of equity

   1.0     1.0     1.2  

Share buy-back

   (65.4 )   (8.2 )   —    

Dividends

   (31.0 )   —       0.1  

Total changes in outside equity interest

   (0.6 )   (2.9 )   (6.1 )
    

 

 

Total equity at the end of the financial year

   811.8     844.5     876.0  
    

 

 

 

8. INCOME TAX

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Prima facie income tax expense/(benefit) calculated at 30%

   28.0     23.8     (17.2 )

(2003: 30%, 2002: 30%) on profit/(loss) from ordinary activities

                  

Increased taxation arising from:

                  

Write down of assets

   2.9     2.3     48.9  

Net restructuring costs

   2.9     1.4     5.4  

Goodwill amortisation

   0.9     1.1     1.4  

Income tax under provided in prior years

   2.2     1.3     0.2  

Net higher overseas tax rates

   —       8.3     4.1  

Reduced taxation arising from:

                  

Net (gain)/loss on sale of businesses and controlled entities

   —       —       (7.7 )

Investment and export incentive allowances

   (6.8 )   (6.7 )   (6.3 )

Net lower overseas tax rates

   (0.9 )   —       —    

Other permanent differences*

   (8.5 )   (4.6 )   12.4  

Share of associates’ net profit

   —       (0.1 )   (0.6 )

Income tax expense/(benefit) on profit from ordinaryactivities before individually significant items and effect of change in tax rate

   20.7     26.8     40.6  

Individually significant income tax items:

                  

Write off of tax balances attributable to Australian operations

   —       —       15.2  
    

 

 

Income tax expense/(benefit) attributable to profit/(loss) from ordinary activities

   20.7     26.8     55.8  
    

 

 

Income tax expense/(benefit) attributable to operating profit/(loss) is made up of:

                  

Provision attributable to current year

   17.2     0.7     8.0  

Under/(Over) provision in respect of previous years

   2.2     1.3     0.2  

Provision attributable to future years

                  

Deferred income tax liability

   (1.5 )   0.3     (2.0 )

Future income tax benefit

   2.8     24.5     49.6  
    

 

 

     20.7     26.8     55.8  
    

 

 

 

* Includes tax benefit on loss from Australian trading operations not brought to account/recovery of tax losses not previously brought to account.

 

92


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

9. DIVIDENDS PAID OR DECLARED

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Dividends paid

              

The following dividends were paid during the year to Ansell Limited shareholders:

              

A final dividend for the year ended 30 June 2003 of 11 cents per share unfranked, was paid on 9 October 2003

   20.4    —      —  

An interim dividend for the year ended 30 June 2004 of 6 cents per share unfranked, was paid on 8 April 2004

   10.6    —      —  

Dividends declared

              

Since the end of the financial year the Directors declared the following dividend payable to Ansell Limited shareholders:

              

final dividend of 7 cents, unfranked (2003 -11 cents; 2002 - nil)

   12.3    20.4    —  

The financial effect of this dividend has not been brought to account in the financial statements For the year ended 30 June 2004 and will be recognised in subsequent financial reports.

              

Dividend Franking Account

              

As a result of entering the Tax Consolidation regime the balance of available franking credits in the franking account as at 30 June 2004 was $2.7 million (2003 - nil; 2002 - nil).

              

 

10. OUTSIDE EQUITY INTERESTS

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Outside equity interests comprise:

                  

Contributed equity

   2.1     2.1     4.5  

Reserves

   (3.0 )   (2.2 )   2.4  

Retained profits at the beginning of the financial year

   10.9     6.8     3.6  

Profits for the year

   1.9     2.6     2.8  

Dividends paid/provided for during the year

   (1.7 )   (1.7 )   (1.8 )

Outside equity interests disposed/acquired during the year

   —       3.2     2.2  

Retained profits at the end of the financial year

   11.1     10.9     6.8  
    

 

 

Total Outside Equity Interests

   10.2     10.8     13.7  
    

 

 

 

11. CASH ASSETS

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Cash on hand

   0.9    0.6    0.2

Cash at bank

   69.8    60.8    72.0

Short-term deposits

   237.1    224.6    186.3
    
  
  
     307.8    286.0    258.5

Restricted deposits

   10.3    13.8    18.4
    
  
  

Total Cash Assets

   318.1    299.8    276.9
    
  
  

 

Restricted deposits represent cash set aside to cover the provisions established to address any remaining liability of members of the Group for claims arising with respect to the Accufix Pacing Lead.

 

93


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

12. RECEIVABLES

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Current

                  

Trade debtors

   204.7     218.2     264.8  

Less provision for doubtful debts

   6.7     6.9     17.5  

Less provision for rebates, allowances and warranty claims

   15.0     13.8     14.8  
    

 

 

     183.0     197.5     232.5  

Amounts owing by South Pacific Tyres partnership

   0.5     7.6     —    

Other amounts receivable

   45.2     57.3     61.2  
    

 

 

Total Current

   228.7     262.4     293.7  
    

 

 

Non-Current

                  

Interest bearing amount owing by South Pacific Tyres partnership

   62.3     55.1     59.4  

Amounts owing by other related parties

   —       —       0.2  

Interest bearing amount owing by external entities

   —       —       2.5  

Other amounts receivable

   1.6     2.4     6.8  

Less provision for doubtful debts

   0.3     0.5     2.2  
    

 

 

Total Non Current

   63.6     57.0     66.7  
    

 

 

Total Receivables

   292.3     319.4     360.4  
    

 

 

Included in other amounts receivable are:

                  

(i) Loans to employees in relation to the employee share plan

                  

current

   —       —       0.7  

non-current

   0.8     1.2     3.6  

(ii) Loans to Executive Directors of Ansell Limited and Executives who are Directors of certain controlled entities secured under the Ansell Housing Scheme repayable at a future date at concessional interest rates

                  

non-current

   —       —       0.2  

Repayments received

   —       0.2     0.2  
The reconciliations of provision for doubtful debts - trade are presented below:                   
     Consolidated

 

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   6.9     17.5     33.1  

Acquisitions/(disposals) of entities

   —       —       (8.2 )

Amounts charged/(released) to profit/(loss) from operating activities

   1.2     (2.5 )   (2.9 )

Amounts utilised for intended purposes

   (1.3 )   (7.4 )   (4.0 )

Net foreign currency differences on translation of self-sustaining

                  

operations

   (0.1 )   (0.7 )   (0.5 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   6.7     6.9     17.5  
    

 

 

 

13. INVENTORIES

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

At Cost

              

Raw materials

   20.1    21.6    31.9

Work in progress

   13.6    13.1    17.0

Finished goods

   112.0    137.2    181.1

Other stock

   3.9    5.5    5.1
    
  
  

Total Inventory at Cost

   149.6    177.4    235.1
    
  
  

Net Realisable Value

              

Finished goods

   37.9    10.5    —  

Other stock

   3.0    —      —  
    
  
  

Total Inventory at Net Realisable Value

   40.9    10.5    —  
    
  
  

Total Inventories

   190.5    187.9    235.1
    
  
  

 

94


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

14. OTHER FINANCIAL ASSETS (INVESTMENTS)

 

          Consolidated

$ in millions


   Notes

   2004

   2003

   2002

Other financial assets

                   

Quoted on a prescribed stock exchange:

                   

At cost

        —      —      9.3

At market value

        2.1    3.1    —  

Not quoted on a prescribed stock exchange:

                   

At cost

        1.3    —      —  

South Pacific Tyres N.Z. Ltd

        21.6    21.9    20.1

Investment in Partnership

                   

South Pacific Tyres

        116.4    116.4    116.4
         
  
  

Total Other Financial Assets

        141.4    141.4    145.8
         
  
  

(b) Investments accounted for using the equity method

                   

Shares in Unlisted Associated Companies

                   

Equity Accounted

   38    —      —      13.3
         
  
  

Total Investments accounted for using the equity method

        —      —      13.3
         
  
  

 

(1) The Directors have adopted the cost basis of valuation in accordance with AASB 1041 ‘Revaluation of Non-Current Assets’.

 

15. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

(a) Freehold Land

              

At cost

   12.6    13.4    16.3

(b) Freehold Buildings

              

At cost

   37.7    39.8    45.6

Less provision for depreciation

   11.7    11.9    7.6
    
  
  
     26.0    27.9    38.0
    
  
  

(c) Leasehold Land and Buildings

              

At cost

   52.2    53.4    62.6

Less provision for amortisation

   12.2    11.1    12.1
    
  
  
     40.0    42.3    50.5
    
  
  

(d) Plant and Equipment

              

At cost

   400.6    436.3    502.5

Less provision for depreciation

   260.2    266.1    286.7
    
  
  
     140.4    170.2    215.8
    
  
  

(e) Buildings and Plant under construction

              

At cost

   8.8    9.1    11.9
    
  
  

Total property, plant and equipment

   227.8    262.9    332.5
    
  
  

 

In accordance with the consolidated entity’s policy of obtaining an independent valuation of land and buildings every three years, a valuation was carried out as at 31 December 2003 by independent valuers. This valuation was on the basis of Fair Value - Existing Use, subject to continued occupation by the operating entity or, where this was not the case, Fair Value - Alternative Use. With respect to land and buildings owned as at 30 June 2004, this resulted in a valuation of freehold land of $33,527,961and a valuation of freehold buildings of $52,227,266.

 

As land and buildings are recorded at cost, the valuation has not been brought to account.

 

95


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

15. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT (continued)

 

Reconciliations

 

Reconciliations of the balances for each class of property, plant and equipment are set out below:

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Freehold Land

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   13.4     16.3     43.3  

Disposal of entities

   —       —       (20.8 )

Disposals/Write-downs

   (1.5 )   (0.6 )   (4.6 )

Net foreign currency differences on translation of self-sustaining operations

   0.7     (2.3 )   (1.6 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   12.6     13.4     16.3  

Freehold Buildings

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   27.9     38.0     97.7  

Additions

   0.1     0.1     0.3  

Disposal of entities

   —       —       (33.3 )

Disposals/Write-downs

   (2.0 )   (3.4 )   (19.4 )

Transfer from capital works in progress

   0.2     0.1     —    

Depreciation

   (1.1 )   (1.8 )   (3.9 )

Net foreign currency differences on translation of self-sustaining operations

   0.9     (5.1 )   (3.4 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   26.0     27.9     38.0  

Leasehold Land and Buildings

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   42.3     50.5     73.2  

Additions

   0.1     0.8     1.1  

Additions through entities acquired

   —       —       1.9  

Disposal of entities

   —       —       (14.8 )

Disposals/Write-downs

   (0.2 )   —       (2.7 )

Transfers from capital works in progress

   0.7     0.2     1.4  

Amortisation

   (1.5 )   (1.7 )   (2.8 )

Net foreign currency differences on translation of self-sustaining operations

   (1.4 )   (7.5 )   (6.8 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   40.0     42.3     50.5  

Plant and Equipment

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   170.2     215.8     423.9  

Additions

   3.9     5.4     11.4  

Additions through entities acquired

   —       —       3.4  

Disposal of entities

   —       —       (104.4 )

Disposals/Write-downs

   (9.7 )   (3.7 )   (74.4 )

Transfers from capital works in progress

   8.3     9.5     30.5  

Depreciation

   (22.7 )   (27.7 )   (46.4 )

Net foreign currency differences on translation of self-sustaining operations

   (9.6 )   (29.1 )   (28.2 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   140.4     170.2     215.8  

 

96


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

15. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT (CONTINUED)

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Buildings and Plant under construction

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   9.1     11.9     31.8  

Additions

   9.7     9.1     21.5  

Disposal of entities

   —       —       (7.0 )

Disposals/Write-downs

   —       —       (0.4 )

Transfers to property, plant & equipment

   (9.2 )   (9.8 )   (31.9 )

Net foreign currency differences on translation of self-sustaining operations

   (0.8 )   (2.1 )   (2.1 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   8.8     9.1     11.9  

 

16. INTANGIBLE ASSETS

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Brand Names

              

At cost

   117.4    121.2    142.5
    
  
  

Goodwill

              

At cost

   375.3    385.6    445.9

Less provision for amortisation

   199.3    182.3    185.2
    
  
  
     176.0    203.3    260.7
    
  
  

Total Intangibles

   293.4    324.5    403.2
    
  
  

 

17. DEFERRED TAX ASSETS

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Future income tax benefit arising from:

              

Accumulated timing differences

   23.6    26.0    32.2

Accumulated tax losses

   0.6    6.0    17.5
    
  
  
     24.2    32.0    49.7
    
  
  

 

The Group has unrecognised capital tax losses relating to controlled entities of $374.9 million (2003 - $267.9 million; 2002 - $331.3 million). Future income tax benefits of $363.9 million (2003 - $380.4 million; 2002 - $393.6 million) relating to trading tax losses of controlled entities have not been recognised in the financial statements.

 

The benefit of those trading losses will only be obtained if:

 

(a) the relevant company derives future assessable income of a nature and an amount sufficient to enable the benefit to be realised, or the benefit can be utilised by another company in the consolidated entity; and

 

(b) the relevant company and/or the consolidated entity continues to comply with the conditions for deductibility imposed by the law; and

 

(c) no changes in tax legislation adversely affect the relevant company and/or consolidated entity in realising the benefit.

 

The tax effect of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the future income tax benefit are presented below:

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Trading stock tax adjustments

   3.5    4.9    4.0

Provisions

   17.0    18.1    21.4

Accruals

   2.7    2.3    3.0

Unrealised foreign exchange losses

   —      —      0.5

Accumulated tax losses

   0.6    6.0    17.5

Other

   0.4    0.7    3.3
    
  
  

Total temporary differences

   24.2    32.0    49.7
    
  
  

 

97


PART I

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

18. PAYABLES

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Current

              

Trade creditors

   124.1    130.1    166.6

Other creditors

   35.3    24.3    26.1
    
  
  

Total Current

   159.4    154.4    192.7
    
  
  

Non-Current

              

Other creditors

   3.3    3.2    3.7
    
  
  

Total Non-Current

   3.3    3.2    3.7
    
  
  

Total Payables

   162.7    157.6    196.4
    
  
  

 

19. INTEREST BEARING LIABILITIES

 

     Consolidated

$ in Millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Current

              

Bank overdrafts

   3.3    2.6    14.6

Bank loans repayable in:

              

Canadian dollars

   —      5.6    5.8

Euro dollars

   —      —      14.9

Malaysian ringgits

   7.0    9.2    5.8

Other currencies

   0.8    0.6    0.7

Other loans repayable in:

              

Australian dollars

   50.0    —      —  

Sterling Pounds

   —      —      16.2

U.S. dollars

   129.1    133.8    49.6
    
  
  

Total Current

   190.2    151.8    107.6
    
  
  

Non-Current

              

Bank loans repayable in:

              

U.S. dollars

   101.6    —      —  

Other currencies

   —      —      0.2

Other loans repayable in:

              

Australian dollars

   66.0    116.0    116.0

Euro dollars

   —      —      34.0

U.S. dollars

   68.4    204.0    366.3
    
  
  

Total Non-Current

   236.0    320.0    516.5
    
  
  

Total Interest Bearing Liabilities

   426.2    471.8    624.1
    
  
  

 

At 30 June 2004 bank overdraft and other loans totalling $1.4 million (2003: $1.7 million, 2002: $2.4 million) were secured, principally against Group property, plant and equipment having carrying values slightly in excess of the secured amounts payable. These security arrangements relate to acquired controlled entities and were in place prior to the companies concerned becoming part of the Ansell Limited Group.

 

The Group established a US$250 million revolving credit bank facility on 30 April 2004 of which US$200 million has a five year term and US$50 million a 364 day term. This facility can be accessed by the parent company and certain USA subsidiaries. US$70 million of the five year term facility had been drawn down at 30 June 2004 (June 2003: Nil) leaving an unused balance at that date of US$180 million. There are no restrictions on the access to this facility. There are a number of financial covenants attaching to this facility including restrictions on the level of borrowings of non guarantor subsidiaries, ensuring the assets of the guarantor subsidiaries are in excess of a specified percentage of total group assets and ensuring certain financial ratios are maintained. The interest rate for this facility is determined based on market rates at the time amounts are drawn down. The Company is in compliance with all covenants.

 

98


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

19. INTEREST BEARING LIABILITIES (CONTINUED)

 

The following table sets out detail in respect of the major components of Interest Bearing Liabilities at 30 June, 2004.

 

Nature of Borrowing


   Amount
$m


   Interest
Rate %
p.a.


   Maturity
Date


Bank Overdrafts

              

Indian rupees

   0.8    3.80    At Call

Thai Baht

   1.8    1.80    At Call

United States dollars

   0.7    1.80    At Call
    
  
  

Total Bank Overdrafts

   3.3          
    
         

Bank Loans

              

Current

              

Malaysian ringgits

   7.0    3.00    2005

Other currencies

   0.8    2.50    2005
    
  
  
     7.8          
    
         

Non-Current

              

United States dollars

   101.6    4.07    2009
    
  
  

Total Bank Loans

   109.4          
    
         

Other Loans

              

Current

              

Australian dollars

   50.0    6.77    2005

United States dollars

   129.1    6.92    2005
    
  
  
     179.1          
    
         

Non-Current

              

Australian dollars

   50.0    6.54    2007

Australian dollars

   16.0    7.76    2007

United States dollars

   29.0    2.19    2006

United States dollars

   26.3    5.99    2007

United States dollars

   13.1    1.97    2010
    
  
  
     134.4          
    
         

Total Other Loans

   313.5          
    
         

Total Interest Bearing Liabilities

   426.2          
    
         

Maturity Schedule


              

Term to maturity:

              

Within one year

   190.2          

One to two years

   29.0          

Two to three years

   92.3          

Four to five years

   101.6          

Greater than five years

   13.1          
    
         

Total

   426.2          
    
         

 

     Consolidated

$ in Millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Net Interest Bearing Debt

              

Cash at bank and short-term deposits (net of restricted deposits)

   306.9    285.4    258.3

Current borrowings

   190.2    151.8    107.6

Non-current borrowings

   236.0    320.0    516.5
    
  
  

Net interest bearing debt

   119.3    186.4    365.8
    
  
  

 

99


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

20. PROVISIONS

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Current

                  

Provision for employee entitlements

   17.1     17.7     25.2  

Provision for contingencies

   4.6     4.8     2.8  

Provision for rationalisation and restructuring costs

   13.1     13.5     30.0  

Provision for Accufix Pacing Lead related expenses

   11.2     14.5     18.6  

Provision for claims

   6.0     7.0     8.8  
    

 

 

     52.0     57.5     85.4  

Provision for income tax

   2.6     3.1     1.9  
    

 

 

Total Current

   54.6     60.6     87.3  
    

 

 

Non-Current

                  

Provision for employee entitlements

   23.9     21.7     23.3  

Provision for deferred income tax

   20.2     21.5     24.4  
    

 

 

Total Non-Current

   44.1     43.2     47.7  
    

 

 

Total Provisions

   98.7     103.8     135.0  
    

 

 

Reconciliations of the carrying amount of each class of provision, except for employee entitlements, are set out below:  
     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Provision for contingencies

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   4.8     2.8     3.2  

Amounts charged to profit after tax from operating activities

   —       2.4     —    

Net foreign currency differences on translation of self-sustaining operations

   (0.2 )   (0.4 )   (0.4 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   4.6     4.8     2.8  
    

 

 

Provision for rationalisation and restructuring

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   13.5     30.0     111.9  

Acquisitions/(disposals) of entities

   —       —       (11.5 )

Amounts charged/(released) to profit/(loss) from operating activities

   9.7     10.1     20.3  

Amounts utilised for intended purposes

   (10.1 )   (25.7 )   (88.0 )

Net foreign currency differences on translation of self-sustaining operations

   —       (0.9 )   (2.7 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   13.1     13.5     30.0  
    

 

 

Provision for Accufix Pacing Lead related expenses

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   14.5     18.6     29.3  

Amounts utilised for intended purposes

   (3.1 )   (2.7 )   (10.7 )

Transfer to controlled entities

   —       —       —    

Amounts refunded by Court/recovered from Insurers

   —       —       1.5  

Net foreign currency differences on translation of self-sustaining operations

   (0.2 )   (1.4 )   (1.5 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   11.2     14.5     18.6  
    

 

 

Provision for claims (Captive Insurance Company)

                  

Balance at the beginning of the financial year

   7.0     8.8     10.9  

Amounts utilised for intended purposes

   (1.0 )   (1.8 )   (2.1 )
    

 

 

Balance at the end of the financial year

   6.0     7.0     8.8  
    

 

 

The tax effect of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the provision for deferred income tax are presented below:   
     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Depreciation on plant adjustments

   1.8     9.3     4.1  

Amortisation of Intangible Assets

   12.4     13.5     16.8  

Other

   6.0     (1.3 )   3.5  
    

 

 

Total

   20.2     21.5     24.4  
    

 

 

 

100


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

20. PROVISIONS (CONTINUED)

 

The present values of employee entitlements not expected to be settled within twelve months of balance date have been calculated using the following weighted averages:

 

     Consolidated

 

Employee Entitlements


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Assumed rate of increase in wage and salary rates

   2.0 %   3.4 %   4.0 %

Discount rate

   4.1 %   1.7 %   2.3 %

Settlement term (years)

   10-15     10-15     10-15  

Number of employees at year end

   11,530     12,013     12,160  

21.    OTHER LIABILITIES

                  
     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Current

                  

Deferred income

   —       1.1     1.2  
    

 

 

Total Current Other Liabilities

   —       1.1     1.2  
    

 

 

22.    DISSECTION OF LIABILITIES

                  
     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Secured

                  

Bank overdrafts and other loans

   0.6     1.1     1.5  

Bank loans

   0.8     0.6     0.9  

Unsecured

                  

Bank overdrafts

   2.7     1.5     13.1  

Bank loans

   108.6     14.8     26.5  

Other loans

   313.5     453.8     582.1  

Trade creditors

   124.1     130.1     166.6  

Other creditors

   38.6     27.5     29.8  

Provisions (as per Note 20)

   98.7     103.8     135.0  

Other liabilities (as per Note 21)

   —       1.1     1.2  
    

 

 

Total Unsecured Liabilities

   686.2     732.6     954.3  
    

 

 

Total Liabilities

   687.6     734.3     956.7  
    

 

 

23.    EXPENDITURE COMMITMENTS

                  
     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

(a) Capital expenditure commitments

                  

Contracted but not provided for in the financial statements:

   —       0.2     0.2  

Plant and equipment

   —       0.2     0.2  
    

 

 

Payable within one year

   —       0.2     0.2  
    

 

 

(b) Operating Lease Commitments

                  

Future operating lease commitments not provided for in the financial statements and payable:

                  

Within one year

   11.8     14.0     11.0  

One year or later and no later than five years

   30.1     33.3     29.1  

Later than five years

   14.4     11.1     15.6  
    

 

 

     56.3     58.4     55.7  
    

 

 

 

The Group leases property under operating leases expiring from one to twenty years. Leases generally provide the Group with a right of renewal at which time all terms are renegotiated.

 

101


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

24. SUPERANNUATION

 

Ansell Limited and certain controlled entities contribute to certain defined benefit and accumulation Superannuation Funds maintained to provide superannuation benefits for employees.

 

The defined benefit funds are listed below. Where applicable, amounts shown have been proportionately determined and are based on values extracted from the most recent financial report of the Fund. In respect of these funds, employer contributions are based on the advice of the plan’s actuary.

 

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Defined Benefit
Plan


   Assets

   Accrued
benefits


   Excess /
(Deficiency)


    Vested
benefits


   Assets

   Accrued
benefits


   Excess /
(Deficiency)


    Vested
benefits


   Assets

   Accrued
benefits


   Excess /
(Deficiency)


    Vested
benefits


Plan sponsored by the Company

                                                              

Pacific Dunlop Superannuation Fund

   37.4    26.7    10.7     22.5    41.3    26.7    14.6     26.3    41.3    26.7    14.6     26.3

Plans sponsored by other entities in the consolidated entity

                                         

Ansell Cash Balance Pension Plan

   33.0    44.0    (11.0 )   42.7    29.2    46.6    (17.4 )   45.3    44.7    54.9    (10.2 )   53.2

Ansell Healthcare Products Inc. Union Retirement Plan

   7.8    12.0    (4.2 )   12.0    6.7    12.3    (5.6 )   12.3    9.9    11.8    (1.9 )   11.8

Ansell Cash Balance Restoration Plan

   —      1.3    (1.3 )   1.3    —      1.6    (1.6 )   1.6    —      1.9    (1.9 )   1.9
    
  
  

 
  
  
  

 
  
  
  

 

Total for plans sponsored by the consolidated entity

   78.2    84.0    (5.8 )   78.5    77.2    87.2    (10.0 )   85.5    95.9    95.3    0.6     93.2
    
  
  

 
  
  
  

 
  
  
  

 

 

Pacific Dunlop Superannuation Fund     

Country

   Australia

Benefit type

   Defined benefit/ Accumulation

Basis of contribution

   Balance of Cost/Defined Contribution

Date of last actuarial valuation

   01/07/2002

Actuary

   Mercer Human Resource Consulting Pty. Ltd.

 

Plan net assets and vested benefits have been calculated at 30 June 2003, being the date of the most recent financial statements of the plan. Accrued benefits are based on an actuarial valuation undertaken at 1 July 2002. The values shown reflect amounts in respect of Ansell Limited employees only. Employees of South Pacific Tyres are also members of the fund through 1 April 2004. Effective 1 April 2004 the remaining Ansell members were transferred out of the Pacific Dunlop Superannuation Fund to Equipsuper (an independent Superannuation Fund). The transfer of assets from the Pacific Dunlop Superannuation Fund to Equipsuper has not as yet been completed.

 

Ansell Cash Balance Pension Plan     

Country

   USA

Benefit type

   Defined Benefit

Basis of contribution

   Statutory Funding Requirements

Date of last actuarial valuation

   31/03/2004

Actuary

   Retirement Plan Actuaries, Inc

Ansell Healthcare Products Inc. Union Retirement Plan

    

Country

   USA

Benefit type

   Defined Benefit

Basis of contribution

   Statutory Funding Requirements

Date of last actuarial valuation

   31/03/2004

Actuary

   Retirement Plan Actuaries, Inc

Ansell Cash Balance Restoration Plan

    

Country

   USA

Benefit type

   Defined Benefit

Basis of contribution

   Contributions equal benefits paid

Date of last actuarial valuation

   31/03/2004

Actuary

   Retirement Plan Actuaries, Inc

 

The Company and the controlled entities are obliged to contribute to the Superannuation Funds as a consequence of legislation or Trust Deeds; legal enforceability is dependent on the terms of the legislation or the Trust Deeds. In accordance with the various Trust Deeds, the Company and their controlled entities are under no legal or constructive obligation to make up any shortfall in the plans’ assets to meet payments due to employees and accordingly no provision has been raised for the deficiencies at 30 June 2004.

 

The directors, based on the advice of the trustees of the funds, are not aware of any changes in circumstances since the date of the most recent financial statements of the funds which would have a material impact on the overall financial position of the funds.

 

102


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

24. SUPERANNUATION (continued)

 

The directors, based on the advice of the trustees of the funds, are not aware of any changes in circumstances since the date of the most recent financial statements of the funds which would have a material impact on the overall financial position of the funds.

 

Definitions

 

Balance of cost:

   The consolidated entity’s contribution is assessed by the actuary by taking into account the members’ contribution and the values of the assets.

Defined contribution:

   The consolidated entity’s contribution is set out in the appropriate fund rules, usually as a fixed percentage of salary.

Accrued benefits:

   The present value of benefits which the fund is presently obliged to transfer in the future to members and beneficiaries as a result of membership of the fund to the calculation date.

Vested benefits:

   Benefits which are not conditional upon the continued membership of the respective fund or any factor other than resignation from the fund.

 

Details of contributions paid to the funds are as follows:

 

     Consolidated

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Contributions to defined benefit funds during the year

   9.9    10.7    3.2

Contributions to accumulation funds during the year

   1.1    1.5    0.8

 

25. OWNERSHIP-BASED REMUNERATION SCHEMES

 

Executive and Employee Share Plans

 

The Company has operated two share plans for employees and Directors of the consolidated entity:

 

    the Pacific Dunlop Executive Share Plan (“Executive Plan”), and

 

    the Pacific Dunlop Employee Share Plan (“Employee Plan”).

 

No issue of shares has been made under either Plan since February 1994 and the Board determined during 1996 that no further issues of shares will be made under the Executive Plan.

 

The Employee Plan permits full time and part time employees, who have completed three or more years continuous service within the consolidated entity and who do not participate in the Executive Plan to acquire 20 ordinary shares in the capital of the Company for each completed year of service. The shares are issued at market value as at the date of issue, payable as to 50 cents per share by the employee, the balance financed by an interest free loan from the Company repayable, at latest, on cessation of employment. The shares are not transferable while a loan remains outstanding, but carry a voting right and an entitlement to dividends (although dividends are applied in reduction of the loan). As at reporting date no offer to employees was outstanding. The aggregate number of Employee Plan Shares on issue may not exceed 5% of the total issued capital of the Company.

 

As stated above, the Executive Plan is no longer available for new issues. Shares issued under that Plan to selected employees (“Executives”) were paid up to 5 cents and were subject to restrictions for a determined period (for the 1993/1994 issue - 8 1/4 years). While partly paid, the shares are not transferable, carry no voting rights and no entitlement to dividends (but are entitled to participate in bonus or rights issues as if fully paid). The price payable for shares issued under the Executive Plan varies according to the event giving rise to a call being made. Market price at the date of the call is payable if an Executive ceases employment within the consolidated entity (other than for death, retrenchment or retirement) prior to expiration of the restriction period. Once restrictions cease the price payable upon a call being made will be the lesser of $10.00 ($2.50 for issues prior to 13 September 1991) and the last sale price of the Company’s ordinary shares on Australian Stock Exchange Limited. The aggregate number of Executive Plan Shares on issue could not exceed 5% of the total issued capital of the Company.

 

The Company’s accounting policy in respect of the Employee Plan is to recognise the paid up capital upon allotment and the receivable created by the loan to employees to acquire the shares. In respect of the Executive Plan, no amount was recognised upon issue, apart from the capital paid up on the shares, as the amount of the call payable was not quantifiable at the time of issue. Once a call had been made upon the shares and paid, the Company recognised the increase in paid up capital. The number of Employee Share Plan Shares and the number

 

103


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

25. OWNERSHIP-BASED REMUNERATION SCHEMES (CONTINUED)

 

of Executive Plan Shares (ordinary plan shares paid to five cents) as at balance date are shown in Note 5. A loss of $4,366 pre-tax in respect of the Employee Share Plan was recognised in the Company and the consolidated financial statements for 2004 (2003 -$13,288 pre-tax; 2002 - $535,381 pre-tax).

 

The market price of the Company’s shares as at 30 June 2004 was $7.74.

 

Options - Generally

 

At reporting date and the date of this report 1,825,000 unissued ordinary shares in the Company remain under option (refer Note 28 Director and Executive Disclosures for details).

 

Ansell Limited Stock Incentive Plan

 

Options and or Performance Share Rights (PSRs) are granted under the Ansell Limited Stock Incentive Plan (‘the Plan’). Decisions to grant options or PSRs are reviewed annually by the Board and are granted for no consideration. In general, grants are made annually, each award being three equal tranches. Each tranche is subject to performance targets set by the Board in respect of each of the three successive years. These rights entitle the holder to an equivalent number of fully-paid ordinary shares upon achievement of the performance targets.

 

The options may be exercised at a price based on the average of the Ansell share price on the five days preceding the grant. PSRs, when vested, are converted to fully-paid ordinary shares at no cost to the executive. Upon vesting participants are permitted to sell shares to cover tax liabilities and up to 50% of the remaining vested tranche. The balance remains restricted for a further 12 months. PSRs that have vested but remain restricted attract dividends.

 

During 2004 525,000 options and 150,000 PSRs were granted to the Chief Executive Officer upon his appointment as an executive, pursuant to the Plan. The options, which are subject to performance conditions, have an exercise price of $7.40, are not exercisable until one year after they vest and will lapse if not exercised on or before 30 June 2014. The PSRs convert to shares at no cost to the executive upon satisfaction of performance conditions. Both the options and PSRs were granted in three tranches, and are subject to the achievement of long-term performance targets and stretch targets established by the Board. Targets for financial year 2005 and future years are yet to be finalised and are subject to further Board consideration of the next stage of the Company’s development under the leadership of the new Chief Executive Officer. The vesting period for both the options and PSRs commenced 1 July 2004.

 

The options granted to the former Managing Director have now vested. The first tranche of 500,000 options are now exercisable at $6.32 for each share acquired. The second tranche of 500,000 options may be exercised, again at $6.32 for each share acquired, after 30 June 2005. Both tranches of options may only be exercised prior to 30 June 2006.

 

During the 2003 financial year the Chief Financial Officer was granted 300,000 options in three equal tranches of 100,000 options, each with an exercise price of $6.97 and subject to certain performance targets aligned to EBITA of the Ansell Healthcare business and the achievement of certain financial ratios for the 2003-2005 financial years. In respect of the first two tranches the performance targets have been met and these options have vested. The first tranche is exercisable after 30 June 2004, the second after 30 June 2005. These options expire on 23 September 2012.

 

During 2003 437,500 PSRs, exercisable in three equal tranches, were granted to senior Group executives pursuant to the Plan. The performance targets applicable to the first two tranches have been met and those tranches have vested. The third tranche is subject to the achievement of performance targets for the 2005 financial year.

 

104


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

25. OWNERSHIP-BASED REMUNERATION SCHEMES (CONTINUED)

 

During 2004 a further 665,000 PSRs, exercisable in three equal tranches, were granted to executives (including those granted to the Chief Executive Officer). The performance targets in respect of the first tranche of PSRs granted in the current year (with the exception of those granted to the Chief Executive Officer) have been achieved and these PSRs have vested. The second and third tranches are subject to the achievement of performance targets for the 2005 and 2006 financial years respectively.

 

In relation to the 2005 financial year the performance condition applicable to options and PSR’s issued to executives other than the Chief Executive Officer is that the EBITA for the Ansell Healthcare business meets or exceeds US$115 million. Performance targets for periods beyond financial year 2005 are under review pending Board consideration of the next stage of the Company’s development under the leadership of the recently-appointed Chief Executive Officer.

 

In accordance with the disclosure requirements of Australian Accounting Standards remuneration includes a proportion of the fair value of options and PSRs granted or outstanding during the year. The fair value is determined as at grant date and is progressively expensed over the vesting period for these securities. The amount included as remuneration (as disclosed in Note 28 Director and Executive Disclosures) is not related to, or indicative of, the benefit (if any) that individual executives may ultimately realise should the options or PSRs vest. No amount in respect of options or PSRs has been included in the determination of the remuneration of the Chief Executive Officer as the vesting period for these instruments commenced after balance date.

 

The fair value of options and PSRs is calculated at the date of grant using binomial tree techniques. The fair values and the factors and assumptions used in determining the fair values of the tranches of options and PSRs applicable for financial year 2004 are as follows:

 

Instrument


   Number
Issued


  

Grant

Date


   Expiry
Date


  

Fair

Value per

Option/PSR


   Exercise
Price


  

Share Price
on

Grant Date


   Estimated
Volatility


    Risk Free
Interest
Rate


    Dividend
Yield


 

Options

   1,000,000    12/4/2002    30/6/2006    $2.15    $6.32    $6.40    30.0 %   6.0 %   0.0 %

Options

   300,000    23/9/2002    23/9/2012    $2.66-$2.70    $6.97    $6.88    20.0 %   5.3 %   0.0 %

Options

   525,000    30/6/2004    30/6/2014    $2.35-$2.38    $7.40    $7.74    20.0 %   6.1 %   2.0 %

PSRs

   437,500    19/2/2003    30/6/2005    $6.07    N/A    $6.07    20.0 %   N/A     0.0 %

PSRs

   515,000    18/12/2003    30/6/2006    $5.89-$6.12    N/A    $6.19    20.0 %   N/A     2.0 %

PSRs

   150,000    30/6/2004    30/6/2007    $6.94-$7.22    N/A    $7.74    20.0 %   N/A     2.0 %

 

Estimated volatility is based on an analysis of historical share price data.

 

26. CONTINGENT LIABILITIES AND CONTINGENT ASSETS

 

Indemnities and Guarantees

 

Ansell Limited (‘the Company’) has previously entered into Deeds of Indemnity with each of the Directors of the Company and certain officers of controlled entities, in relation to liabilities that they may incur (other than to Group companies) as Directors of the Company and Directors and officers of certain controlled entities respectively, to the extent permitted by law and the Company’s Constitution.

 

The Company has also guaranteed the performance of certain wholly-owned controlled entities which have negative shareholders’ funds.

 

At this time, no liabilities the subject of any such indemnity or guarantee have been identified and, accordingly, it is not possible to quantify any financial obligation of the consolidated entity under these indemnities and of the Company pursuant to its guarantee.

 

Accufix Litigation

 

Only a limited number of lawsuits in relation to the Accufix Pacing Leads which have been made against certain Group Companies remain on foot, the majority of which have been brought in France.

 

As at 30 June 2004, the balance of the provisions made for settlements in relation to claims (approximately A$11.2 million) is considered adequate to address any remaining liability of members of the Ansell Group.

 

105


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

26. CONTINGENT LIABILITIES AND CONTINGENT ASSETS (CONTINUED)

 

Latex Allergy Litigation

 

As at 30 June 2004, there were approximately 46 product liability cases pending against one or more Ansell Group Companies in the United States in relation to allergic reaction to exposure to natural rubber latex gloves. In a number of cases, distributors of latex gloves who have also been named as defendants, are pursuing cross-claims and third party claims against United States Group Companies. It is not possible, at this time, to quantify the potential financial impact, of such cases, on the Group.

 

Business and Asset Sales

 

The Company and various Group Companies have, as part of the Group’s historical asset and business sale program, provided warranties, indemnities and other undertakings and, in some instances, the Company has guaranteed the warranties, indemnities and other obligations of various Group Companies, to the purchasers of Group assets and businesses. At this time, it is not possible to quantify the potential financial impact of those warranties, indemnities, undertakings or guarantees upon the economic entity. From time to time, the Company has received notices from purchasers of its businesses pursuant to the relevant sale agreements. No formal proceedings are currently on foot and, accordingly, it is not possible at this time to quantify the potential financial impact on the Group.

 

Exide Corporation

 

US legal proceedings are continuing against entities in the Exide Group in connection with the sale of the GNB business. Proceedings against those entities in the Exide Group that have not filed for bankruptcy (‘Non-bankrupt Entities’) were transferred to the Delaware bankruptcy court (‘the Court’) where the Court determined that all of the Ansell Group’s claims against the Non-bankrupt Entities may only be asserted against Exide Technologies, Inc., a company which has emerged from bankruptcy.

 

The Ansell Group has requested that the Court review its decision. The Court has yet to do so. The Ansell Group will continue to pursue recovery of the amounts owed by the Exide Group, but the Ansell Group only expects to recover stock in the reorganised company (Exide Technologies, Inc.). The ultimate amount of the Ansell Group’s claims have not yet been determined and therefore the amount and value of the stock that may be recovered from Exide Technologies Inc. is also undetermined.

 

106


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

27. Financial Instruments

 

Derivative Financial Instruments

 

The consolidated entity is involved in a range of derivative financial instruments, which can be defined in the following broad categories:

 

(i) Forward / Future Contracts

 

These transactions enable the consolidated entity to buy or sell specific amounts of foreign exchange, financial instruments or commodities at an agreed rate/price at a specified future date. Maturities of these contracts are principally between six months and two years.

 

(ii) Options

 

This is a contract between two parties, which gives the buyer of a put or call option the right, but not the obligation, to transact at a specified interest rate/exchange rate or commodity price at a future date, generally for a premium. Maturities of these contracts are principally between three months and two years.

 

(iii) Swaps

 

These agreements enable parties to swap interest rate (from or to a fixed or floating basis) or currency (from one currency to another currency) positions for a defined period of time. Maturities of the contracts are principally between two and five years.

 

Interest Rate Risk

 

The Company’s exposure to interest rate risk and the effective weighted average interest rate for classes of financial assets and financial liabilities is set out below:

 

Net Financial Assets/(Liabilities)

 

    

Weighted

Effective
Interest
Rate %


    Floating

    Fixed Interest maturing in:

  

Non

Interest
Bearing


   Total

$ in millions


       1 year
or less


    1 to 5
years


    Over 5
years


     

Financial Assets 2004

                                      

Recognised

                                      

Cash on hand and at bank

   1.1 %   20.5     —       —       —      50.2    70.7

Short-term deposits

   4.8 %   231.8     —       15.6     —      —      247.4

Receivables - trade

   N/A     —       —       —       —      183.0    183.0

Receivables - other

   6.1 %   62.8     —       —       —      46.5    109.3

Investments

   N/A     —       —       —       —      141.4    141.4
          

 

 

 
  
  

Total Financial Assets 2004

         315.1     —       15.6     —      421.1    751.8
          

 

 

 
  
  

Financial Liabilities 2004

                                      

Recognised

                                      

Payables - trade

   NA     —       —       —       —      124.1    124.1

Payables - other

   NA     —       —       —       —      38.6    38.6

Bank overdraft

   1.5 %   3.3     —       —       —      —      3.3

Bank and other loans

   5.6 %   321.2     —       101.7     —      —      422.9

Provision for employee entitlements

   N/A     —       —       —       —      41.0    41.0

Unrecognised

                                      

Net interest rate swaps

   2.0 %   (147.4 )   121.1     26.3     —      —      —  
          

 

 

 
  
  

Total Financial Liabilities 2004

         177.1     121.1     128.0     —      203.7    629.9
          

 

 

 
  
  

Net Financial Assets/(Liabilities) 2004

         138.0     (121.1 )   (112.4 )   —      217.4    121.9
          

 

 

 
  
  

Financial Assets 2003

                                      

Recognised

                                      

Cash on hand and at bank

   1.3 %   61.4     —       —       —      —      61.4

Short-term deposits

   3.9 %   238.4     —       —       —      —      238.4

Receivables - trade

   N/A     —       —       —       —      197.5    197.5

Receivables - other

   5.4 %   62.7     —       —       —      59.2    121.9

Investments

   N/A     —       —       —       —      141.4    141.4
          

 

 

 
  
  

Total Financial Assets 2003

         362.5     —       —       —      398.1    760.6
          

 

 

 
  
  

Financial Liabilities 2003

                                      

Recognised

                                      

Payables - trade

   N/A     —       —       —       —      130.1    130.1

Payables -other

   N/A     —       —       —       —      27.5    27.5

Bank overdraft

   3.2 %   1.3     —       —       —      1.3    2.6

Bank and other loans

   6.4 %   370.0     24.2     75.0     —      —      469.2

Provision for employee entitlements

   N/A     —       —       —       —      39.4    39.4

Unrecognised

                                      

Net interest rate swaps

   2.5 %   (319.4 )   168.8     150.6     —      —      —  
          

 

 

 
  
  

Total Financial Liabilities 2003

         51.9     193.0     225.6     —      198.3    668.8
          

 

 

 
  
  

Net Financial Assets/(Liabilities) 2003

         310.6     (193.0 )   (225.6 )   —      199.8    91.8
          

 

 

 
  
  

 

107


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

27. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

 

Provisions, including amounts contained within income tax, deferred income tax, contingencies, rationalisation and restructure, Accufix Pacing Lead related expenses and insurance claims amounting to $57.7 million (2003 - $64.4 million) are not included within the table above as it is considered that they do not meet the definition of a financial instrument.

 

A separate analysis of debt by currency can be found at Note 19 - Interest Bearing Liabilities.

 

Credit Risk and Net Fair Value

Recognised Financial Instruments:

 

(i) Credit Risk

 

The credit risk on financial assets, excluding investments, of the consolidated entity which have been recognised on the Statement of Financial Position, is the carrying amount, net of any provision for doubtful debts. The consolidated entity minimises concentrations of credit risk by undertaking transactions with a large number of customers and counter parties in various countries. The consolidated entity is not materially exposed to any individual overseas country or individual customer.

 

(ii) Net Fair Value

 

The Company considers that the carrying amount of recognised financial assets and financial liabilities approximates their net fair value.

 

Refer to Note 1 for accounting policies in respect of the carrying values of financial assets and financial liabilities.

 

Unrecognised Financial Instruments:

 

Credit risk on unrecognised derivative contracts is minimised as counterparties are recognised financial intermediaries with acceptable credit ratings determined by a recognised rating agency. It is not felt that there is a material exposure to any single counterparty or group of counterparties. The consolidated entity’s exposure is almost entirely (over 99%) to banks.

 

The following table displays:

 

(i) Face Value

 

This is the contract’s value upon which a market rate is applied to produce a gain or loss which becomes the settlement value of the derivative financial instrument.

 

(ii) Credit Risk

 

This is the maximum exposure to the consolidated entity in the event that all counterparties who have amounts outstanding to the consolidated entity under derivative financial instruments, fail to honour their side of the contracts. The consolidated entity’s exposure is almost entirely to banks (see (v) below). Amounts owed by the consolidated entity under derivative financial instruments are not included.

 

(iii) Net Fair Value

 

This is the amount at which the instrument could be realised between willing parties in a normal market in other than a liquidation or forced sale environment. The net amount owed by / (owing to) financial institutions under all derivative financial instruments would have been $1.6 million (2003 - ($11.1) million; 2002 - ($23.8) million), if all contracts were closed out on 30 June 2004.

 

     Face Value

   Credit Risk

   Net Fair Value

 

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Foreign Exchange Contracts

                                                

Purchase/Sale Contracts:

                                                

- U.S. dollars

   77.0    112.0    329.7    0.4    0.3    1.6    0.2     (0.4 )   (7.3 )

- Australian dollars

   22.0    47.5    49.4    —      1.8    —      —       1.8     —    

- Other currencies

   33.4    44.8    216.5    0.2    —      2.5    0.1     (0.9 )   2.4  

Cross Currency Swaps:

                                                

- U.S. dollars

   53.8    69.4    96.5    1.9    2.7    2.2    1.9     2.7     (1.5 )

- Other currencies

   —      —      16.5    —      —      —      —       —       (2.1 )

Foreign Exchange Options

                                                

Zero Cost Collar

                                                

- Euro/U.S. dollars

   193.5    103.5    —      2.2    0.8    —      0.7     (2.6 )   —    

Premium Paid (Put)

                                                

- Euro/U.S. dollars

   —      19.8    —      —      0.2    —      —       0.2     —    

Interest Rate Contracts

                                                

Interest Rate Swaps:

                                                

- U.S. dollars

   141.0    369.4    435.1    0.4    0.3    3.0    (1.2 )   (10.9 )   (14.5 )

- Australian dollars

   50.0    100.0    300.0    —      —      —      (0.1 )   (1.0 )   (0.8 )

- Other currencies

   —      —      17.5    —      —      —      —       —       —    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  

 

 

Total

   570.7    866.4    1,461.2    5.1    6.1    9.3    1.6     (11.1 )   (23.8 )
    
  
  
  
  
  
  

 

 

 

108


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

27. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

 

From time to time in the ordinary course of business, the consolidated entity enters into forward exchange contracts to hedge a proportion of its purchase and sale commitments denominated in foreign currencies (principally US dollars). Hedge cover does not exceed 12 months.

 

(iv) Market/Liquidity Risk

 

The consolidated entity seeks to reduce the risk of:

 

(a) being forced to exit derivative financial instrument positions at below their real worth; or

 

(b) finding it cannot exit the position at all, due to lack of liquidity in the market;

 

by:

 

(a) dealing only in liquid contracts dealt by many counterparties; and

 

(b) dealing only in large and highly liquid and stable international markets.

 

(v) Credit Risk by Maturity

 

The following table indicates the value of amounts owing by counterparties by maturity. Based on the Group policy of not having overnight exposures to an entity rated lower than A- by Standard & Poor’s or A3 by Moody’s Investors Service, it is felt the risk to the consolidated entity of the counterparty default loss is not material.

 

     Foreign Exchange
Related Contracts


   Interest Rate
Contracts


   Foreign Exchange
Options


   Total

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

   2003

   2002

Term:

                                                           

0 to 6 mths

   0.6    2.1    4.1    —      0.3    —      1.1    0.4    —      1.7    2.8    4.1

6 to 12 mths

   0.1    —      —      —      —      —      1.1    0.6    —      1.2    0.6    —  

1 to 2 yrs

   —      0.2    —      —      —      3.0    —      —      —      —      0.2    3.0

2 to 5 yrs

   1.8    2.5    2.2    0.4    —      —      —      —      —      2.2    2.5    2.2
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  

Total

   2.5    4.8    6.3    0.4    0.3    3.0    2.2    1.0    —      5.1    6.1    9.3
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  

 

(vi) Historical Rate Rollovers

 

It is the consolidated entity’s policy not to engage in historical rate rollovers except in circumstances where the maturity date falls on a bank holiday. In these instances, settlement occurs on the next trading day.

 

(vii) Hedges and Future Transactions

 

The following table shows the consolidated entity’s deferred gains and (losses), both realised and unrealised, that are currently held on the Statement of Financial Position and the expected timing of recognition as revenue or expense:

 

     Interest Rate

   Foreign Exchange

 

$ in millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

    2003

   2002

 

Exposures

                                

Less than 1 year

   —      —      —      (0.1 )   1.9    (0.5 )

Realised Swaps Deferred

                                

Less than 1 year

   0.7    0.4    0.1                  

1 to 2 years

   0.7    0.8    0.7                  

2 to 5 years

   4.9    0.9    2.2                  

 

109


PART I

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

28. DIRECTOR AND EXECUTIVE DISCLOSURES

 

Specified Directors:

 

The following persons were directors of Ansell Limited during the financial year:

 

E.D. Tweddell - Chairman

 

H. Boon - Group Managing Director and Chief Executive Officer (retired 30 June 2004)

 

P.L. Barnes

 

L.D. Crandall

 

H.J. Elliott

 

S.P. Gold (resigned 16 April 2004. Alternate to M.J. McConnell from 16 April 2004)

 

M.J. McConnell (appointed 16 April 2004. Previously alternate to S.P. Gold)

 

Specified Executives (other than directors) with the Greatest Authority for Strategic Direction and Management:

 

The following persons were the specified executives with the greatest authority for the strategic direction and management of the consolidated entity during the financial year:

 

Name


  

Position


  

Employer


W. Heintz    Senior Vice President and Regional, Director - Europe    Ansell Healthcare Europe N.V.
R. Jilla    Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer    Ansell Healthcare Products LLC.
N. O’Donnell    Senior Vice President and Regional Director - Asia Pacific    Ansell Limited
W. Reed    Senior Vice President and Regional Director - Americas    Ansell Healthcare Products LLC.
W. Reilly, Jr.    Senior Vice President and General Counsel    Ansell Healthcare Products LLC.
D. Tough   

Appointed as an executive effective 11 May 2004

and as Group Managing Director and Chief Executive

Officer 1 July 2004

   Ansell Healthcare Products LLC.

 

Remuneration of specified directors and specified executives:

 

Principles used to determine the nature and amount of remuneration

 

The Board’s Nomination, Remuneration and Evaluation Committee is responsible for reviewing the remuneration policies and practices of the Company, including the compensation arrangements for the Managing Director and senior management and, within the aggregate amount approved by shareholders, the fees for Non-executive Directors. The fees of the Chairman and Non-executive Directors are set within the aggregate amount approved by shareholders, at levels which represent the responsibilities of, and the time commitments provided by, those Directors in discharging their duties. The fees paid to Directors take into account what is paid by comparable companies, and what is necessary to attract high-calibre people to consider Board appointment. The Board will continue to review its remuneration strategies in relation to Non-Executive Directors from time to time, in line with general industry practice.

 

Non-executive Directors

 

The total annual amount of fees payable to the Chairman and Non-executive Directors is $750,000, which was set in 1989. This is the maximum aggregate amount, and the Company does not, at this time, intend distributing the full amount by way of fees. The Board, prior to setting annual fees for the 2004 financial year, obtained independent expert advice and undertook a review of comparable companies. The fees payable to the Non-executive Directors for this year were adjusted to reflect the termination of the retirement payment arrangements as at 30 June 2003. Each Non-executive Director is required to reinvest a minimum of 10 per cent of their gross fee in acquiring shares in the Company until their shareholding is equal to at least one year’s fees, pursuant to the Non-executive Directors’ Share Plan. The Plan enables Non-executive Directors to elect to apply up to 100 per cent of their fees in acquiring shares in the Company. The Non-executive Directors’ Share Plan is not a performance-based share plan and is not intended as an incentive component of a Non-executive Director’s remuneration. Shareholders approved the participation by Non-executive Directors in the Plan in October 2000 and April 2002 (on amended terms). This Plan essentially involves each Non-executive Director using his or her own after-tax money to buy shares on ASX at market price (i.e. involving no discount) to increase his or her direct holding in the Company. Accordingly, no performance conditions were proposed to attach as a precondition for purchase of the shares. Each Director is, however, generally required to retain shares acquired under the Plan for the period he or she holds office as a Director.

 

110


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

28. DIRECTOR AND EXECUTIVE DISCLOSURES (CONTINUED)

 

Senior Executives

 

Executive compensation is composed of several elements that need to be combined as an integrated whole for the Company to receive the best return from its expenditure. The compensation approach is based on there being consistency between countries but with cost related to market practice in each location.

 

Executive compensation is composed of fixed (salary and benefits) and variable (short and long term incentives) components. The weighting of fixed and variable aims to provide a strong focus on performance. The balance between short and long term incentives recognises that senior executives are responsible, along with the Board, for the sustainable health and success of the company. Its purpose is to provide compensation which allows the Company to secure the services of high calibre executives and focus them towards a common vision and achievement of goals. As part of this purpose it should foster teamwork, innovation and calculated risk taking aimed at achieving sustainable business improvements and maximising shareholder value.

 

Participants in the senior executive compensation program are as follows:

 

    CEO

 

    Executives in Ansell Grades E1-E3 and other key management talent as designated by the CEO and or the Compensation Committee.

 

Compensation of participants is composed of four regular elements as follows:

 

    Base salary

 

    Benefits

 

    Short term incentive

 

    Long term incentive

 

Other components such as special retention programs may be used from time to time as needed.

 

Base salary

 

The terms of employment of all executive management contain a fixed remuneration component, or base salary. In general, base salary is dependent upon the level and scope of an executive’s position, is targeted at a norm within benchmarked industries, and takes into account individual performance.

 

Benefits

 

Executives receive benefits such as motor vehicle allowances, home office expenses, contributions to Superannuation/Pension plans and executive insurance.

 

Short term incentive (STI)

 

An annual cash-based incentive program operates to reward individual performance against agreed performance targets. This target based STI plan is used to reinforce business plans by focusing on Key Performance Indicators (KPI’s) which are reviewed with the Remuneration Committee each year. By including company performance as a significantly weighted measure of performance, payouts will be directly linked to overall Company performance. Each executive has a target STI Opportunity (STIO) depending on the accountabilities of the role, impact on the organisation and geographic location. For Senior executives the maximum target bonus opportunity is 45% of base salary.

 

Each year the Remuneration Committee considers appropriate targets and KPI’s to link the STI and the level of payout if targets are met. For the year ended 30 June 2004 the KPI’s linked to STIO were based on functional/individual, regional and total Company objectives. The KPI’s required performance in growing revenue, improving EBITA and reducing Working Capital. The remuneration committee set a threshold level at which STI payouts are triggered and this will usually represent 50% of the target award. A stretch goal is also established for each KPI allowing up to 200% of the target award to be earned.

 

Long term incentive

 

In 2002, the Company established the Ansell Limited Stock Incentive Plan (the Plan). Under the Plan, Ansell may make grants of options or Performance Share Rights (PSR’s), which are subject to the achievement of performance targets set by the Board. Refer to Note 25 Ownership-Based Remuneration Schemes for details on options and PSRs.

 

111


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

28. DIRECTOR AND EXECUTIVE DISCLOSURES (CONTINUED)

 

Details of remuneration

 

Details of the remuneration of all directors of Ansell Limited and each of the specified executives of the consolidated entity are set out in the following tables.

 

Specified Directors of Ansell Limited

 

2004

 

     Primary

   Post-employment

   Equity

   Other

    

Name


  

Cash salary
and fees

$


  

Cash bonus

$


  

Super-
annuation
contribution
(a)

$


  

Retirement
benefits

$


  

Notional
value of
equity
compensation
(b)

$


  

Termination
benefits

$


  

Other

(c)

$


  

Total

$


Non-executive

                                       

E. D. Tweddell (Chairman)

   234,375         21,094                        255,469

P. L. Barnes

   91,875         8,287                        100,162

L. D. Crandall

   82,500         7,425                        89,925

H. J. Elliott

   82,500         7,425                        89,925

S. P. Gold (resigned 16 April 2004)

   65,625         5,906                        71,531

M. J. McConnell (appointed

16 April 2004)

   17,187         1,547                        18,734

Executive

                                       

H. Boon (CEO and Managing Director) (retired 30 June 2004) (d) (f)

   966,981    419,545    356,636         537,500    2,204,960    714,893    5,200,515
    
  
  
       
  
  
  

Total all specified Directors

   1,541,043    419,545    408,320         537,500    2,204,960    714,893    5,826,261
    
  
  
       
  
  
  

 

Specified executives of the consolidated entity

 

2004

 

     Primary

   Post-employment

   Equity

   Other

    

Name


  

Cash salary
and fees

$


  

Cash
bonus

$


  

Super-
annuation
contribution
(a)

$


  

Retirement
benefits

$


  

Notional
value of
equity
compensation
(b)

$


  

Termination
benefits

$


  

Other

(c)

$


  

Total

$


W. Heintz (e) (h)

   386,845    190,824    125,926         152,988         259,624    1,116,207

R. Jilla (d) (g) (h)

   398,978    190,009    29,162         407,732         51,223    1,077,104

N. O’Donnell (h)

   196,000    61,985    39,004         99,176         32,160    428,325

W. Reed (d) (h)

   363,401    122,118    19,605         142,945         58,032    706,101

W. Reilly (d) (h)

   334,866    159,351    19,092         97,572         22,139    633,020

D. Tough (appointed as an executive 11 May 2004 and CEO and Managing Director 1 July 2004) (d)

   124,715                             1,021    125,736
    
  
  
       
       
  

Total all specified executives

   1,804,805    724,287    232,789         900,413         424,199    4,086,493
    
  
  
       
       
  

 

(a) For Directors includes notional contributions at the rate that satisfies Australian Superannuation Guarantee requirements. No amounts were required to be paid to the Australian Superannuation fund in respect of the year ended 30 June 2004 upon advice of the Trustee. For US based specified executives, includes contributions to US benefit or non-qualified pension plans as applicable and to a European pension plan for Mr Heintz. For Messrs Boon and O’Donnell it also includes an imputed notional contribution to the Australian superannuation fund calculated at an actuarial rate.

 

(b) In accordance with the requirements of Accounting Standards, remuneration includes a proportion of the notional value of options or PSRs granted or outstanding during the year. The notional value is determined as at grant date and is progressively allocated over the ‘vesting period’ or these securities. The amount included as remuneration is not related to, nor indicative of the benefit (if any) that individual executives may ultimately realise should the options or PSRs vest.

 

(c) Includes cash benefits such as motor vehicle allowances, home office expenses, executive insurance, housing allowances and statutory amounts paid on termination including accumulated annual leave and long service leave.

 

(d) US-based Executives are paid in US$. The average exchange rate for June 2004 is US$0.7016 = A$1.00.

 

(e) Europe-based Executive paid in Euros. The average exchange rate for June 2004 is Euros 0.5775 = A$1.00.

 

112


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

28. DIRECTOR AND EXECUTIVE DISCLOSURES (CONTINUED)

 

(f) Notional value of Equity Compensation includes the notional value of 500,000 options granted in April 2002. The options, which have an exercise price of $6.32 for each share acquired, vested upon achievement of performance conditions applicable to the 2004 financial year.

 

(g) Notional value of Equity Compensation includes the notional value of 100,000 options granted in September 2002. The options, which have an exercise price of $6.97 for each share acquired, vested upon achievement of performance conditions applicable to the 2004 financial year.

 

(h) Notional value of Equity Compensation includes the notional vale of PSRs granted in 2002 and 2003 that vested upon achievement of performance conditions applicable to the 2004 financial year.

 

Service agreements

 

Remuneration and other terms of employment for executives are specified in Letters of Appointment. Specified US based executives are considered to be employed ‘at will’. Terms regarding the termination of employment are covered under the Company’s Severance Policy. It is Company policy that specified US executives employed for more than 12 months will, in general, receive termination payments equal to 12 months’ base salary plus certain other benefits. The Letters of Appointment provide the framework for the provision of other benefits including participation in the Short Term Incentive Plan, Long Term Incentive Plan, Medical Health Plans, Superannuation and Retirement plans where eligible.

 

Specified executives based in Europe and Australia are employed according to the terms and conditions of employment as specified in each jurisdiction.

 

W. Heintz

 

    At will employment

 

    Base salary for the year ended 30 June 2004 EURO 223,403 to be reviewed annually by the remuneration committee.

 

    Payment of termination benefit on early termination by Ansell other than for gross misconduct equal to one times annual base salary.

 

R. Jilla

 

    At will employment

 

    Base salary for the year ended 30 June 2004 US$279,923 to be reviewed annually by the remuneration committee.

 

    Payment of termination benefit on early termination by Ansell other than for gross misconduct equal to one times annual base salary.

 

N. O’Donnell

 

    Employed under Australian federal employment law and common law legislation

 

    Base salary for the year ended 30 June 2004 A$196,000 to be reviewed annually by the remuneration committee.

 

    Payment of termination benefit on early termination by Ansell other than for gross misconduct equal to a maximum of one times total annual remuneration package.

 

W. Reed

 

    At will employment

 

    Base salary for the year ended 30 June 2004 US$254,962 to be reviewed annually by the remuneration committee.

 

    Payment of termination benefit on early termination by Ansell other than for gross misconduct equal to one times annual base salary.

 

W. Reilly

 

    At will employment

 

    Base salary for the year ended 30 June 2004 US$234,942 to be reviewed annually by the remuneration committee.

 

    Payment of termination benefit on early termination by Ansell other than for gross misconduct equal to one times annual base salary.

 

D. Tough

 

    At will employment

 

    Base salary for the period between his appointment on 11 May 2004 and 30 June 2004 US$650,000 per annum, which will also apply to the 2005 financial year. Mr Tough upon his appointment also received a grant of 525,000 options, exercisable at $7.40, and 150,000 PSRs, which are subject to performance conditions related to financial years 2005, 2006 and 2007.

 

    Payment of termination benefit on early termination by Ansell other than for gross misconduct equal to one and a half times annual base salary if termination occurs within the first three years of his employment, and one times annual base salary if termination occurs after the third anniversary of his commencement date. In certain circumstances, such as a substantial diminution of responsibility, the Company may be deemed to have terminated employment and will be liable to make payments equivalent to 18 months’ remuneration.

 

113


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

28. DIRECTOR AND EXECUTIVE DISCLOSURES (CONTINUED)

 

Equity Instruments

 

Refer to Note 25 Ownership-Based Remuneration Schemes for details on options and PSRs.

 

Options over equity instruments granted as remuneration

 

Option Holdings:

 

Options held by specified directors and specified executives as at balance date and the movements during the year are as follows:

 

     Held at
1 July 2003


   Granted as
Remuneration


   Held at
30 June 2004


   Vested and
exercisable at
30 June 2004


Specified directors

                   

H. Boon (a)

   1,000,000    —      1,000,000    500,000

Specified executives

                   

R. Jilla (b)

   300,000    —      300,000    100,000

D. Tough (c)

   —      525,000    525,000    —  

 

(a) Options were granted on 12 April 2002, have an exercise price of $6.32, an expiry date of 30 June 2006 and a fair value as at 30 June 2004 of $2.15.

 

(b) Options were granted on 23 September 2002, have an exercise price of $6.97 and an expiry date of 23 September 2012. Tranches 1 & 2 have a fair value as at 30 June 2004 of $2.66 and Tranche 3 has a fair value of $2.70.

 

(c) Options were granted on 11 May 2004, have an exercise price of $7.40 and an expiry date of 30 June 2014. Tranche 1 has a fair value at 30 June 2004 of $2.35, Tranche 2 $2.36 and Tranche 3 $2.38. The vesting period for these options commenced 1 July 2004.

 

Performance Share Rights (PSRs) granted as remuneration

 

PSR Holdings:

 

PSRs held by specified executives as at balance date and the movements during the year are as follows:

 

     Held at
1 July 2003


   Granted as
Remuneration


   Vested and
converted


   Held at
30 June 2004


Specified executives

                   

W. Heintz (a)

   25,000    30,000    8,333    46,667

R. Jilla (a)

   —      50,000    —      50,000

N. O’Donnell (a)

   15,000    20,000    5,000    30,000

W. Reed (a)

   30,000    25,000    10,000    45,000

W. Reilly (a)

   25,000    15,000    8,333    31,667

D. Tough (b)

   —      150,000    —      150,000

 

(a) Grants of PSRs during the year were made on 18 December 2003 in three tranches with tranche 1 being applicable to the 2004 financial year.

 

(b) Grant of PSRs during the year was made on 11 May 2004 in three tranches. The vesting period for these PSRs commenced 1 July 2004.

 

PSRs, when vested, are converted into fully-paid ordinary shares and issued at no cost to the executive.

 

114


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

28. DIRECTOR AND EXECUTIVE DISCLOSURES (CONTINUED)

 

Equity Instruments (continued)

 

Equity holdings and transactions

 

The movement during the reporting period in the number of ordinary shares of Ansell Limited held directly, indirectly or beneficially, by each specified director and specified executive, including their personally-related entities is as follows:

 

     Held at
1 July 2003


   Purchases (a)

   Received
on
vesting
of PSRs


   Sales

   Held at
30 June
2004


Specified directors

                        

E. D. Tweddell

   30,872    3,348    —      —      34,220

P. L. Barnes

   10,370    1,315    —      —      11,685

H. Boon

   56,701    —      —      —      56,701

L. D. Crandall

   3,828    4,280    —      —      8,108

H. J. Elliott

   7,798    1,178    —      —      8,976

S. P. Gold (b)

   24,437,905    6,174    —      8,000,000    16,444,079

M. J. McConnell

   20,000    6,406    —      —      26,406

Specified executives

                        

W. Heintz

   —      —      8,333    —      8,333

R. Jilla

   6,000    —      —      —      6,000

N. O’Donnell

   —      —      5,000    —      5,000

W. Reed

   100    —      10,000    6,498    3,602

W. Reilly

   —      —      8,333    2,788    5,545

D. Tough

   —      —      —      —      —  

 

(a) Includes shares purchased on market pursuant to the Non-executive Directors’ Share Plan.

 

(b) Mr Gold has an indirect non-beneficial interest in 16,428,840 shares by virtue of a 10 per cent limited partnership interest in Trefoil International III, L.P., which is a related body corporate of Shamrock Holdings of California Inc (June 2003: 24,428,840 shares).

 

Other Transactions with specified directors and specified executives

 

From time to time, specified directors and specified executives of the Company or its controlled entities, or their personally-related entities, may purchase goods from the consolidated entity. These purchases are on terms and conditions no more favourable than those entered into by unrelated customers and are trivial or domestic in nature.

 

29. SERVICE AGREEMENTS

 

The Company has no service agreements with the Non-executive Directors.

 

115


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

30. NOTES TO THE INDUSTRY SEGMENTS REPORT

 

(a) Operating Revenue

 

The Operating Revenue of Discontinued Businesses represents the external sales to the date of disposal and the cash received/receivable from the sale of such businesses (net of disposal costs).

 

(b) Unallocated Revenue and Costs

 

Represents costs of Statutory Head Office, part of the costs of Ansell Healthcare’s Corporate Head Office and non-sales revenue.

 

(c) Non Recurring Items

 

The result for the 2004 financial year includes write-downs of property, plant and equipment of $8.8 million relating to the closure of certain manufacturing facilities, expenses and provisions relating to transitional issues carried over from discontinued businesses and the previous company structure of $9.7 million, the majority of which arose from the sale of the GNB battery business to Exide Technologies Inc and the latter’s involvement in, and exit during the year, from Chapter 11 proceedings. Offsetting these charges were refunds of sales tax of $17.8million relating to discontinued businesses in Australia.

 

(d) Tax

 

June 2002 includes the write off of tax balances attributable to Australian operations of $15.2 million and tax attributable to Discontinued Businesses.

 

(e) Cash

 

Cash also includes Accufix Pacing Leads restricted deposits.

 

(f) Inter-Segment Transactions

 

Significant inter-segment sales were made by Asia Pacific - $216.3 million (2003 - $258.2 million; 2002 - $304.9 million) and Americas - $233.0 million (2003 - $254.7 million; 2002 - $188.3 million). Inter-segment sales are predominantly made at the same prices as sales to major customers. Operating revenue is shown net of inter-segment values. Accordingly, the Operating revenues shown in each segment reflect only the external sales made by that segment.

 

(g) Industry Segments

 

The consolidated entity comprises the following main business segments:

 

Occupational Healthcare - manufacture and sale of occupational health and safety gloves.

 

Professional Healthcare - manufacture and sale of medical, surgical and examination gloves for hand barrier protection and infection control.

 

Consumer Healthcare - manufacture and sale of condoms, household gloves and other personal products.

 

Discontinued Businesses - represents former Industry Segment businesses which have been sold or abandoned.

 

(h) Regions

 

The allocation of Operating Revenue and Operating Results reflect the geographical regions in which the products are sold to external customers. Assets Employed are allocated to the geographical regions in which the assets are located.

 

Asia Pacific - manufacturing facilities in 4 countries and sales.

 

Americas - manufacturing facilities in USA and Mexico and significant sales activity.

 

Europe - principally a sales region with one manufacturing facility in the UK.

 

Sales revenue in Australia for the Healthcare operations during 2004 were $108.3 million (2003 - $86.0 million; 2002 $76.8 million). The only material foreign country in terms of sales revenue from continuing operations is United States of America with revenue of $472.8 million in 2004 (2003 - $582.0 million; 2002 $723.3 million).

 

116


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

30. NOTES TO THE INDUSTRY SEGMENTS REPORT (CONTINUED)

 

    

2004

$m


  

2003

$m


  

2002

$m


(i) Segment Capital Expenditure

              

Occupational Healthcare

   5.4    3.2    6.7

Professional Healthcare

   4.4    8.6    12.7

Consumer Healthcare

   3.3    3.4    1.5

Discontinued Businesses

   —      —      12.0

(j) Region Capital Expenditure

              

Asia Pacific

   8.7    10.1    13.6

Americas

   3.4    4.2    5.3

Europe

   1.0    0.9    2.0

(k) Segment Depreciation

              

Occupational Healthcare

   8.7    11.0    15.7

Professional Healthcare

   11.5    15.5    18.8

Consumer Healthcare

   5.1    4.8    5.6

Discontinued Businesses

   —      —      11.1

(l) Segment Other Non Cash Expenses (excluding Provision for Rationalisation and Write-down of Assets separately disclosed)

              

Occupational Healthcare

   6.9    8.3    8.9

Professional Healthcare

   1.5    0.7    1.9

Consumer Healthcare

   4.9    2.9    5.1

Discontinued Businesses

   —      —      14.8

 

117


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

31. NOTES TO THE STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

(a) Reconciliation of Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities to Net Profit/(Loss) after Income Tax

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Net profit/(loss) after income tax

   72.6     52.5     (113.0 )

Add/(less) non-cash items:

                  

Depreciation

   23.8     29.5     50.3  

Amortisation

   22.9     27.0     32.0  

Provision for doubtful debts - trade

   1.2     (2.5 )   (2.9 )

Write off of FITB attributable to Australian tax losses

   —       —       15.2  

Write down of assets

   1.0     6.1     75.2  

Write down of property, plant and equipment

   8.8     —       69.3  

Share of net gain of associate and joint venture entities

   —       (0.3 )   (1.9 )

Add/(less) items classified as investing/financing activities:

                  

Interest revenue

   (9.0 )   (8.0 )   (15.5 )

Borrowing costs

   29.4     37.8     70.2  

Loss/(gain) on sale of investments, properties, plant and equipment

   (0.8 )   (5.6 )   5.6  

Gain on sale of controlled entities and businesses

   —       —       (25.7 )
    

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities before change in assets and liabilities

   149.9     136.5     158.8  

Change in assets and liabilities net of effect from acquisitions and disposals of controlled entities and businesses:

                  

(Increase)/Decrease in debtors

   24.9     34.5     (0.3 )

(Increase)/Decrease in inventories

   (2.6 )   47.2     39.4  

Decrease/(Increase) in prepaid expenses

   (0.8 )   4.9     (2.4 )

(Increase)/Decrease in deferred expenses

   —       —       4.3  

Increase/(Decrease) in creditors and bills payable

   (6.0 )   (36.5 )   78.3  

(Decrease)/Increase in provisions and other liabilities

   7.8     (31.9 )   (203.1 )

Increase/(Decrease) in provision for deferred income tax

   (1.3 )   (2.9 )   2.3  

(Increase)/Decrease in future income tax benefit

   7.8     17.7     24.7  

(Decrease)/Increase in provision for income tax

   (0.5 )   1.2     (8.5 )

Other non-cash items

   —       (9.1 )   19.6  
    

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

   179.2     161.6     113.1  
    

 

 

 

(b) Components of Cash

 

For the purposes of the Statements of Cash Flows, cash includes cash on hand and at banks and investments in money market instruments, net of outstanding bank overdrafts. Cash, at the end of the financial year, as shown in the Statements of Cash Flows, comprises:

 

     Note

   Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


      2004

    2003

    2002

 

Cash on hand

   11    0.9     0.6     0.2  

Cash at bank

   11    69.8     60.8     72.0  

Short-term deposits

   11    237.1     224.6     186.3  

Restricted deposits*

   11    10.3     13.8     18.4  

Bank overdrafts

   19    (3.3 )   (2.6 )   (14.6 )
         

 

 

          314.8     297.2     262.3  
         

 

 

 

* Refer to note 11 for further details on these amounts.

 

118


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

32. ACQUISITION OF CONTROLLED ENTITIES AND MATERIAL BUSINESSES

 

During the year the
following businesses
were acquired:


 

Date of Acquisition


 

Voting

Shares

Acquired

%


  

Cost of

Acquisition
$ million


   Net Tangible Assets
Acquired $ million


   Description of
Purchase
Consideration


 

No material acquisitions were made during the year.

 

33. DISPOSAL OF CONTROLLED ENTITIES AND MATERIAL BUSINESSES

 

During the year the
following material
businesses were

disposed of:


 

Date of Disposal


 

Voting

Shares

Disposed

%


  

Consideration
(Cash)

$ million


  

Net Tangible

Assets Disposed
$ million


   Profit / (Loss) on
Disposal $ million


 

No material disposals were made during the year.

 

34. NON-DIRECTOR RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES

 

Ansell Limited is the parent entity of all entities detailed in Note 37 and from time to time has dealings on normal commercial terms and conditions with those related entities, the effects of which are eliminated in the consolidated financial statements.

 

Disclosures in respect of certain transactions with controlled entities and related parties and amounts paid to or received therefrom are as set out in the details below. Other transactions with related entities, which are eliminated on consolidation, include the lease of certain properties, the supply of materials and labour and the provision of both short and long term finance in the form of varying financial instruments, all of which are conducted on normal commercial terms and conditions.

 

(a) Transactions with Associates and Other Related Companies

 

Effective 1 July 2001, the consolidated entity discontinued equity accounting for its interest in South Pacific Tyres N.Z. Ltd. During the course of the year, the consolidated entity received royalties from South Pacific Tyres NZ Ltd. In prior years the Company and consolidated entity conducted financial transactions with associated companies, while still having an ownership interest, on normal commercial terms and conditions. The nature and amounts of these transactions are detailed as follows:

 

     Consolidated

    

2004

$m


  

2003

$m


  

2002

$m


Sale of goods and services

              

Car Parts Distribution Pty Ltd

   —      —      7.5

Royalty revenue

              

South Pacific Tyres N.Z. Ltd.

   1.3    —      0.4

Dividend revenue

              

Pacific Marine Batteries Pty. Ltd.

   —      —      —  

 

119


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

34. NON-DIRECTOR RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES (CONTINUED)

 

(b) Transactions with Partnerships

 

The consolidated entity carries on a partnership with Goodyear in Australia under the name of South Pacific Tyres. In addition the consolidated entity carried on a partnership with Accenture in Australia and New Zealand under the name Novare Asia Pacific until 31 August 2001, at which time the consolidated entity acquired Accenture’s share of Novare Asia Pacific. During the course of the year the Company and the consolidated entity conducted financial transactions with South Pacific Tyres (and with Novare Asia Pacific until 31 August 2001) on normal commercial terms and conditions being:

 

     Consolidated

$ in Millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

Sales of goods and services

              

South Pacific Tyres

   —      —      1.3
    
  
  
     —      —      1.3
    
  
  

Purchases of goods and services

              

Novare Asia Pacific

   —      —      5.5
    
  
  
     —      —      5.5
    
  
  

Other revenue

              

South Pacific Tyres

   3.5    3.3    2.5
    
  
  

Aggregate current amounts receivable (a)

              

South Pacific Tyres

   0.5    7.6    —  
    
  
  

Aggregate non-current amounts receivable
South Pacific Tyres
(a)

   62.3    55.1    59.4
    
  
  
     62.3    55.1    59.4
    
  
  

 

(a) Amount included within Other Amounts Receivable (Note 12)

 

Loans

 

On 20 December 2000, the Company agreed to make available to the South Pacific Tyres partnership a loan for $56.3 million for a period of two years pending South Pacific Tyres receipt of this amount from Goodyear. The loan was drawn down in two tranches, $31.3 million on 20 December 2000 and $25.0 million on 5 January 2001.

 

On 20 December 2000, the Company was assigned a South Pacific Tyres receivable due from Goodyear of $31.3 million as partial settlement of the above loan.

 

During the year ended 30 June 2002 Goodyear repaid the loans. In October 2001, the Company through a controlled entity agreed to lend South Pacific Tyres up to $56.3 million.

 

The terms of the further agreements of October 2001 with Goodyear containing put and call options (which enables Ansell to put its investment to Goodyear during the 12 month period commencing 15 August 2005 or for Goodyear to exercise its call option over Ansell’s investment during the 6 month period from 15 August 2006) provide the consolidated entity an actionable exit strategy in respect of its investment in the South Pacific Tyres partnership.

 

The loans mature at the earlier of :

 

    the Company exercising the put option (no earlier than August 2005)

 

    the tenth anniversary of the agreement (October 2011); and

 

    the dissolution of the partnership (not expected).

 

Interest is charged at the 90 day bank bill rate plus a margin of 0.6% per annum, and is capitalised to the principal balance quarterly.

 

Interest brought to account by the Company in relation to this loan during the year:

 

$ in Millions


   Consolidated
2004


Interest revenue

   3.5

 

In addition, under the partnership agreement, South Pacific Tyres leases certain properties on a basis of equitable rentals mutually agreed by the partners. Lease payments of $0.2 million (2003 - $0.2 million; 2002 - $0.2 million) were made by South Pacific Tyres to the consolidated entity. The Company, through its corporate treasury operations, also provided on the basis of normal commercial terms and conditions, forward exchange cover on behalf of the partnership.

 

120


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

35. EARNINGS PER SHARE

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

 

Earnings reconciliation

                

Net profit/(loss)

   72.6    52.5    (113.0 )

Net profit attributable to outside equity interests

   1.9    2.6    2.8  
    
  
  

Basic earnings

   70.7    49.9    (115.8 )

Diluted earnings

   70.7    49.9    (115.8 )

Weighted average number of ordinary shares used as the denominator

                

Number for basic earnings per share

                

Ordinary shares

   180.8    187.1    186.9  

Effect of partly paid Executive Plan shares, and options

   0.6    0.6    0.7  
    
  
  

Number for diluted earnings per share

   181.4    187.7    187.6  
    
  
  

 

Partly paid Executive Plan shares, and options have been included in diluted earnings per share in accordance with accounting standards.

 

Conversion, Call, Subscription or issue after 30 June 2004:

 

Refer to Note 5 for further information.

 

36. ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS

 

The Company and various Group Companies as the occupiers of property receive, from time to time, notices from relevant authorities pursuant to various environmental legislation. On receiving such notices, the Company evaluates potential remediation options and the associated costs. At this time, the Company does not believe that the potential financial impact of such remediation upon the economic entity is material.

 

In the ordinary course of business, the Ansell Group has maintained comprehensive general liability insurance policies covering its operations and assets. Generally such policies exclude coverage for most environmental liabilities.

 

121


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

37. PARTICULARS RELATING TO CONTROLLED ENTITIES

 

          Beneficial Interest

Particulars Relating to Controlled Entities


   Country of
Incorporation


   2004
%


   2003
%


   2002
%


Ansell Limited

   Australia               

Ansell Healthcare Japan Co. Ltd.

   *Japan    100    100    100

Ativ Pac Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

BNG Battery Technologies Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Cliburn Investments Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Dexboy International Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Corrvas Insurance Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Dunlop Olympic Manufacturing Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

FGDP Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

H.C. Sleigh Services Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

N Harvesters Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

PSL Industries Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

International Better Brands Pty Ltd

   Australia    100    100    100

Licknib Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Nucleus Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Lifetec Project Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Medical TPLC Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

N&T Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Nucleus Trading Pte. Ltd.

   *Singapore    100    100    100

THLD Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

TNC Holdings Pte. Ltd.

   *Singapore    100    100    100

TPLC Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Societe de Management Financier S.A.

   *France    100    100    100

TPLC S.A.

   *France    100    100    100

Olympic General Products Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Foamlite (Australia) Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Pacific Distribution Properties Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Pacific Dunlop Finance Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Pacific Dunlop Holdings (China) Co. Ltd.

   *China    100    100    100

Pacific Dunlop Linings Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Pacific Dunlop Tyres Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

P.D. Holdings Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

P.D. International Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Ansell Belgium Holdings SPRL N.V.

   *Belgium    100    100    100

Ansell Canada Inc.

   *Canada    100    100    100

Llesna Healthcare Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Ansell Kemwell Ltd.

   *India    74.9    74.9    74.9

Ansell Lanka (Pvt.) Ltd.

   *Sri Lanka    100    100    100

Ansell (Thailand) Ltd.

   *Thailand    100    100    100

Medical Telectronics N.V.

   *Netherlands Ant.    100    100    100

Medical Telectronics Holding & Finance (Holland) B.V.

   *Netherlands    100    100    100

Mt Waverley Estates Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Pacific Dunlop (Hong Kong) Limited.

   *Hong Kong    100    100    100

Corrvas Insurance (Singapore) Pte. Ltd. ( formerly PacDun (Singapore) Pte. Ltd)

   * Singapore    100    100    100

Pacific Dunlop Investments (USA) Inc.

   *USA    100    100    100

Ansell Brazil LTDA

   *Brazil    100    100    100

Ansell Edmont Industrial de Mexico S.A. de C.V.

   *Mexico    100    100    100

Ansell Perry de Mexico S.A. de C.V.

   *Mexico    100    100    100

Commercializadora GNK S.A de C.V.

   *Mexico    100    100    100

Golden Needles de Mexico S.A de C.V.

   *Mexico    100    100    100

Ansell Healthcare Products LLC.

   *USA    100    100    100

Ansell Protective Products Inc.

   *USA    100    100    100

Ansell Services Inc.

   *USA    100    100    100

Pacific Chloride Inc.

   *USA    100    100    100

 

122


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

37. PARTICULARS RELATING TO CONTROLLED ENTITIES (CONTINUED)

 

     Country of
Incorporation


   Beneficial Interest

Particulars Relating to Controlled Entities


     

2004

%


 

2003

%


 

2002

%


Pacific Dunlop Holdings Inc.

   *USA    100   100   100

Pacific Dunlop USA Inc.

   *USA    100   100   100

TPLC Holdings Inc.

   *USA    100   100   100

Accufix Research Institute Inc.

   *USA    100   100   100

Cotac Corporation

   *USA    100   100   100

Pacific Dunlop Finance Company Inc.

   *USA    100   100   100

Pacific Dunlop Holdings (Europe) Ltd.

   *U.K.    100   100   100

Ansell Healthcare Europe N.V.

   *Belgium    100   100   100

Ansell GmbH

   *Germany    100   100   100

Ansell Italy Srl

   * Italy    100   100   100

Ansell S.A.

   *France    100   100   100

Ansell UK Limited

   *U.K.    100   100   100

Pacific Dunlop Holdings (Singapore) Pte. Ltd.

   *Singapore    100   100   100

JK Ansell Ltd.

   *India      (a) 50     (a) 50     (a) 50

Ansell Services (Asia) Sdn. Bhd. (formerly P.D. Holdings (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd.)

   *Malaysia    100   100   100

Ansell Ambi Sdn. Bhd.

   *Malaysia    100   100   100

Ansell (Kedah) Sdn. Bhd.

   *Malaysia    100   100   100

Ansell (Kulim) Sdn. Bhd.

   *Malaysia    100   100   100

Ansell Malaysia Sdn. Bhd.

   *Malaysia    75   75   75

Ansell Medical Sdn. Bhd.

   *Malaysia    75   75   75

Ansell N.P. Sdn. Bhd.

   *Malaysia    75   75   75

Ansell Shah Alam Sdn. Bhd.

   *Malaysia    100   100   100

PDOCB Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

Ansell Medical Products Pvt. Ltd.

   *India    100   100   100

Suretex Ltd.

   *Thailand    100   100   100

Latex Investments Ltd.

   Mauritius    100   100   100

Suretex Prophylactics (India) Ltd.

   *India    100   100   100

STX Prophylactics S.A .(Pty.) Ltd.

   *Sth Africa    100   100   100

PD Licensing Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

PD Shared Services Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

PD Shared Services Holdings Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

Siteprints Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

S.T.P. (Hong Kong) Ltd.

   *Hong Kong    100   100   100

Pacific Dunlop Holdings N.V.

   *Netherlands Ant.    100   100   100

Pacific Dunlop (Netherlands) B.V.

   *Netherlands    100   100   100

Textile Industrial Design & Engineering Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

The Distribution Group Holdings Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

The Distribution Group Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    (b) 100   (b) 100   (b) 100

Nwodhsa Enterprises (Wholesale) Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

TDG Warehousing Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

The Distribution Trust

   Australia    100   100   100

Union Knitting Mills Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

Xelo Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

Xelo Sacof Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100   100   100

 

Controlled Entities Sold in Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

No controlled entities were sold during the current financial year.

 

123


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

37. PARTICULARS RELATING TO CONTROLLED ENTITIES (CONTINUED)

 

    

Country of

Incorporation


   Beneficial Interest

Controlled Entities in Voluntarily Liquidation at 30 June 2004


      2004
%


   2003
%


   2002
%


TPLC Ltd.

   *UK    100    100    100

TPLC Medizinprodukte GmbH.

   *Germany    100    100    100

Ansell Glove Company Ltd.

   *UK    100    100    100

Golden Needles Knitting & Glove Co. Ltd.

   *UK    100    100    100

Mates Vending Ltd.

   *UK    100    100    100

Controlled Entities Voluntarily Liquidated During the Year


                   

BNG Sub Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

F.J.’s Auto Plus Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Gardenland Frozen Food Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

General Jones Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

H.C. Sleigh Investments Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Herbert Adams Holdings Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Jetbase Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Kcilc Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Lifetec R&D Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Maspas Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Novare Partnership Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Ocper Auto Parts Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

PA Furniture Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Pacific Distribution Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Pacific Dunlop Belting Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Project Array Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Project (X92) Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Retsamttaw Ocla Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Robur Tea Company Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Slumberland (Australia) Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Softwood Towns Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Sport Australia (Export) Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Super Cycle Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

Xdds Pty. Ltd.

   Australia    100    100    100

 

* Controlled Entities incorporated outside Australia carry on business in those countries.

 

(a) Ansell Healthcare has day-to-day management control of this entity.

 

(b) The trustee of The Distribution Trust is The Distribution Group Pty. Ltd. The beneficiary of the trust is Ansell Limited.

 

124


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

38. INVESTMENTS IN ASSOCIATES

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

   2003

    2002

 

Results of associates

                 

Share of associates’ profit from ordinary activities before income tax

   —      0.4     2.7  

Share of associates’ income tax expense relating to profit from ordinary activities

   —      (0.1 )   (0.8 )
    
  

 

Share of associates’ net profit - as disclosed by associates

   —      0.3     1.9  

Share of post acquisition retained profits and reserves attributable to associates Retained profits

                 

Share of associates’ retained profits at the beginning of the financial year

   —      (0.1 )   8.5  

Share of associates’ net profit

   —      0.3     1.9  

Dividends from associates

   —      (2.6 )   (1.3 )

Retained profits of Associates disposed of during the financial year and entity no longer equity accounted

   —      2.4     (9.2 )
    
  

 

Share of associates’ retained profits at the end of the financial year

   —      —       (0.1 )
    
  

 

Asset revaluation reserve

                 

Share of associates’ asset revaluation reserve at the beginning of the financial year

   —      —       0.9  

Share of asset revaluation reserve of entity no longer equity accounted

   —            (0.9 )
    
  

 

Share of associates’ asset revaluation reserve at the end of the financial year

   —      —       —    
    
  

 

Foreign currency translation reserve

                 

Share of associates’ foreign currency translation reserve at the beginning of the financial year

   —      —       2.3  

Share of foreign currency translation reserve of entity no longer equity accounted

   —            (2.3 )
    
  

 

Share of associates’ foreign currency translation reserve at the end of the financial year

   —      —       —    
    
  

 

Movements in carrying value of investments

                 

Carrying amount of investments in associates at the beginning of the financial year

   —      13.3     33.3  

Share of associates’ net profit

   —      0.3     1.9  

Dividends received from associates

   —      (2.6 )   (1.3 )
    
  

 

     —      11.0     33.9  

Less carrying value of investment in associate disposed of during the financial year

   —      (11.0 )   (0.8 )

Less write-down and carrying value of investment no longer equity accounted

   —      —       (19.8 )
    
  

 

Carrying amount of investment in associates at the end of the financial year

   —      —       13.3  
    
  

 

Commitments

                 

Share of associates’ operating lease commitments payable:

                 

Within one year

   —      —       0.1  

One year or later and no later than five years

   —      —       0.1  

Later than five years

   —      —       —    
    
  

 

     —      —       0.2  
    
  

 

 

125


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

38. INVESTMENTS IN ASSOCIATES (continued)

 

Details of investments in associates are as follows :

 

     Principal
Activities


   Balance
Date


  

2004

%


  

Consolidated
Ownership

Interest

2003

%


   2002
%


  

Consolidated
Investment

Carrying Amount


Name


                 

2004

$m


   2003
$m


   2002
$m


Pacific Marine Batteries Pty. Ltd.

   Manufacturing    30 June    —      —      50    —      —      2.7

BT Equipment Pty. Ltd.

   Manufacturing    30 June    —      —      45    —      —      10.6
                             
  
  
                              —      —      13.3
                             
  
  

 

No dividends were received by the Company from associates during the year ended 30 June 2004

(2003 - $2.6 million; 2002 - $1.3 million).

 

Summary of performance and financial position of associates:

 

     Consolidated

$ in Millions


   2004

   2003

   2002

The consolidated entity’s share of aggregate assets, liabilities and profits of associates are as follows:

              

Net profit - as reported by associates

   —      0.3    1.9

Current assets

   —      —      24.0

Non-current assets

   —      —      4.7
    
  
  

Total assets

   —      —      28.7
    
  
  

Current liabilities

   —      —      15.2

Non-current liabilities

   —      —      0.2
    
  
  

Total liabilities

   —      —      15.4
    
  
  

Net assets - as reported by associates

   —      —      13.3
    
  
  

 

126


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

39. MAJOR DIFFERENCES BETWEEN AUSTRALIAN GAAP AND US GAAP – RESTATED

 

Australian generally accepted accounting principles (AGAAP) vary in certain significant respects from generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (US GAAP). Application of US GAAP would have affected shareholders’ equity as at 30 June 2004, 2003, and 2002 and net profit after income tax expense attributable to the Ansell Limited shareholders for each of the years in the three year period ended 30 June 2004, to the extent quantified below.

 

Restatement of Prior Year US GAAP Results

 

As set out in the financial statements for the years ended 30 June 2001, 2002 and 2003, the Group’s interest in the South Pacific Tyres (SPT) partnership has continued to be equity accounted for US GAAP purposes. Accordingly, the previously issued financial statements have included Ansell’s equity share of SPT’s results and equity impacts in the US GAAP reconciliation.

 

Goodyear, a US corporation, and the other partner in SPT, undertook certain restatements of its financial statements during the past year. As part of this process, the results and transactions of the SPT partnership were fully reconsidered as to their compliance with US GAAP. The previously issued financial statements of SPT which had been filed with Ansell’s 20-F, in accordance with Regulation S-X, Rule 3.09, have now been restated.

 

Previously, these statements had discussed only one difference between AGAAP and US GAAP. This difference was related to Revaluations of Property, Plant and Equipment, and the consequential impacts upon depreciation. The statements indicated that other US GAAP differences existed, but that all such differences were of an immaterial nature and amount.

 

As a result of the further evaluation of SPT’s transactions, it has been determined that an amount of $25 million recorded as Supply Agreement revenue under AGAAP in 2001 should, more probably, have been recorded by SPT in 2002, as a Capital Contribution from Goodyear. Since this transaction did not change the structure of the partnership, this US GAAP accounting would result in an increase of $12.5 million in Ansell’s share of SPT’s losses in 2001, and a reduction in Ansell’s share of SPT’s losses in 2002, of the same amount.

 

In addition to the above, all other US GAAP differences, although immaterial, have been quantified. The quantification of these items, which have now been included in the reconciliation set out in these financial statements (as Note 39(n) Investments), is as follows:

 

     Thousands of A$

     2001

    2002

    2003

Supply Agreement – gain/(loss)

   (12,500 )   12,500     —  

All Other US GAAP differences – gain/(loss)

   586     (891 )   737
    

 

 

Restatement effect

   (11,914 )   11,609     737
    

 

 

Impact of total restatement effect on

                

– Basic earnings per share (cents)

   (6.14 )   6.21     0.37

– Diluted earnings per share (cents)

   (6.10 )   6.19     0.37

 

The impact of all US GAAP differences on the result of SPT Australia when compared to the result determined in accordance with AGAAP for the 2004 financial year, has been to reduce the loss by $977,171 (whole dollars). Accordingly, Ansell’s equity accounted losses for the year ended 30 June 2004 have been reduced by $488,586 (whole dollars) as a result of SPT’s US GAAP differences.

 

Additionally, in respect of the prior years, the results of SPT were reflected by Ansell as a component of its ‘discontinued’ operations. While the ‘put’ and ‘call’ options remain in place and Ansell remains committed to its objective of exiting the tyre business, for US GAAP purposes the classification of the results of SPT has been restated – and they are now reflected in ‘continuing’ operations for all periods presented.

 

In addition to the restatement items set out above in respect of SPT, it has also been determined that the cumulative effect of the adoption of SFAS 142 and SFAS 143 in the year ended June 30, 2003 had been effected as a direct charge to Equity, but had not been recorded as a charge to Net Income. Accordingly, the restatement now reflects this as a charge to Net income, and Income from Continuing operations. Earnings per share amounts have been restated accordingly. There is no restatement of Shareholder’s Equity as a result of this restatement.

 

Further, during the consideration of the SPT restatement issues, the evaluation of the Company’s Australian Pension Plan disclosures indicated that of an accumulated Additional Minimum Liability identified for recording in accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in 2004, an amount of $7.9 million should have been recorded in 2003. Accordingly, the impact on Shareholder’s Equity and Comprehensive income has been included in the restatements.

 

Additional Data in respect of the restatements


   Millions of A$

 
     2003

    2002

    2001

 

Continuing Operations

                  

US GAAP Net Profit/(Loss) from continuing operations as previously reported

   85.8     (75.1 )   (223.0 )

Reclassification of previously reported SPT Equity accounted results from Discontinued operations

   (17.1 )   (62.0 )   (45.9 )

Restatement of SPT Equity accounted results as above

   0.7     11.6     (11.9 )
    

 

 

US GAAP Net Profit/(Loss) from continuing operations – restated

   69.4     (125.5 )   (280.8 )
    

 

 

Basic earnings per share from continuing operations – previously reported (cents)

   46 ¢   (40   (115

Basic earnings per share from continuing operations – restated (cents)

   37 ¢   (67   (145

Net Profit/(Loss)

                  

US GAAP Net Profit/(Loss) as previously reported

   55.9     (183.6 )   (195.0 )

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principles re SFAS 142 and 143

   (5.3 )   —       —    

Restatement of SPT Equity accounted results as above

   0.7     11.6     (11.9 )
    

 

 

US GAAP Net Profit/(Loss) – restated

   51.3     (172.0 )   (206.9 )
    

 

 

Basic earnings per share – previously reported (cents)

   30 ¢   (98   (101

Basic earnings per share – restated (cents)

   27 ¢   (92   (107

Comprehensive Income/(Loss)

                  

Comprehensive Income/(Loss) as previously reported

   (7.2 )   (268.8 )   (264.4 )

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principles re SFAS 142 and 143 previously reflected directly in equity

   (5.3 )   —       —    

Additional Minimum Pension Liability not previously recorded

   (7.9 )   —       —    

Restatement of SPT Equity accounted results as above

   0.7     11.6     (11.9 )
    

 

 

Comprehensive Income/(Loss) restated

   (19.7 )   (257.2 )   (276.3 )
    

 

 

Shareholders’ Equity

                  

Ansell Limited Shareholders’ Equity according to US GAAP (including Comprehensive Income) as previously reported

   874.6     876.9     1,153.6  

Cumulative restatement of SPT Equity accounted results for periods prior to 2001.

   (2.8 )   (2.8 )   (2.8 )

Restatement of SPT Equity accounted results as above

   0.4     (0.3 )   (11.9 )

Additional Minimum Pension Liability not previously recorded

   (7.9 )   —       —    
    

 

 

Ansell Limited Shareholders’ Equity according to US GAAP (including Comprehensive Income) restated

   864.3     873.8     1,138.9  
    

 

 

US GAAP Equity Roll-Forward

                  

Opening balance US GAAP Equity Roll-Forward as previously stated

   876.9     1,153.6     1,655.8  

Cumulative restatement of SPT Equity accounted results for periods post 2001.

   (0.3 )   (11.9 )   —    

Cumulative restatement of SPT Equity accounted results for periods prior to 2001.

   (2.8 )   (2.8 )   (2.8 )
    

 

 

Opening balance US GAAP Equity Roll-Forward restated

   873.8     1,138.9     1,653.0  

Increase in Additional Minimum Pension liability

   (7.9 )   —       —    

US GAAP Net Profit/(Loss) – restated

   51.3     (172.0 )   (206.9 )

Proceeds from issue of shares

   1.0     1.2     2.5  

Dividends

   —       —       (77.6 )

Share buy back

   (8.2 )   —       (165.4 )

Movements in AGAAP Foreign Currency Translation Reserve

   (71.3 )   (69.6 )   (73.0 )

Unrealised net gain on cash flow hedges

   1.1     (12.1 )   (1.6 )

Movements in Loans outstanding under Employee Share Plan

   3.1     4.3     1.3  

Other (including FX on US GAAP adjustments)

   21.4     (16.9 )   6.6  
    

 

 

Closing Balance US GAAP Equity Roll-Forward restated

   864.3     873.8     1,138.9  
    

 

 

 

A description of the material differences between AGAAP, as followed by Ansell Limited, and US GAAP are as follows:

 

(a) Property, Plant and Equipment

 

Certain property, plant and equipment has been revalued by Ansell Limited at various times in prior financial periods. Revaluation increments have increased the carrying value of the assets and accordingly the depreciation charges have been increased above those which would be required on a historical cost basis. Under US GAAP such revaluations are not permitted. Accordingly, these adjustments eliminate this effect.

 

The above policy also causes differences in reported gains and losses on the sale of property, plant and equipment. Gains and losses for AGAAP are based on consideration less revalued amounts net of accumulated depreciation and amortisation. For US GAAP purposes gains and losses are determined having regard to depreciated historical cost, and revaluation reserves applicable to assets sold are reported as Income.

 

In August 2001, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standard (SFAS) No. 144 “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets”. SFAS No. 144 superseded SFAS No. 121 and was adopted by the Group effective 1 July 2002. SFAS No. 144 retains the requirements of SFAS No. 121 to (a) recognise an impairment loss if the carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not recoverable from its undiscounted cash flows and (b) measure an impairment loss as the difference between the carrying amount and fair value of the asset lees estimated costs to sell. SFAS No. 144 also requires that a long-lived asset to be abandoned, exchanged for a similar productive asset, or distributed to owners in a spin-off be considered held and used until the asset is disposed of, exchanged or distributed.

 

(b) Minority Interests

 

Minority interests are included as part of total Shareholders Equity under AGAAP. The reconciliation to US GAAP in Note 40 has excluded these from Shareholders’ Equity consistent with US GAAP treatment.

 

(c) Provisions

 

The term “provisions” is used in AGAAP to designate accrued expenses with no definitive payment date. Classification between current and non-current is generally based on management assessments, as subject to audit.

 

Included within the result for AGAAP are amounts charged to income in respect of future costs associated with rationalisation and restructuring within existing business segments (provision for rationalisation and restructuring costs). Any plans to reorganise or exit a business are approved by the Board of Directors. Once committed to, accruals are made for the estimated costs associated with the reorganisation or exit. The US GAAP criteria for accruing costs associated with business restructure contain certain very specific qualifying criteria including those set out in EITF 94–3. Where these criteria are not satisfied an adjustment to earnings is included in the reconciliation to US GAAP.

 

The provision for rationalisation and restructuring as at 30 June 2004 predominantly represents costs and claims now expected to be incurred in respect of businesses sold between 1996 and 2002. The adoption of AASB 1044 has resulted in no US GAAP differences in the fiscal years ended 30 June, 2003 or 2004.

 

127


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

39. MAJOR DIFFERENCES BETWEEN AUSTRALIAN GAAP AND US GAAP—RESTATED (continued)

 

(d) Employee Loans, Executive Share Plan and Options

 

For AGAAP purposes the Company applies the fair value model which is consistent with the provision of SFAS No. 123 – “Accounting for Stock Based Compensation” to determine compensation cost in respect of options and in respect of the Performance Share Rights (PSR’s) first issued in 2003 under the Ansell Limited Stock Incentive Plan. No options have actually been exercised. During 2004 a $2.6 million compensation charge was recognized covering the current year costs associated with the grants of PSR’s. This treatment is consistent with US GAAP.

 

For AGAAP purposes options are not expensed in the accounts. A further charge of $300,000 under US GAAP was made in respect of the options in accordance with SFAS No. 123. This charge has been calculated using the fair value method whereby fair value is derived using an option pricing model that takes into consideration the stock price at grant date, the exercise price and the expected life of the award, the expected volatility of the underlying stock, the expected dividends on the stock and the risk free interest rate for the expected life of the option. Compensation cost is recognized over the service period, which is the vesting period, with an corresponding credit to stockholders’ equity.

 

(e) Earnings Per Share

 

Under Australian GAAP earnings per share is calculated by dividing operating profit after tax, minority shareholders interest and any preference dividend by the weighted average number of shares on issue for the year. Methods of computing earnings per share in accordance with US GAAP are documented in SFAS No. 128 – “Earnings per Share”. Earnings per share computations recognise the effect of all bonus issues (stock splits) and bonus elements of rights issues made up to 30 June 2004, and also give effect to the stock consolidation (reverse split) approved by shareholders in April 2002.

 

For the three year period 1 July 2001 to 30 June 2004 there were no differences in the calculation methodology of EPS under AGAAP and US GAAP.

 

(f) Pension Plans

 

The Group sponsors contributory and non-contributory accumulation and defined benefit pension plans covering substantially all employees. The defined benefit plans generally provide benefits based on salary in the period prior to retirement. All defined benefit plans are funded based on actuarial advice on a regular basis.

 

Actuarial calculations have been carried out for the defined benefit funds and the material fund aspects are as detailed in Note 24. The majority of assets of the funds are invested in pooled superannuation trusts in the case of the Australian funds and equity securities for other major funds.

 

Limited disclosure in respect of pension plans is presently required by AGAAP. Under AGAAP the contributions to the various pension plans are recorded as an expense in the Statement of Financial Performance. The disclosure requirements of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 87 (SFAS No. 87) and No. 132 (SFAS No. 132 as revised) have been included in Note 40 to these consolidated financial statements. The Group reports pension plans aggregated where allowed by SFAS No.87. Additionally, an adjustment is made to recognise the measurement principles of SFAS No. 87 and related standards in determining net income and shareholders’ equity under US GAAP.

 

(g) Statement of Cash Flows

 

Profit from operations determined under AGAAP differs in certain respects from the amount determined in accordance with US GAAP. A reconciliation of US GAAP profits to Cash Flows from operations is provided.

 

Under AGAAP, cash is defined as cash on hand and deposits repayable on demand, less overdrafts repayable on demand. Under US GAAP, cash and cash equivalents are defined as cash and investments with original maturities of three months or less, and do not include bank overdrafts or restricted deposits. Cash and cash equivalents as of 30 June, 2004, 2003 and 2002 would have been $307.8 million, $286.0 million and $258.5 million respectively, under US GAAP.

 

128


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

39. MAJOR DIFFERENCES BETWEEN AUSTRALIAN GAAP AND US GAAP – RESTATED (continued)

 

(h) Income Taxes

 

Under AGAAP, future income tax benefits attributable to temporary differences are only brought to account when their realisation is assured beyond reasonable doubt. Future income tax benefits related to tax losses are only brought to account when their realisation is virtually certain.

 

Under US GAAP, all deferred tax assets are recognised, net of a valuation allowance, to the extent the likelihood of realising the tax benefit is more likely than not. Although the US GAAP standard provides for a lower threshold than AGAAP, based on the level of historical taxable income and projections for future taxable income over the periods in which the carry forward tax losses and deductible temporary differences will reverse, additional deferred tax adjustments are considered only after having regard to the level and jurisdiction of unbooked tax losses.

 

At 30 June 2004 the gross tax losses of A$2.2 million for which future tax benefits (deferred tax assets) have been brought to account under both AGAAP and US GAAP have no expiry date.

 

All deferred tax balances at 30 June 2004 relate to entities operating in foreign tax jurisdictions.

 

At 30 June 2004 the expiry dates of gross tax losses for which future tax benefits (deferred tax assets) have not been brought to account under AGAAP and US GAAP are as follows - in respect of financial years ending on 30 June;

 

Revenue Losses


  

Capital Losses


Year


  

A$
million


  

Year


  

A$
million


2005

   82.9    2005     

2006

   65.8    2006    473.0

2007

   53.8    2007    10.0

2008

   3.2    2008     

2009

   2.9    2009    52.7

2010

   1.9    2010     

2011

   108.0    2011     

2012

   69.2    2012     

2019

   26.6    2019     

2022

   9.7    2022     

No expiry date

   712.0    No expiry date    624.9

 

The increase in the tax effect of unrecognised capital tax losses during the year of $107.0 million was primarily due to a reassessment of capital losses available in Australia following the completion of the first income tax return under the tax consolidation regime. Additional capital losses were also incurred in the USA during the period.

 

The future tax benefit of revenue losses not recognised fell by $16.5 million with the recoupment of revenue losses in the USA, partially offset by additional revenue losses being incurred in Australia.

 

Inclusive of the $24.2 million (2003 $32.0 million) set out in Note 17 to the consolidated financial statements, the total deferred tax assets amounting to $763.0 million (June 2003 $680.3 million) are offset by valuation adjustments of $738.8 million as at 30 June 2004 (June 2003 $648.3 million) and total deferred tax liabilities amount to $20.2 million (June 2003 $21.5 million). The adequacy of the valuation allowance is regularly assessed and none of the deferred tax assets relate to amounts which, if realised, would impact the carrying values of goodwill or any other intangible assets.

 

The Company elected to enter the tax consolidation regime in Australia effective 1 July 2002. There was no impact on the consolidated financial statements of the Company as a result of this election as all tax balances of the Company and all Australian wholly owned subsidiaries were written off in a prior period.

 

Analysis of Pre Tax Profit/(Loss)

 

     2004

    2003

    2002

 
     A$m

    A$m

    A$m

 

Australian Operations

   (4.0 )   (29.2 )   (17.8 )

Foreign Operations

   97.3     108.5     (39.4 )
    

 

 

Total Group

   93.3     79.3     (57.2 )
    

 

 

 

Total tax expense for 2004 and 2003 was comprised of foreign tax expense (of which $1.3 million is deferred, 2003—$24.8 million), as the Australian operations are in a significant tax loss position. For 2002 $41.4 million of the tax expense for the year was comprised of foreign tax expense and $14.4 million domestic with $47.6 million being deferred.

 

129


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

39. MAJOR DIFFERENCES BETWEEN AUSTRALIAN GAAP AND US GAAP—RESTATED (continued)

 

(h) Income Taxes (continued)

 

Notwithstanding the level of accumulated losses in certain jurisdictions, the Group has unremitted profits arising from operating activities which are held in foreign tax jurisdictions. In the event that all of these profits do not remain permanently reinvested in those jurisdictions and are distributed by way of dividend, additional taxes amounting to approximately $12 million may become payable on a total amount of $39.7 million of unremitted earnings.

 

(i) Accounting for Goodwill

 

Shares in controlled entities are recorded on acquisition at the holding company’s cost. Any difference between the fair value of net assets acquired and cost is recognised as goodwill. Under AGAAP, goodwill is amortised on a straight line basis over varying periods not exceeding 20 years. Although the benefits from the goodwill acquired may exceed 20 years the goodwill is written off over periods not exceeding 20 years to comply with AGAAP.

 

In 1989 and prior years, for AGAAP, goodwill was written off in the year of acquisition. For US GAAP purposes, such goodwill has been reinstated.

 

In June 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 141, “Business Combinations”, and SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Intangible Assets”. SFAS No. 141 requires that the purchase method of accounting be used for all business combinations completed after 30 June 2002 which is consistent with AGAAP. SFAS No. 141 also specifies the types of acquired intangible assets that are required to be recognised and reported separately from goodwill and those acquired intangible assets that are required to be included in goodwill. SFAS No. 142 requires that goodwill no longer be amortised, but instead tested for impairment at least annually. This requirement creates a difference between AGAAP and US GAAP. SFAS No. 142 also requires recognised intangible assets to be amortised over their respective estimated useful lives and reviewed for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets”. SFAS No. 142 also permits indefinite useful lives to be assigned to recognised intangibles. Any recognised intangible assets determined to have an indefinite useful life will not be amortised, but instead tested for impairment in accordance with the Standard until its life is determined to no longer be indefinite.

 

The Group adopted SFAS No. 141 and SFAS No. 142 effective 1 July 2002 at which time the values of goodwill and brand names capitalised under US GAAP were reviewed for impairment. This review resulted in a write down of the value of goodwill of $5.0 million. This write down related to goodwill capitalised under US GAAP that had previously been written off under AGAAP. Under US GAAP this adjustment would be presented as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principles in US GAAP income for the year ended 30 June 2003 and is reflected as an adjustment in arriving at net income pursuant to US GAAP.

 

SFAS No. 142 requires goodwill and other intangible assets to be tested for impairment at the reporting unit level. A reporting unit is the same as, or one below, an operating segment as defined by SFAS No. 131 “Disclosure about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information”.

 

Ansell has traditionally managed its business by product type within three business units – Occupational, Professional and Consumer. Each of these three business units comprise both manufacturing and sales and marketing with most manufacturing facilities being principally a supplier to one of the business units only (certain factories can produce product for more than one business unit, however, production for a particular unit does dominate).

 

Although the manufacturing facilities are predominantly product specific they do supply product to multiple marketing regions. The primary focus of the manufacturing facilities is to manufacture product as cost effectively as possible and to form an important component of an integrated supply chain, notwithstanding that due to taxation issues an appropriate manufacturing margin is retained by the manufacturing facilities.

 

Accordingly, the Group has allocated to, and conducts impairment testing of goodwill and brand names semi-annually based on the three business units, which are considered to be the cash generating units and the same as the Company’s business segments. Any material diminution in value is charged to the Statement of Financial Position for US GAAP purposes.

 

For US GAAP purposes no goodwill amortisation has been charged against income since 1 July 2002, the effective date of SFAS No. 142. In prior years the Group adopted the method of straight-line amortisation over 40 years for US GAAP where the useful life was considered to exceed 20 years. Goodwill amortisation of $21.4 million under AGAAP in 2004 and $25.3 million in 2003 has also been added back to income in the Statement of Financial Performance for US GAAP purposes.

 

Goodwill attributable to sold businesses is brought to account in determining the gain or loss on sale.

 

130


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

39. MAJOR DIFFERENCES BETWEEN AUSTRALIAN GAAP AND US GAAP—RESTATED (CONTINUED)

 

(j) Brand names

 

Brand names acquired since 1 July 1990, are recorded in the accounts at cost based on independent valuation. No amortisation has been charged on these assets under AGAAP as no event has occurred to cause a reduction in the values or limit their useful lives.

 

For US GAAP purposes and for purposes of this reconciliation, brand names were, effective 1 July 1994 amortised over a period of 40 years using the straight line method. Upon the adoption of SFAS No. 142 effective 1 July 2002, such amortisation ceased for US GAAP purposes as indefinite useful lives have been assigned to brand names. The carrying value of brand names is reviewed semi annually and any material diminution in value is charged to the Statement of Financial Performance for AGAAP and US GAAP purposes.

 

Brand names attributable to sold businesses are brought to account in determining the gain or loss on sale.

 

(k) Derivatives not designated as hedges

 

Derivatives not designated as hedges primarily consist of interest rate swaps and forward exchange contracts which, while mitigating economic risks to which the economic entity is exposed, do not qualify for hedge accounting under SFAS 133 as they relate to hedging of anticipated transactions. These amounts are adjusted in determining US GAAP income. The amount adjusted, by decreasing US GAAP net income by $2.0 million (2003 - $2.4 million increase; 2002 - $1.9 million decrease), is in respect of forward contracts hedging future foreign currency sales of product. The contracts are related to budgeted sales and are not in relation to firm commitments.

 

(l) Discontinued Operation

 

Under AGAAP a business or segment is presented as a discontinued operation upon completion of the transaction, whereas under US GAAP presentation as discontinued is determined in accordance with either APB 30 or SFAS No. 144 which basically requires presentation as discontinued at the relevant measurement date, which may pre-date completion.

 

Sales revenue under US GAAP as disclosed in Note 40 to the consolidated financial statements represents the sales revenue for the periods shown of the continuing Ansell Healthcare operations. Certain retained liabilities relating to Accufix Pacing Lead related expenses are reported in Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements as a current provision of $11.2 million. As set out in Note 26 to the consolidated financial statements the expected outcomes of the material litigation actions outstanding in respect of the Medical Products Group and retained by Ansell following the sale of the operation in 1996 have been provided for.

 

Certain deferred tax assets previously reported in respect of the results of the Medical Products Group were subject to a valuation allowance in 1996, and income tax benefits attributable to the losses from operations and loss from sale have not been brought to account as recovery is not, at this time, considered to be more likely than not.

 

(m) Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

 

The nature of Ansell Limited’s business activities necessarily involves the management of various financial and market risks, including those related to changes in interest rates, currency exchange rates and commodity prices. Ansell Limited uses derivative financial instruments to mitigate or eliminate certain of those risks, as a component of its risk management strategy. The Company does not use derivate instruments for trading purposes.

 

Under Australian GAAP, derivative financial instruments may have hedge accounting treatment applied if the hedging derivatives are effective in reducing the exposure being hedged and are designated as a hedge at the inception of the contract. Hedging derivatives are accounted for in a manner consistent with the accounting treatment of the hedged items as disclosed in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

The FASB issued SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities” as amended, which became effective for Ansell Limited on 1 July 2000. Under SFAS No. 133, as amended, all derivative instruments are recognised in the Statement of Financial Position at their fair values. The accounting for changes in the fair value of a derivative (that is, gains and losses) depends on the intended use of the derivative and the resulting designation.

 

Ÿ For a derivative designated as hedging the exposure to changes in the fair value of a recognized asset or liability or a firm commitment (referred to as a fair value hedge), the gain or loss is recognized in earnings in the period of change together with the offsetting loss or gain on the hedged item attributable to the risk being hedged. The effect of that accounting is to reflect in earnings the extent to which the hedge is not effective in achieving offsetting changes in fair value.

 

Ÿ For a derivative designated as hedging the exposure to variable cash flows of a forecasted transaction (referred to as a cash flow hedge), the effective portion of the derivative’s gain or loss is initially reported as a component of other comprehensive income (outside earnings) and subsequently reclassified into earnings when the forecasted transaction affects earnings. The ineffective portion of the gain or loss is reported in earnings immediately.

 

Ÿ For a derivative designated as hedging the foreign currency exposure of a net investment in a foreign operation, the gain or loss is reported in other comprehensive income (outside earnings) as part of the cumulative translation adjustment. The accounting for a fair value hedge described above applies to a derivative designated as a hedge of the foreign currency exposure of an unrecognized firm commitment or an available-for-sale security. Similarly, the accounting for a cash flow hedge described above applies to a derivative designated as a hedge of the foreign currency exposure of a foreign-currency-denominated forecasted transaction.

 

Ÿ For a derivative not designated as a hedging instrument, the gain or loss is recognized in earnings in the period of change.

 

Under US GAAP, all derivatives are recognised on the Statement of Financial Position at their fair value. On the date the derivative is entered into, Ansell Limited designates the derivative as either a fair value hedge or a cash flow hedge.

 

131


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

39. MAJOR DIFFERENCES BETWEEN AUSTRALIAN GAAP AND US GAAP—RESTATED (CONTINUED)

 

(m) Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities (continued)

 

Ansell Limited is exposed to interest rate risk and foreign exchange risk associated with underlying assets and liabilities. To hedge these exposures, which relate primarily to long term borrowings in United States Dollars and to assets held by self sustaining foreign affiliates, Ansell Limited uses derivative financial instruments to mitigate or eliminate those risks. The difference between the accounting treatment under AGAAP and US GAAP detailed above affects only the pattern and timing of non-cash accounting recognition of gains and losses on derivative instruments and does not change the economic benefits of using these instruments to manage risk.

 

Hedges of recognised assets, liabilities and firm commitments (fair value hedges)

 

All fair value hedges have been assessed for their effectiveness in accordance with SFAS No. 133 guidelines. The ineffective portion of changes in fair values of hedged positions, reported in earnings, amount to a gain of $1.8 million (2003 - gain of $1.3 million: 2002 - gain of $2.6 million), before income taxes. There were no amounts excluded from the measure of effectiveness.

 

Hedges of future cash flows (cash flow hedges)

 

Amounts classified in Other Comprehensive Income (OCI) during the period relate to cash flow hedges, which will be reclassified to earnings when the forecasted transaction affects earnings. During the next 12 month period ending 30 June 2005, a loss of $0.4 million is expected to be reclassified to earnings. At 30 June 2004, the maximum term of cash flow hedges that hedge forecasted transactions was 38 months.

 

A reconciliation of current period changes in Other Comprehensive Income within equity is as follows:

 

     $ millions

 

Opening balance of accumulated net gain/(loss) on cash flow hedges

   (12.6 )

Net gain / (loss) on cash flow hedges - recognized in OCI – net of nil tax

   17.3  

Add reclassification adjustments to earnings

   —    
    

Closing balance of accumulated net gain/(loss) on cash flow hedges

   4.7  
    

 

(n) Investments

 

For AGAAP purposes investments held in publicly listed companies have been marked to market and the charge included in AGAAP profit for the year. To comply with SFAS No 115 “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities” this charge has been reclassified to accumulated other comprehensive income as the Company has designated such securities as “available for sale” pursuant to SFAS No. 115.

 

Accounting for the Investment in South Pacific Tyres (SPT)

 

The accounting for the investment in SPT is detailed in Note 1 to the Financial Statements.

 

For US GAAP purposes the existing provisions contained within the amended partnership agreement - notwithstanding the substance of the revised arrangements and actual process in respect of the operational control of SPT, which has ultimately determined the AGAAP treatment - continue to provide the company with the legal ability to significantly influence the partnership.

 

Accordingly, equity accounting continues to be applied for the purpose of reporting in accordance with the requirements under US GAAP.

 

(o) Revenue Recognition

 

Under AGAAP, interest income and proceeds from the sale of non current assets are recorded as other revenues from ordinary activities and the book basis of the assets and businesses sold is included in expenses. Under US GAAP, interest income is classified as other income and the difference between the sale proceeds and the book basis of the assets and business sold would be presented as a gain or loss and included in the determination of operating income or income from discontinued operations.

 

132


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

39. MAJOR DIFFERENCES BETWEEN AUSTRALIAN GAAP AND US GAAP—RESTATED (CONTINUED)

 

(p) Asset Retirement Obligations

 

In August 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 143 “Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations” which was adopted by the Company effective 1 July 2002. The Statement addresses financial accounting and reporting obligations associated with the retirement of tangible long-lived assets and for the associated asset retirement costs. The adoption of SFAS No. 143 resulted in the recognition of a net retirement obligation of $0.3 million as at 1 July 2002. In accordance with the provisions of SFAS No. 143 this would be presented as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle in the period of adoption of the standard. A charge of $0.1 million was recorded during 2003 and 2004 reflecting the amortisation of the asset retirement obligation.

 

(q) Recent Changes in US GAAP

 

The adoption of those current changes in US GAAP which are not yet effective is not expected to have any material effects on the consolidated financial statements of the Company.

 

133


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

40. RECONCILIATION TO UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (US GAAP)

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Statement of Financial Performance (for years ended 30th June)

         Restated     Restated  

Net profit/(loss) of the consolidated entity per Australian GAAP

   72.6     52.5     (113.0 )

Less interest of outside equity holders after income tax

   1.9     2.6     2.8  
    

 

 

Net profit/(loss) attributable to Ansell Limited shareholders

   70.7     49.9     (115.8 )

Adjustments required to accord with US GAAP:

                  

add/(deduct)

   19.7     1.4     (56.2 )
    

 

 

Net Profit/(Loss) according to US GAAP(2)

   90.4     51.3     (172.0 )
    

 

 

Weighted average number of shares per basic EPS calculations (millions)

   180.8     187.1     186.9  

Weighted average number of shares/options (millions)

   0.6     0.6     0.7  
    

 

 

Weighted average number of shares per diluted EPS calculations (millions)

   181.4     187.7     187.6  

Continuing Operations

                  

Income/(loss) from continuing operations

                  

Before income tax

   104.0     96.2     (98.6 )

Income tax expense

   (20.7 )   (26.8 )   (26.9 )

Income/(loss) from continuing operations

   83.3     69.4     (125.5 )

Discontinued Operations

                  

Income/(loss) from discontinued operations

                  

Before income tax(1)

   7.1     (12.8 )   (27.0 )

Income tax expense

   —       —       (19.5 )

Income/(loss) from discontinued operations

   7.1     (12.8 )   (46.5 )

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principles—goodwill and asset retirement obligations (nil tax)

   —       (5.3 )   —    
    

 

 

Net profit/(loss) per US GAAP

   90.4     51.3     (172.0 )
    

 

 

Earnings per share - basic and diluted (Australian Cents)

                  

Continuing operations                - basic

   46 ¢   37 ¢   (67

                                                      - diluted

   46 ¢   37 ¢   (67

Discontinued operations            - basic

   4 ¢   (7   (25

                                                      - diluted

   4 ¢   (7   (25

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle    - basic

   —       (3   —    

                                                                                             - diluted

   —       (3   —    
    

 

 

Net Profit/(Loss)(3)                     - basic

   50 ¢   27 ¢   (92

                                                      - diluted

   50 ¢   27 ¢   (92
    

 

 

Condensed US GAAP Consolidated Statement of Income Data excluding Discontinued Operations

                  

Revenues

   1,113.3     1,293.6     1,414.2  

Total costs and expenses

   992.5     1,170.9     1,458.1  

Interest expense

   16.8     26.5     54.7  

Tax expense

   20.7     26.8     26.9  
    

 

 

Profit/(Loss) from continuing operations

   83.3     69.4     (125.5 )
    

 

 

(1)      Includes net gain/(loss) on disposal/liquidation of businesses and controlled entities

   —       (7.0 )   25.7  

(2)(3)  Proforma earnings and EPS for 2002 inclusive of the adoption of SFAS No. 142 would be:

                  
Reported Net Profit/(Loss)    90.4     51.3     (172.0 )

Goodwill and brand name amortisation added back

               22.1  
    

 

 

Adjusted Net Profit/(Loss)

   90.4     51.3     (149.9 )
    

 

 

Basic Earnings per share (Australian cents)                   

Reported Net Profit/(Loss)

   50 ¢   27 ¢   (92

Goodwill and brand name amortisation

               12 ¢
    

 

 

Adjusted Net Profit/(Loss)

   50 ¢   27 ¢   (80
    

 

 

 

134


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

40. RECONCILIATION TO UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (US GAAP) (CONTINUED)

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 
           Restated     Restated  

Reconciliation of Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities per Australian GAAP

                  

financial statements to Net Profit/(Loss) after Tax Under US GAAP

                  

Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities per AGAAP

   179.2     161.6     113.1  

Items classified as financing activities: (1)

                  

Interest received

   9.0     8.0     15.5  

Interest paid

   (29.4 )   (37.8 )   (70.2 )

Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities per US GAAP

   158.8     131.8     58.4  

Write-down of non-current assets

   (1.0 )   (6.1 )   (144.5 )

Depreciation

   (23.8 )   (29.4 )   (50.1 )

Amortisation

   (1.9 )   (2.5 )   (24.3 )

Provision for doubtful debts - trade

   (1.2 )   2.5     2.9  

Write off of Deferred Tax Assets attributable to Australian tax losses

   —       —       (15.2 )

Write down of property, plant and equipment

   (8.8 )   —       —    

Share of net loss of associate and joint venture entities

   (7.7 )   (16.1 )   (48.5 )

Change in assets and liabilities net of effect from acquisitions and disposals of subsidiaries and businesses:

                  

(Decrease)/Increase in debtors

   (24.9 )   (34.5 )   0.3  

(Decrease)/Increase in inventories

   2.6     (47.2 )   (39.4 )

(Decrease)/Increase in prepaids

   0.8     (4.9 )   2.4  

(Decrease)/Increase in deferred expenses

   —       —       (4.3 )

(Increase)/Decrease in creditors and bills payable

   6.0     36.5     (78.3 )

Decrease in lease liabilities, provisions and other liabilities

   (2.2 )   37.4     187.9  

(Increase)/Decrease in provision for deferred income tax

   1.3     2.9     (2.3 )

Increase/(Decrease) in future income tax benefit

   (7.8 )   (17.7 )   (24.7 )

(Increase)/Decrease in provision for income tax

   0.5     (1.2 )   8.5  

(Loss)/Gain on sale of investments, properties, plant and equipment

   1.6     5.6     (5.6 )

Gain/(loss) on sale/liquidation of subsidiaries and businesses

   —       (7.0 )   27.2  

Outside equity interest in profit for the year

   (1.9 )   (2.6 )   (2.8 )

Other

   —       3.8     (19.6 )
    

 

 

Net Profit/(Loss) after tax

   90.4     51.3     (172.0 )
    

 

 

 

(1) Interest is classified as a financing activity under AGAAP.

 

135


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

40. RECONCILIATION TO UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (US GAAP) (CONTINUED)

 

           Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   Note

    2004

    2003

    2002

 

Adjustments to reflect U.S. GAAP

               Restated     Restated  

Add/(Deduct):      Amortisation of goodwill for AGAAP purposes only

   39 (i)   21.4     25.3     —    

 Reduced goodwill amortisation charge as a result of differences in useful lives

   39 (i)   —       —       12.7  

 Amortisation of goodwill capitalised for US GAAP purposes only

   39 (i)   —       —       (2.4 )

 Write-down of US GAAP goodwill on adoption of SFAS No. 142

   39 (i)   —       (5.0 )   —    

 Amortisation of brand names capitalised

   39 (j)   —       —       (4.5 )

 Amortisation of compensation component of options

   39 (d)   (0.3 )   (0.7 )   1.9  

 Creation of asset retirement obligation on adoption of SFAS No. 143

   39 (p)   —       (0.3 )   —    

 Amortisation of asset retirement obligation

   39 (p)   (0.1 )   (0.1 )   —    

 Pension Plans (1)

   39 (f)   5.8     1.9     5.4  

 Income tax expense

         (1.8 )   (0.6 )   (1.9 )

 Depreciation of asset revaluation included in depreciation charge

   39 (a)   —       —       0.2  

 Net realisation of asset revaluation reserve and related depreciation adjustment on sale/liquidation of controlled entities, businesses and assets

   39 (a)   0.8     (7.0 )   20.5  

 Net hedge (losses)/gains (brought to account)/ deferred for AGAAP

   39 (k)   (2.0 )   2.4     (1.9 )

 Income tax (expense)/benefit

         0.6     (0.7 )   0.6  

 Rationalisation and restructuring provision

   39 (c)   —       —       (30.0 )

 Income tax benefit

         —       —       8.1  

 Goodwill capitalised for US GAAP purposes written off on sale of controlled entities and businesses

   39 (i)   —       —       (34.5 )

 Incremental gain on sale of controlled entities and businesses due to lower carrying value of amortised brand names

   39 (j)   —       —       15.5  

 Net change in fair value hedges

   39 (m)   1.8     1.3     2.6  

 Income tax expense

         (0.5 )   (0.4 )   (0.8 )

 Equity share in loss of South Pacific Tyres

   39 (n)   (7.7 )   (16.4 )   (50.4 )

 Income tax benefit

         2.3     4.9     11.1  

 Valuation adjustment for above income tax (benefit)/expense amounts

         (0.6 )   (3.2 )   (8.4 )
          

 

 

Total Adjustments

         19.7     1.4     (56.2 )
          

 

 

Shareholders’ Equity of the Group as at 30th June

         811.8     844.5     876.0  

Deduct: Outside equity interests

   39 (b)   (10.2 )   (10.8 )   (13.7 )
          

 

 

Shareholders’ equity attributable to Ansell Limited

         801.6     833.7     862.3  
          

 

 

Adjustments required to accord with U.S. GAAP:

                        

Add / (Deduct): Goodwill not capitalised for Australian GAAP - net of amortisation and amortisation adjustments on Australian GAAP goodwill (including fx impact)

   39 (i)   184.4     148.6     123.7  

  Amortisation of brand names – cumulative (including fx impact)

   39 (j)   (21.5 )   (22.2 )   (26.1 )

  Amortisation of asset retirement obligations

   39 (p)   (0.5 )   (0.4 )   —    

  Pension Plans

   39 (f)   13.9     8.1     6.2  

  Hedging adjustments net of nil tax

   39 (k)   0.1     2.1     (0.3 )

  Reserves attributable to Asset Revaluation

   39 (a)   (0.7 )   (1.5 )   (20.2 )

  Depreciation charged on Revaluation increments

   39 (a)   0.1     0.1     12.6  

  Loans outstanding under ownership based remuneration scheme

   39 (d)   (0.8 )   (1.2 )   (4.3 )

  Net change in fair value hedges, hedged items and cash flow hedges

   39 (m)   0.8     (1.0 )   (2.3 )

  Net gains/(losses) on cash flow hedges residing in Comprehensive Income

   39 (m)   4.7     (12.6 )   (13.7 )

  Additional minimum pension liability residing in Comprehensive Income

   39 (f)   (13.2 )   (7.9 )   —    

  Gain on equity securities residing in Comprehensive Income

   39 (n)   —       —       1.0  

  Equity share of South Pacific Tyres

   39 (n)   (89.2 )   (81.5 )   (65.1 )
          

 

 

Total Adjustments

         78.1     30.6     11.5  
          

 

 

Ansell Limited Shareholders’ Equity according to U.S. GAAP (including Comprehensive Income)

         879.7     864.3     873.8  
          

 

 

Note: All US GAAP adjustments are in respect of 100% owned operations

                        

Statement of Comprehensive Income:

                        

Net profit/(loss) per U.S. GAAP

         90.4     51.3     (172.0 )

Foreign Currency Translation Reserve net of nil tax

         (6.3 )   (63.2 )   (74.1 )

Unrealised net gain/(loss) on cash flow hedges net of nil tax

         17.3     1.1     (12.1 )

Additional minimum pension liability net of nil tax

         (5.3 )   (7.9 )   —    

Unrealised gain/(loss) on available for sale equity securities net of nil tax

         —       (1.0 )   1.0  
          

 

 

Comprehensive Income/(Loss)

         96.1     (19.7 )   (257.2 )
          

 

 

 

(1) Pension Plans - includes curtailment gains of $6.1 million for 2002 resulting from the sale of businesses.

 

136


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

40. RECONCILIATION TO UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (US GAAP) (CONTINUED)

 

     2004

    2003

 

$ in Millions


   Australian
Fund


    US Funds

    Australian
Fund


    US Funds

 

Pension Plan data supporting Note 39(f)

                        

Plan’s funded status at 30 June is summarised as follows:

                        

Actuarial present value of accumulated obligations:

                        

- Vested

   19.9     54.9     63.3     57.6  

- Non-vested

   —       1.2     0.7     1.3  

Total accumulated benefit obligation

   19.9     56.1     64.0     58.9  

Projected benefit obligation

   20.6     56.7     64.4     59.8  

Plan assets at fair value

   41.7     40.8     79.6     36.1  

Excess/(deficiency) of assets over benefit obligations

   21.1     (15.9 )   15.2     (23.7 )

Unrecognised net gain/(loss)

   (5.6 )   15.1     (16.4 )   24.2  

Unrecognised prior service costs

   —       (0.8 )   —       (1.4 )

Unrecognised net transition obligation/(asset) and other deferrals

   —       —       (1.0 )   —    

Net Pension (Liability)/Asset

   15.5     (1.6 )   (2.2 )   (0.9 )

NET PENSION COST

                        

Defined Benefit Plans:

                        

- Service cost-benefits earned during the year

   0.9     2.5     1.9     3.1  

- Interest cost on projected benefit obligation

   1.0     3.3     4.3     4.2  

- Expected return on plan assets

   (2.7 )   (3.7 )   (5.5 )   (4.7 )

- Net amortisation and settlement and curtailment (gain)/loss

   (5.9 )   3.1     (1.1 )   0.8  

Net Pension Cost of Defined Benefit Plans

   (6.7 )   5.2     (0.4 )   3.4  

ASSUMPTIONS (used to determine net pension cost)

                        

Weighted average discount rate

   5.0 %   5.8 %   5.0 %   5.8 %

Rate of increase in compensation level

   4.0 %   4.3 %   3.5 %   4.3 %

Expected long term rate of return

   7.0 %   8.0 %   7.0 %   8.0 %

The expected long term rate of return on pension assets is based on a strategic asset allocation. The real rate of return (net of inflation) is expected to average 5% over the long term and the long term average rate of inflation is expected to be 3%.

                        

MEASUREMENT DATE

   30 June 04     31 March 04     30 June 03     31 March 03  

CHANGE IN BENEFIT OBLIGATION

                        

Projected Benefit Obligation at beginning of year

   64.4     59.8     82.6     67.9  

Service cost

   0.9     2.5     1.9     3.1  

Interest cost

   1.0     3.3     4.3     4.2  

Transfers from/(to) other funds*

   (42.5 )   —       1.2     —    

Member contributions

   0.3     —       2.2     —    

Actuarial (gain)/loss

   1.5     0.3     (7.4 )   6.3  

Benefits, administrative expenses and tax paid

   (5.0 )   (7.2 )   (20.4 )   (11.5 )

Foreign currency exchange rate changes

   —       (2.0 )   —       (10.2 )

Projected Benefit Obligation at end of year

   20.6     56.7     64.4     59.8  

ASSUMPTIONS (used to determine end of year benefit obligations)

                        

Weighted average discount rate

   5.0 %   5.8 %   5.0 %   5.8 %

Rate of increase in compensation level

   4.0 %   4.3 %   3.5 %   4.3 %

CHANGE IN PLAN ASSETS

                        

Market value of assets at beginning of year

   79.6     36.1     84.9     54.5  

Adjustment to fair value at beginning of the year

   2.6     —       —       —    

Member/Employer Contributions

   —       4.3     2.3     4.8  

Transfers from/(to) other funds*

   (42.5 )   —       1.2     —    

Benefits, administrative expenses and tax paid

   (5.0 )   (7.2 )   (20.4 )   (11.5 )

Actual return on plan assets

   7.0     8.7     11.6     (5.2 )

Foreign currency exchange rate changes

   —       (1.1 )   —       (6.5 )

Market value of assets at end of year

   41.7     40.8     79.6     36.1  

 

* Current year represents removal of assets and liabilities relating to Ansell accumulation members from disclosures.

 

137


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

40. RECONCILIATION TO UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (US GAAP) (CONTINUED)

 

$ in Millions

 

Pension Plan data supporting Note 39(f) (continued)

 

CONTRIBUTIONS

 

Employer contributions to the Australian fund during the fiscal year ending 30 June 2005 are expected to be nil. In respect of its US plans the Company expects to contribute $4.6 million to the plans in 2005.

 

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION - AUSTRALIAN FUND

 

Estimated Future Benefit Payments

 

The following benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, are expected to be paid:

 

2005        2.7
2006        1.6
2007        1.7
2008        1.9
2009        2.4
2010 -2014        11.4

 

Plan Assets

 

The allocation of the Fund’s assets by asset category is as follows:

 

Asset Category


   Target
Allocation


    Plan assets at 30 June

 
     2004

    2003

 

Equity securities

   64 %   64 %   73 %

Fixed Interest

   22 %   21 %   15 %

Real estate

   9 %   9 %   10 %

Other

   5 %   6 %   2 %

 

The primary investment objective of the Ansell Employer Benefit Account is to achieve a rate of return (after tax and investment expenses) that exceeds inflation (CPI) increases by at least 4.0% per annum over rolling three year periods.

 

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION - USA FUNDS

 

Estimated Future Benefit Payments

 

The following benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, are expected to be paid:

 

2005        4.2
2006        2.4
2007        3.1
2008        3.5
2009        3.7
2010 -2014        27.7

 

Plan Assets

 

The allocation of the funded US pension plans’ weighted-average assets by asset category are as follows:

 

    

Target

Allocation


    Plan assets at 31 March

 

Asset Category


     2004

    2003

 

Equity securities

   62 %   64 %   56 %

Debt securities

   32 %   32 %   41 %

Real estate

   3 %   3 %   —    

Other

   3 %   1 %   3 %

 

The target allocation currently is 62% equity (47% US, 15% International), 3% real estate, 32% debt and 3% cash. Over the past 5 years the allocation to equities has ranged from 55% to 65% depending on market conditions and the expected ability of the Plan to meet an 8% earnings assumption. The asset allocation is reviewed at least annually and adjusted based on past and future assumptions for market returns. Recent low level interest rates have necessitated a rise in the equity allocation to increase the probability of achieving an 8% return. The investment approach dictated in the IPS is to maintain sufficient diversification by asset class and economic sectors. The IPS mandates that each manager be diversified and that significant sector deviations to the benchmark be explained and approved.

 

138


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

40. RECONCILIATION TO UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (US GAAP) (CONTINUED)

 

Information for United States Investors

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Proceeds Received from the sale of businesses and investments per Note 3

                  

Pacific Automotive business

   —       —       238.7  

Pacific Brands business

   —       —       701.0  
    

 

 

     —       —       939.7  
    

 

 

Material Write-down of assets

                  

Ambri Investment

                  

The Group’s investment in Ambri Ltd has been written down to recoverable amount.

   (1.0 )   (6.1 )   —    

Exide Receivable/Investment (i)

   —       —       (99.9 )

As a result of Exide Inc filing for chapter 11 bankruptcy protection and subsequent demise of Exide Inc’s share price the company fully wrote off its investment in and all amounts receivable from Exide Inc.

                  

Ansell Healthcare fixed assets (ii)

   —       —       (63.1 )

Following the announcement to close Ansell Healthcare’s manufacturing facility in Troy, Alabama the company wrote down the value of plant and equipment at the site to estimated recoverable value. In addition, certain other values attributed to land and buildings within the USA were written down to independently appraised values.

                  

Other (iii)

   —       —       (13.5 )

Represents the write-down of various assets to recoverable amount as determined by the

                  

company.

                  

 

(i) Included within Income/Loss from discontinued operations

 

(ii) Included within Income/Loss from continuing operations

 

(iii) Of this amount $3.6 million is included within Income/(Loss) from continuing operations and $9.9 million included within Income/Loss from discontinued operations.

 

           Restated

    Restated

 

US GAAP Equity Roll-forward

                  

Opening Balance US GAAP equity

   864.3     873.8     1,138.9  

US GAAP Profit/(Loss)

   90.4     51.3     (172.0 )

Proceeds from issue of shares

   1.0     1.0     1.2  

Dividends

   (31.0 )   —       —    

Share buy back

   (65.4 )   (8.2 )   —    

Movement in AGAAP Foreign Currency Translation Reserve

   (7.4 )   (71.3 )   (69.6 )

Unrealised net gain/(loss) on cash flow hedges in OCI

   17.3     1.1     (12.1 )

Additional minimum pension liability in OCI

   (5.3 )   (7.9 )   —    

Movements in Loans outstanding under Employee Share Plan

   0.4     3.1     4.3  

Other (including FX on US GAAP adjustments)

   15.4     21.4     (16.9 )
    

 

 

Closing balance US GAAP equity

   879.7     864.3     873.8  
    

 

 

 

139


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

40. RECONCILIATION TO UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (US GAAP) (CONTINUED)

 

Information for United States Investors (continued)

 

     Consolidated

 

$ in Millions


   2004

    2003

    2002

 

Goodwill:

                  

AGAAP goodwill - written down value 30 June

   176.0     203.3     260.7  

Add: Amortisation for AGAAP only from 1 July 2002

   46.7     25.3     —    

Add: Net Goodwill recognised for US GAAP only

   33.3     33.3     38.3  

Add :Adjustment for different amortisation basis on AGAAP goodwill

   104.4     90.0     85.4  
    

 

 

US GAAP goodwill - written down value 30 June

   360.4     351.9     384.4  
    

 

 

US GAAP Goodwill Comprises:

                  

Gross Goodwill

   438.2     448.6     516.7  

Accumulated Amortisation

   (77.8 )   (96.7 )   (132.3 )
    

 

 

Written down value

   360.4     351.9     384.4  
    

 

 

Brand names

                  

AGAAP brand names - 30 June

   117.4     121.2     142.5  

(Deduct): US GAAP accumulated amortisation

   (21.5 )   (22.2 )   (26.1 )
    

 

 

US GAAP Brand names - 30 June

   95.9     99.0     116.4  
    

 

 

Property, plant & equipment

                  

Property, plant & equipment at cost and valuation (net of accumulated depreciation)

   227.8     262.9     332.5  

(Deduct): Asset revaluation reserves applicable

   (0.7 )   (1.5 )   (20.2 )

Add: Adjustment to add back depreciation charged on the revaluation increments (cumulative)

   0.1     0.1     12.6  
    

 

 

Property, plant & equipment at cost (net of accumulated depreciation)

   227.2     261.5     324.9  
    

 

 

Analysis of long-lived assets by Country

                  

- Australia

   53.4     62.8     72.5  

- USA

   293.4     338.1     430.4  

- Malaysia

   77.5     83.2     98.6  

- Thailand

   56.0     61.9     80.2  

- Sri Lanka

   43.7     49.3     61.0  

- Other Countries

   51.2     54.6     85.2  
    

 

 

     575.2     649.9     827.9  
    

 

 

Asset Retirement Obligations

                  

Asset retirement obligations relate to future legal obligations to restore certain leased facilities

                  

to their original conditions as at the commencement of the lease.

                  

Asset retirement obligation

                  

Balance at beginning of period

   0.8     —       —    

Initial balance on adoption of SFAS No. 143

   —       0.7     —    

Liabilities incurred in current period

   0.1     0.1     —    
    

 

 

Balance at end of period

   0.9     0.8     —    
    

 

 

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income

                  

Foreign Currency Translation Reserve net of nil tax

   (138.2 )   (131.9 )   (68.7 )

Unrealised net gain/(loss) on cash flow hedges net of nil tax

   4.7     (12.6 )   (13.7 )

Additional minimum pension liability net of nil tax

   (13.2 )   (7.9 )   —    

Unrealised gain on available for sale equity securities net of nil tax

   —       —       1.0  
    

 

 

     (146.7 )   (144.5 )   (81.4 )
    

 

 

 

140


PART III

 

Item 18 : Consolidated Financial Statements

 

40. RECONCILIATION TO UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (US GAAP) (CONTINUED)

 

Information for United States Investors (continued)

 

Executive Share Option Data Supporting Notes 39(d), 25 and 28

 

SFAS 123 “Accounting for Stock Based Compensation” encourages the adoption of a fair value based method of determining compensation costs. For US GAAP purposes, the company has adopted the fair value provision of SFAS 123.

 

The compensation fair value of all options which are outstanding has been calculated at $1.0 million. In respect of the options granted to Mr D.Tough (on his appointment as Chief Executive Officer on 1 July 2004) the performance hurdles that must be met before vesting can occur have not as yet been finalised. The compensation fair value will be determined in order to allow for the amortisation over the vesting period which commences 1 July 2004.

 

141


PART III

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

To the members of Ansell Limited:

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated Statements of Financial Position of Ansell Limited and its subsidiaries as of 30 June, 2004, 2003 and 2002, and the related consolidated Statements of Financial Performance, and of Cash Flows for each of the years in the three year period ended 30 June, 2004. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Ansell Limited and its subsidiaries at 30 June, 2004, 2003 and 2002, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three year period ended 30 June, 2004 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in Australia.

 

Accounting principles generally accepted in Australia vary in certain significant respects from accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. Information relating to the nature and effect of such differences is presented in Notes 39 and 40 to the consolidated financial statements. The application of accounting principles generally accepted in the United States would have affected consolidated financial performance for each of the years in the three year period ended June 30, 2004 and the determination of Shareholder’s equity as of June 30, 2004, 2003 and 2002, to the extent summarized in Notes 39 and 40 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

As discussed in Note 39 to the consolidated financial statements, the company has restated the effects of certain differences between generally accepted accounting principles in Australia and generally accepted accounting principles in the United States and their effects on financial performance and shareholders equity for each of the years in the two year period ended June 30, 2003.

 

/s/ KPMG

 

Melbourne

 

31 August, 2004 except for Notes 39 and 40, for which the date is 15 March, 2005.

 

142


PART III

 

Item 19 :  Exhibits

 

See Exhibit Index

 

143


PART III

 

Signature

 

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this annual report on its behalf.

 

Ansell Limited Registrant

/s/ Rustom Jilla

Rustom Jilla

Chief Financial Officer

 

Dated: 28 March 2005

 

144


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

South Pacific Tyres

 

Statements filed in accordance with Rule 3.09.

 

STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE

 

For the year ended 30th June 2004

 

     Notes

   

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 
                          

Revenue from sale of goods

   3     763,609,409     737,027,575     769,790,943  

Revenue from rendering services

   3     55,127,229     56,569,421     59,595,043  

Other revenues from ordinary activities

   3     6,503,245     6,407,910     7,615,697  
          

 

 

Total revenue from ordinary activities

         825,239,883     800,004,906     837,001,683  

Cost of goods sold

         591,739,184     587,501,675     647,665,319  

Selling, Administrative and General Expenses

         218,086,061     219,985,037     225,688,548  

Significant items

   4 (b)   11,790,923     9,752,650     93,108,359  

Borrowing costs

   4 (b)   21,937,942     17,834,103     13,660,548  

Other expenses from ordinary activities

         297,389     287,389     485,062  
          

 

 

Expenses from ordinary activities

         843,851,499     835,360,854     980,607,836  
          

 

 

Loss from ordinary activities before related income tax expense

         (18,611,616 )   (35,355,948 )   (143,606,153 )
          

 

 

Income tax expense/(benefit) relating to ordinary activities

   6 (a)   3,869,684     4,207,837     (13,579,453 )
          

 

 

Loss from ordinary activities after related income tax expense

         (22,481,300 )   (39,563,785 )   (130,026,700 )

Net loss attributable to outside equity interests

   21     —       —       (470 )
          

 

 

Net Loss after income tax attributable to the consolidated entity

         (22,481,300 )   (39,563,785 )   (130,027,170 )
          

 

 

See accompanying notes to financial statements.

                        

 

145


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION

 

As at 30th June 2004

 

     Notes

   

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

CURRENT ASSETS

                        

Cash assets

   7     56,435,875     15,229,939     37,100,672  

Receivables

   8     130,174,880     137,441,630     141,657,657  

Inventories

   9     147,411,193     162,032,137     160,741,965  

Prepayments

   10     3,219,753     3,323,269     2,258,575  
          

 

 

TOTAL CURRENT ASSETS

         337,241,701     318,026,975     341,758,869  
          

 

 

NON-CURRENT ASSETS

                        

Receivables

   8     1,651,270     9,546,303     30,384,952  

Property, plant and equipment

   12     197,823,676     218,425,028     202,827,093  

Intangible assets

   13     4,498,952     4,916,874     5,204,262  

Deferred tax assets

   6 (c)   14,516,753     18,231,572     22,441,327  
          

 

 

TOTAL NON-CURRENT ASSETS

         218,490,651     251,119,777     260,857,634  
          

 

 

TOTAL ASSETS

         555,732,352     569,146,752     602,616,503  
          

 

 

CURRENT LIABILITIES

                        

Payables

   14     144,028,406     159,953,830     161,782,718  

Interest bearing liabilities

   15     188,484,663     171,413,834     142,395,212  

Current tax liabilities

   6 (b)   290,809     135,944     58,887  

Provisions

   16     54,318,272     53,365,690     102,837,858  
          

 

 

TOTAL CURRENT LIABILITIES

         387,122,150     384,869,298     407,074,675  
          

 

 

NON-CURRENT LIABILITIES

                        

Payables

   14     704,179     7,986,959     28,491,815  

Interest bearing liabilities

   15     125,707,508     111,097,444     61,095,014  

Provisions

   16     6,357,177     6,883,413     7,978,203  
          

 

 

TOTAL NON-CURRENT LIABILITIES

         132,768,864     125,967,816     97,565,032  
          

 

 

TOTAL LIABLITIES

         519,891,014     510,837,114     504,639,707  
          

 

 

PARTNERS’ EQUITY

                        

Contributed equity

   18     317,688,138     317,675,138     317,675,138  

Reserves

   19     12,374,551     12,570,229     12,570,229  

Accumulated losses

   20     (294,221,351 )   (271,935,729 )   (232,268,571 )
          

 

 

TOTAL PARTNERS’ EQUITY

         35,841,338     58,309,638     97,976,796  

Outside equity interest

   21     —       —       —    
          

 

 

TOTAL PARTNERS’ EQUITY

         35,841,338     58,309,638     97,976,796  
          

 

 

TOTAL LIABILITIES AND PARTNERS’ EQUITY

         555,732,352     569,146,752     602,616,503  
          

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to financial statements.

 

146


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

STATEMENT OF PARTNERS’ EQUITY

 

     Contributed
Equity


   Outside
Equity
Interest


    Accumulated
Losses


    Reserves

    Total
Partners’
Equity


 

Balance at June 30, 2001

   317,675,137    485,688     (98,587,215 )   9,220,023     228,793,633  

Net loss

              (130,027,170 )         (130,027,170 )

Foreign currency translation

                    (303,980 )   (303,980 )

Foreign Currency Translation Reserve - disposal

              (3,645,848 )   3,645,848        

Asset Revaluation Reserve - disposal

              (8,338 )   8,338        

Outside equity interest reduction

        (485,688 )               (485,688 )

Additional contributed equity

   1                      1  
    
  

 

 

 

Balance at June 30, 2002

   317,675,138    —       (232,268,571 )   12,570,229     97,976,796  

Net loss

              (39,563,785 )         (39,563,785 )

Initial adoption of AASB1028

              (103,373 )         (103,373 )
    
  

 

 

 

Balance at June 30, 2003

   317,675,138    —       (271,935,729 )   12,570,229     58,309,638  

Net loss

              (22,481,300 )         (22,481,300 )

Asset Revaluation Reserve - disposal

              195,678     (195,678 )      

Additional contributed equity

   13,000                      13,000  
    
  

 

 

 

Balance at June 30, 2004

   317,688,138    —       (294,221,351 )   12,374,551     35,841,338  
    
  

 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to financial statements.

 

147


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

     Notes

    2004
$
Inflows
(Outflows)


    2003
$
Inflows
(Outflows)


    2002
$
Inflows
(Outflows)


 

Cash flows from operating activities

                        

Cash receipts in the course of operations

         941,655,101     836,176,622     856,792,111  

Cash payments in the course of operations

         (908,776,962 )   (882,305,840 )   (870,905,731 )

Interest received

         1,160,246     1,935,297     3,689,606  

Borrowing costs paid

         (13,589,472 )   (12,737,555 )   (13,368,875 )

Income taxes (paid)/refunded

   6 (b)   —       79,774     (112,184 )
          

 

 

Net cash provided by/(used in) operating activities

   30 (c)   20,448,913     (56,851,702 )   (23,905,073 )
          

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities

                        

Proceeds on disposal of controlled entities

         —       —       1,983,805  

Proceeds on disposal of property, plant and equipment

         5,342,999     4,472,613     2,919,839  

Payments for businesses, (net of cash acquired)

   30 (b)   —       —       (1,246,831 )

Payments for property, plant and equipment

         (16,279,869 )   (48,512,695 )   (14,750,236 )
          

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

         (10,936,870 )   (44,040,082 )   (11,093,423 )
          

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities

                        

Proceeds from partner contributions

         13,000     —       —    

Proceeds from borrowings

         49,782,954     79,333,371     136,589,773  

Repayment of borrowings

         (18,195,000 )   —       (79,935,051 )

Dividends paid

         —       —       (2,146 )
          

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

         31,600,954     79,333,371     56,652,576  
          

 

 

Net increase/(decrease) in cash held

         41,112,997     (21,558,413 )   21,654,080  

Cash at the beginning of the financial year

         14,539,451     36,097,864     14,170,702  

Effects of exchange rate fluctuations on the balances of cash held

                        

in foreign currencies

         —       —       273,082  
          

 

 

Cash at the end of the financial year

   30 (a)   55,652,448     14,539,451     36,097,864  
          

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to financial statements.

 

148


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

Note 1 Statement of significant accounting policies

 

General

 

The principal activities of the consolidated entity during the period were:

 

    Manufacture of tyres for vehicles

 

    Wholesaling and retailing of vehicle and aircraft tyres.

 

There were no significant changes in the nature of the principal activities of the consolidated entity during the year.

 

The significant policies which have been adopted in the preparation of this financial report are:

 

(a) Basis of preparation

 

In accordance with Section 11 of the Partnership Agreement, South Pacific Tyres (“the consolidated entity”) is required to prepare a financial report as if it were a public company under the provisions of the Corporations Act 2001.

 

In the opinion of the directors, the consolidated entity is not a reporting entity. The financial report of the consolidated entity has been drawn up as a special purpose financial report for distribution to the partners and for the purpose of fulfilling the requirements of the Corporations Act 2001.

 

The financial report has been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Corporations Act 2001, the recognition and measurements aspects of all applicable accounting standards and other mandatory professional reporting requirements (Urgent Issues Group Consensus Views) that have a material effect.

 

The financial report has been prepared on the accrual basis of accounting as defined in AASB1001, Accounting Policies, using historical cost convention and going concern assumption. Except where stated, it does not take into account changing money values or current valuations of non-current assets.

 

The accounting policies have been consistently applied by each entity in the consolidated entity, and except where there is a change in accounting policy, are consistent with those of the previous year.

 

(b) Principles of consolidation

 

Controlled entities

 

The financial statements of controlled entities are included from the date control commences until the date control ceases.

 

Outside interests in the equity and results of the entities that are controlled by the consolidated entity are shown as a separate item in the consolidated financial statements.

 

Transactions eliminated on consolidation

 

Unrealised gains and losses and inter-entity balances resulting from transactions with or between controlled entities are eliminated in full on consolidation.

 

(c) Revenue recognition - Note 3

 

Revenues are recognised at fair value of the consideration received net of the amount of goods and services tax (GST) payable to the taxation authority.

 

Sale of goods

 

Revenue from the sale of goods is recognised (net of returns, discounts and allowances) when control of the goods passes to the customer.

 

Rendering of services

 

Revenue from rendering services is recognised when the service has been completed.

 

Interest revenue

 

Interest revenue is recognised as it accrues, taking into account the effective yield on the financial asset.

 

Sale of non-current assets

 

The gross proceeds of non-current asset sales are included as revenue at the date control of the asset passes to the buyer, usually when an unconditional contract of sale is signed.

 

The gain or loss on disposal is calculated as the difference between the carrying amount of the asset at the time of disposal and the net proceeds on disposal (including incidental costs ).

 

149


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 1 Statement of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

(d) Goods and services tax

 

Revenues, expenses and assets are recognised net of the amount of goods and services tax (GST), except where the amount of GST incurred is not recoverable from the Australian Tax Office (ATO). In these circumstances the GST is recognised as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset or as part of an item of the expense. Receivables and payables are stated with the amount of GST included.

 

The net amount of GST recoverable from, or payable to, the ATO is included as a current asset or current liability in the statement of financial position. Cash flows are included in the statement of cash flows on a gross basis. The GST components of cash flows arising from investing and financing activities which are recoverable from, or payable to, the ATO are classified as operating cash flows.

 

(e) Foreign currency

 

Transactions

 

Foreign currency transactions are translated to Australian currency at the rates of exchange ruling at the dates of the transactions. Amounts receivable and payable in foreign currencies at reporting date are translated at the rates of exchange ruling on that date.

 

Exchange differences relating to amounts payable and receivable in foreign currencies are brought to account as exchange gains or losses in the statement of financial performance in the financial year in which the exchange rates change.

 

Translation of controlled foreign entities

 

The assets and liabilities of foreign operations that are self-sustaining are translated at the rates of exchange ruling at reporting date. Equity items are translated at historical rates. The statements of financial performance are translated at a weighted average rate for the year. Exchange differences arising on translation are taken directly to the foreign currency translation reserve until the disposal, or partial disposal, of the operations.

 

The balance of the foreign currency translation reserve relating to a foreign operation that is disposed of, or partially disposed of, is transferred to retained profits in the year of disposal.

 

(f) Derivatives

 

The consolidated entity is exposed to changes in interest rates, foreign exchange rates and commodity prices from its activities. The consolidated entity uses the following derivative financial instruments to hedge these risks: interest rate swaps and forward foreign exchange contracts. Derivative financial instruments are not held for speculative purposes.

 

Hedges

 

Anticipated transactions

 

Transactions are designated as a hedge of the anticipated specific purchase or sale of goods or services, purchase of qualifying assets, or an anticipated interest transaction, only when they are expected to reduce exposure to the risks being hedged, are designated prospectively so that it is clear when an anticipated transaction has or has not occurred and it is probable the anticipated transaction will occur as designated. Gains or losses on the hedge arising up to the date of the anticipated transaction, together with any costs or gains arising at the time of entering into the hedge, are deferred and included in the measurement of the anticipated transaction when the transaction has occurred as designated. Any gains or losses on the hedge transaction after that date are included in the statement of financial performance.

 

The net amounts receivable or payable under open swaps and forward rate agreements and the associated deferred gains or losses are not recorded in the statement of financial position until the hedge transaction occurs. When recognised the net receivables or payables are then revalued using the foreign currency and interest rates current at reporting date. Refer to Note 22

 

When the anticipated transaction is no longer expected to occur as designated, the deferred gains or losses relating to the hedged transaction are recognised immediately in the statement of financial performance.

 

Where a hedge transaction is terminated early and the anticipated transaction is still expected to occur as designated, the deferred gains or losses that arose on the hedge prior to its termination continue to be deferred and are included in the measurement of the purchase or sale or interest transaction when it occurs. Where a hedge transaction is terminated early because the anticipated transaction is no longer expected to occur as designated, deferred gains or losses that arose on the hedge prior to its termination are included in the statement of financial performance for the period.

 

Where a hedge is redesignated as a hedge of another transaction, gains or losses arising on the hedge prior to its redesignation are only deferred where the original anticipated transaction is still expected to occur as designated. When the original anticipated transaction is no longer expected to occur as designated, any gains or losses relating to the hedge instrument are included in the statement of financial performance for the period.

 

Gains or losses that arise prior to and upon the maturity of transactions entered into under hedge rollover strategies are deferred and included in the measurement of the hedged anticipated transaction if the transaction is still expected to occur as designated. If the anticipated transaction is no longer expected to occur as designated, the gains or losses are recognised immediately in the statement of financial performance.

 

Other hedges

 

All other hedge transactions are initially recorded at the relevant rate at the date of the transaction. Hedges outstanding at reporting date are valued at the rates ruling on that date and any gains or losses are brought to account in the statement of financial performance.

 

Cost or gains arising at the time of entering into the hedge are deferred and amortised over the life of the hedge.

 

150


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 1 Statement of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

(g) Borrowing costs

 

Borrowing costs include interest, amortisation of discounts or premiums relating to borrowings and amortisation of ancillary costs incurred in connection with arrangement of borrowings.

 

Interest payments in respect of financial instruments classified as liabilities are included in borrowing costs.

 

Where interest rates are hedged or swapped, the borrowing costs are recognised net of any effect of the hedge or the swap.

 

Borrowing costs are expensed as incurred unless they relate to qualifying assets. Qualifying assets are assets which take more than 12 months to get ready for their intended use or sale. In these circumstances, borrowing costs are capitalised to the cost of the asset. Where funds are borrowed specifically for the acquisition, construction or production of a qualifying asset, the amount of borrowing costs capitalised is those incurred in relation to that borrowing, net of any interest earned on those borrowings. Where funds are borrowed generally, borrowing costs are capitalised using a weighted average capitalisation rate.

 

(h) Taxation - Note 6

 

Consolidated entity

 

Income tax is only provided for in the financial statements in respect of the corporate entities forming part of the consolidated entity of South Pacific Tyres.

 

Controlled entities

 

The controlled entities adopt the income statement liability method of tax effect accounting.

 

Income tax expense is calculated on operating profit adjusted for permanent differences between taxable and accounting income. The tax effect of timing differences, which arise from the items being brought to account in different periods for income tax and accounting purposes, is carried forward in the statement of financial position as a future income tax benefit or a provision for deferred income tax.

 

Future income tax benefits are not brought to account unless realisation of the asset is assured beyond reasonable doubt. Future income tax benefits relating to tax losses are only brought to account when their realisation is virtually certain. The tax effects of capital losses are not recorded unless realisation is virtually certain.

 

(i) Accounting for acquisitions

 

Acquired businesses are accounted for on the basis of the cost method. Fair values are assigned at the date of acquisition to all the identifiable underlying assets acquired and to the liabilities assumed. Specific assessment is undertaken at the date of acquisition of any additional costs to be incurred.

 

Goodwill, representing the excess of the purchase consideration plus incidental costs over the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired on the acquisition of the business, is amortised to the statement of financial performance using the following criteria:

 

Goodwill Acquired


  

Write-Off Period


Up to $1.25m

   Written off over 5 years in equal instalments, but at a rate of not less than $250,000 pa

Over $1.25m

   Written off over 20 years on a straight line basis, but at a rate of not less than $250,000 pa

 

The unamortised balance of goodwill is reviewed at least annually. Where the balance exceeds the value of expected future benefits, the difference is charged to the statement of financial performance. For the purposes of this review process, goodwill is allocated to cash generating units (which equates to the consolidated entity’s reportable business units) upon acquisition. Acquired businesses can readily be allocated to one of the business units on the basis of product manufactured and/or marketed.

 

Acquisitions of assets

 

All assets acquired, including property, plant and equipment and intangibles other than goodwill, are initially recorded at their cost of acquisition at the date of acquisition, being the fair value of the consideration provided plus incidental costs directly attributable to the acquisition. Acquired in-process research and development is only recognised as a separate asset when future benefits are expected beyond any reasonable doubt to be recoverable.

 

Where settlement of any part of cash consideration is deferred, the amounts payable are recorded at their present value, discounted at the rate applicable to the consolidated entity if a similar borrowing were obtained from an independent financier under comparable terms and conditions. The unwinding of the discount is treated as interest expense.

 

The costs of assets constructed or internally generated by the consolidated entity, other than goodwill, include the cost of materials and direct labour. Directly attributable overheads and other incidental costs are also capitalised to the asset.

 

Borrowing costs are capitalised to qualifying assets as set out in Note 1(g).

 

Expenditure, including that on internally generated assets other than research and development costs, is only recognised as an asset when the entity controls future economic benefits as a result of the costs incurred that are probable and can be measured reliably. Costs attributable to feasibility and alternative approach assessments are expensed as incurred.

 

Subsequent additional costs

 

Costs incurred on assets subsequent to initial acquisition are capitalised when it is probable that future economic benefits in excess of the originally assessed performance of the asset will flow to the consolidated entity in future years, otherwise, expensed as incurred.

 

Research and development costs

 

Research and development expenditure is expensed as incurred.

 

151


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 1 Statement of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

(j) Use and revision of accounting estimates

 

The preparation of the financial report requires the making of estimates and assumptions that affect the recognised amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses and the disclosure of contingent liabilities. The estimates and associated assumptions are based on historical experience and various other factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis of making the judgements about carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates.

 

The estimates and underlying assumptions are viewed on an ongoing basis. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognised in the period in which the estimate is revised if the revision affects only that period, or in the period of the revision and future periods if the revision affects both current and future periods.

 

(k) Receivables - Note 8

 

The collectibility of debts is assessed at reporting date and specific provision is made for any doubtful accounts.

 

Trade debtors

 

Trade debtors to be settled within agreed terms are carried at amounts due.

 

(l) Inventories - Note 9

 

Raw materials and stores, work in progress and finished goods are carried at the lower of cost allocated and net realisable value.

 

Cost includes direct materials, direct labour, other direct variable costs and allocated production overheads necessary to bring inventories to their present location and condition, based on normal operating capacity of the production facilities.

 

Manufacturing activities

 

The cost of manufacturing inventories and work-in-progress are assigned on a first-in, first-out basis. Costs arising from exceptional wastage are expensed as incurred.

 

Net realisable value

 

Net realisable value is determined on the basis of each inventory line’s normal selling pattern. Expenses of marketing, selling and distribution to customers are estimated and are deducted to establish net realisable value.

 

(m) Investments - Note 11

 

Investments in controlled entities are carried in the financial statements of the consolidated entity at the lower of cost and recoverable amount.

 

(n) Leased assets

 

Leases under which the company assumes substantially all the risks and benefits of ownership are classified as finance leases. Other leases are classified as operating leases.

 

Operating leases

 

Payments made under operating leases are expensed on a straight line basis over the term of the lease, except where an alternative basis is more representative of the pattern of benefits to be derived from the leased property. Also refer to Note 23.

 

(o) Recoverable amount of non-current assets valued on cost basis

 

The carrying amount of non-current assets valued on the cost basis are reviewed to determine whether they are in excess of their recoverable amount at reporting date. If the carrying amount of a non-current asset exceeds its recoverable amount, the asset is written down to the lower amount. The write-down is expensed in the reporting period in which it occurs.

 

Where a group of assets working together supports the generation of cash inflows, recoverable amount is assessed in relation to that group of assets. In assessing recoverable amounts of non-current assets, the relevant cash flows have not been discounted to their present value.

 

152


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 1 Statement of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

(p) Depreciation and amortisation

 

Complex assets

 

The components of major assets that have materially different useful lives, are effectively accounted for as separate assets, and are separately depreciated.

 

Useful lives

 

All non-current assets have limited useful lives and are depreciated/amortised using the straight line method over their estimated useful lives.

 

Assets are depreciated or amortised from the date of acquisition or, in respect of internally constructed assets, from the time an asset is completed and held ready for use.

 

Depreciation and amortisation rates and methods are reviewed annually for appropriateness. When changes are made, adjustments are reflected prospectively in current and future periods only. Depreciation and amortisation are expensed, except to the extent that they are included in the carrying amount of another asset as an allocation of production overheads.

 

The depreciation/amortisation rates used for each class of asset are as follows:

 

     2004

    2003

    2002

 

Freehold buildings

   2.50 %   2.50 %   2.50 %

Leasehold buildings and improvements

   2.5%-40 %   2.5%-40 %   2.5%-40 %

Plant and equipment

   6.7%-33.33 %   6.7%-33.33 %   6.7%-33.33 %

Leased plant and equipment

   10%-20 %   10%-20 %   10%-20 %

 

(q) Payables - Note 14

 

Liabilities are recognised for amounts to be paid in the future for goods or services received. Trade accounts payable are settled within agreed terms.

 

(r) Interest bearing liabilities - Note 15

 

Bank loans are recognised at their principal amount, subject to set-off arrangements. Interest expense is accrued at the contracted rate.

 

Debentures, bills of exchange and notes payable are recognised when issued at the net proceeds received, with the premium or discount on issue amortised over the period of maturity. Interest expense is recognised on an effective yield basis.

 

(s) Employee benefits

 

Wages, salaries, annual leave, sick leave and non-monetary benefits

 

Liabilities for employee benefits for wages, salaries, annual leave and sick leave expected to be settled within 12 months of the year-end represent present obligations resulting from employees’ services provided up to the reporting date, calculated at undiscounted amounts based on remuneration wage and salary rates that the consolidated entity expects to pay as at reporting date including related on-costs. Related on-costs have been included in trade creditors.

 

Long service leave

 

The provision for employee benefits to long service leave represents the present value of the estimated future cash outflows to be made resulting from employees’ services provided to reporting date.

 

The provision is calculated using the expected future increases in wage and salary rates including related on-costs and expected settlement dates based on turnover history and is discounted using the rates attaching to national government bonds at reporting date which most closely match the terms of maturity of the related liabilities. The unwinding of the discount is treated as long service leave expense.

 

Superannuation plan

 

The partnership and its controlled entities contribute to various defined benefit and accumulation superannuation plans. Contributions are recognised as an expense as they are made. Further information is set out in Note 26.

 

(t) Provisions

 

A provision is recognised when there is a legal, equitable or constructive obligation as a result of a past event and it is probable that a future sacrifice of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation, the timing or amount of which is uncertain.

 

If the effect is material, a provision is determined by discounting the expected future cash flows (adjusted for expected future risks) required to settle the obligation at a pre tax rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the liability. The unwinding of the discount is treated as part of the expense related to the particular provision.

 

Restructuring and employee termination benefits

 

A provision for restructuring including termination benefits is only recognised when a detailed plan has been approved and the restructuring has either commenced or been publicly announced. Costs relating to ongoing activities are not provided for.

 

The liability for termination benefits are included in the provision for Rationalisation and restructure (Note 16).

 

153


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 1 Statement of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

(t) Provisions (continued)

 

Surplus leased premises

 

Provision is made for non-cancellable operating lease rentals payable on surplus leased premises when it is determined that no substantive future benefit will be obtained from its occupancy and sub-lease rentals are less.

 

The estimate is calculated based of discounted net future cash flows, using the interest rate implicit in the lease or an estimate thereof.

 

(u) Advertising

 

Under AGGAP, Advertising is generally expensed as the service is performed. Costs incurred under the consolidated entity’s cooperative advertising program with dealers and franchisees are recorded as reductions of sales as related revenues are recognised.

 

(v) Environmental remediation

 

The consolidated entity expenses environmental expenditures related to existing conditions resulting from past or current operations and from which no current or future benefit is discernible. South Pacific Tyres determines its liability on a site by site basis and records a liability at the time when it is probable and can be reasonably estimated.

 

Note 2 Change in accounting policy

 

Employee benefits

 

The consolidated entity has applied the revised AASB 1028 “Employee Benefits” for the first time from 1 July 2002.

 

The liability for wages and salaries, annual leave and sick leave is now calculated using the remuneration rates the consolidated entity expects to pay as at each reporting date, not wage and salary rates current at reporting date.

 

The initial adjustments to the consolidated financial report as at 1 July 2002 as a result of this change are:

 

    $103,373 increase in provision for employee benefits

 

    $103,373 decrease in opening retained earnings.

 

As a result of this change in accounting policy, employee benefits expense increased by $139,957 and the income tax expense decreased by $2,222 for the year to 30 June 2003.

 

 

    

2004

$


  

2003

$


  

2002

$


Note 3 Revenue from ordinary activities

              

Sale of goods revenue from operating activities

   763,609,409    737,027,575    769,790,943

Rendering of services revenue from operating activities

   55,127,229    56,569,421    59,595,043

Other revenue from operating activities

              

Interest:

              

Associated entities

   27,693    814,052    1,828,580

Other parties

   1,132,553    1,121,245    1,861,026

Revenues from outside operating activities

              

Gross proceeds from sale of non-current assets

   5,342,999    4,472,613    3,926,091
    
  
  

Total other revenue

   6,503,245    6,407,910    7,615,697
    
  
  

Total revenue from ordinary activities

   825,239,883    800,004,906    837,001,683
    
  
  

 

154


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Note 4 Profit from ordinary activities before income tax expense

                  
(a) Individually significant expenses/(revenues) included in profit from ordinary activities before income tax expense                   

Closure of Footscray & Thomastown tyre factories

   9,458,682     3,927,911     94,900,000  

Closure of BA Hamill

   —       (1,769,227 )   2,900,000  

Retail store restructure programme

   —       928,524     1,924,813  

Reverse Radial truck factory plant & equipment storage and removal provision

   (1,967,197 )   —       —    

Closure of radial truck tyre factory

   —       —       (3,516,017 )

Norhead dispute settlement

   —       2,565,442     1,500,000  

Retreading plant closures

   513,743     —       —    

Somerton factory plant & equipment stocktake loss

   4,036,631     —       —    

Write down of Thomastown / Footscray properties to recoverable amount

   2,219,064     —       —    

Activity alignment

   —       —       (4,600,437 )

Superannuation shortfall defecit / (gain) accrual

   (2,470,000 )   4,100,000     —    
    

 

 

     11,790,923     9,752,650     93,108,359  
    

 

 

(b) Profit from ordinary activities before income tax expense has been arrived at after charging/(crediting) the following items:                   

Cost of goods sold

   591,739,184     587,501,675     647,665,319  

Write-down of Property, Plant & Equipment to recoverable amount

   2,219,064     —       —    

Relates to Footscray and Thomastown tyre plants. Fair value determined by registered valuer, Knight Frank, in 2004.

                  

Depreciation of:

                  

Buildings

   251,849     175,527     104,319  

Plant and equipment

   21,894,326     19,469,383     26,628,428  
    

 

 

     22,146,175     19,644,910     26,732,747  
    

 

 

Amortisation of:

                  

Leasehold land and buildings

   1,158,908     1,076,008     1,315,525  

Goodwill

   297,389     287,389     485,062  
    

 

 

     1,456,297     1,363,397     1,800,587  
    

 

 

Total depreciation and amortisation

   23,602,472     21,008,307     28,533,334  
    

 

 

Borrowing costs

                  

Associated entities

   8,904,264     5,816,482     3,164,641  

Bank loans and overdrafts

   13,033,678     12,017,621     10,495,907  
    

 

 

Total borrowing costs

   21,937,942     17,834,103     13,660,548  
    

 

 

 

155


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Note 4 Profit from ordinary activities before income tax expense (continued)

                  

(b) Profit from ordinary activities before income tax has been arrived at after

charging/(crediting) the following items: (continued)

                  

Research and development expenditure

                  

Expensed as incurred

   1,573,420     2,849,443     1,938,620  

Net bad and doubtful debts expense including movements in provision for doubtful debts

   624,867     619,922     1,487,774  

Net expense for movements in provision for:

                  

Employee entitlements

   23,330,487     18,361,047     83,347,032  

Rationalisation and restructuring costs

   2,162,833     2,565,422     91,183,546  

Rebates and allowances

   27,265,039     19,542,569     19,979,619  

Net foreign exchange (gain)/loss:

                  

Borrowings

   165,022     (8,205 )   (13,907 )

Net loss on disposal / writedown of non-current assets:

                  

Property, plant and equipment

   6,134,607     7,721,228     13,327,002  

Investments

   —       —       625,815  

Operating lease rental expense

                  

Minimum lease payments

   30,522,660     30,138,477     31,589,141  

Note 5 Auditors’ remuneration

                  

Audit services

                  

Auditors of the company - KPMG Australia

   312,437     330,000     388,622  

For other services

                  

Auditors of the company - KPMG Australia

   3,901     —       2,550  

Note 6 Taxation

                  

(a) Income tax expense

                  

Prima facie income tax expense/(benefit) calculated at 30% (2003 : 30%) (2002 : 30%)

on the profit/(loss) from ordinary activities

   (5,583,485 )   (10,606,784 )   (43,081,846 )

Increase in income tax expense due to:

                  

Depreciation on buildings

   68,953     65,465     61,316  

Amortisation of goodwill

   89,217     86,217     145,519  

Thin Capitalisation

   1,033,514     401,549     —    

Entertainment

   322,092     213,606     196,069  

Sundry items

   412,945     84,401     219,335  

Decrease in income tax expense due to:

                  

Effects of lower/higher rates of tax on overseas income

   —       —       157  

Tax at standard rate on consolidated entity profits attributed to partners

   (7,679,125 )   (13,350,470 )   (29,039,039 )

Income tax expense/(benefit) on operating profit/(loss) before individually significant income tax items

   4,022,361     3,594,924     (13,420,725 )

Add: Income tax under/(over) provided in prior year

   (152,677 )   612,913     (158,728 )
    

 

 

Income tax expense/(benefit) attributable to operating profit

   3,869,684     4,207,837     (13,579,453 )
    

 

 

Income tax expense/(benefit) attributable to operating profit is made up of:

                  

Current income tax provision

   4,633,950     2,057,845     (11,560,219 )

Under/(over) provision in prior year

   (152,677 )   612,913     (158,728 )

Future income tax benefit

   (611,589 )   1,537,079     (1,860,506 )
    

 

 

     3,869,684     4,207,837     (13,579,453 )
    

 

 

 

 

156


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Note  6 Taxation (continued)

                  

(b) Current tax liabilities

                  

Provision for current income tax

                  

Movements during the year:

                  

Balance at beginning of year

   135,944     58,887     167,096  

Income tax (paid)/received

   —       79,774     (112,184 )

Under /(over) provision in prior year

   539     635,755     (72,516 )

Current year’s income tax expense/(benefit) on operating loss

   4,633,949     2,057,845     (11,560,219 )

Disposal of controlled entity

   —       —       78,048  

Tax loss transferred to FITB

   (4,479,623 )   (2,696,317 )   11,558,662  
    

 

 

     290,809     135,944     58,887  
    

 

 

(c) Deferred tax assets

                  

Future income tax benefit

                  
Future income tax benefit comprises the estimated future benefit at the applicable rate of 30% (2003 : 30%, 2002 : 30%) on the following items:                   

Accumulated non-allowable provisions

   5,761,608     4,979,376     6,499,991  

Accumulated tax losses

   8,755,145     13,252,196     15,941,336  
    

 

 

     14,516,753     18,231,572     22,441,327  
    

 

 

 

The tax effect of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the future income tax benefit are presented below:

 

Trading stock adjustments

   166,306     36,887     30,409  

Depreciation on property, plant and equipment

   (1,586,941 )   (2,018,708 )   (2,132,392 )

Provisions

   6,892,310     6,931,368     8,533,692  

Accruals

   237,699     160,408     251,990  

Accumulated tax losses

   8,755,145     13,252,196     15,941,336  

Other

   52,234     (130,579 )   (183,708 )
    

 

 

     14,516,753     18,231,572     22,441,327  
    

 

 

 

An amount of $48,389,177 of taxable income must be earned to allow for the realisation of the deferred tax assets in the foreseeable future. The combined taxable income of Tyre Marketers (Australia) Limited and SACRT Trading Pty Ltd in 2004 was $16,687,301 (2003 $6,919,370) and (2002 $36,556,061 loss). In the opinion of the directors of the consolidated entity, it is virtually certain that the results of future operations will generate sufficient taxable income to realise the deferred tax assets.

 

The consolidated entity has unrecognised capital tax losses of $21,271,173 in 2004 (2003 $22,081,014) and (2002 $22,817,537).

 

As a consequence of the substantive enactment of the Tax Consolidation legislation and since the consolidated entity had not notified the Australian Tax Office at the date of signing this report of the implementation date for the tax consolidation, the consolidated entity has applied UIG39 “Effects of Proposed Tax Consolidation Legislation on Deferred Tax Balances”. There was no impact on the consolidated entity’s future income tax benefits, as at 30 June 2004.

 

157


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Note 7 Cash assets

                  

Cash

   56,435,875     5,629,939     8,400,672  
Bank short term deposits, maturing daily and paying interest at a weighted average interest rate of 4.7 % (2003 : 4.5%) (2002 : 4.7% )    —       9,600,000     28,700,000  
    

 

 

     56,435,875     15,229,939     37,100,672  
    

 

 

Note 8 Receivables

                  

Current

                  

Gross debtors

   127,149,457     132,004,740     138,762,403  

Less : Provision for doubtful trade debtors

   (1,730,468 )   (2,655,040 )   (3,050,317 )
    

 

 

     125,418,989     129,349,700     135,712,086  

Other debtors

   4,755,891     8,091,930     5,945,571  
    

 

 

     130,174,880     137,441,630     141,657,657  

Non-current

                  

Other debtors

   1,651,270     9,546,303     30,384,952  
    

 

 

     131,826,150     146,987,933     172,042,609  
    

 

 

Other debtor amounts generally arise from transactions outside the usual operating activity of the consolidated entity.  

Note 9 Inventories

                  

Current

                  

Raw materials and stores at cost

   8,406,434     11,548,888     10,302,933  

Less : Provision for stock obsolescence

   (56,185 )   (462,697 )   (490,527 )
    

 

 

Raw materials and stores at net realisable value

   8,350,249     11,086,191     9,812,406  
    

 

 

Work in progress at cost

   5,024,033     7,779,196     4,950,537  

Less : Provision for stock obsolescence

   —       —       (70,301 )
    

 

 

Work in progress at net realisable value

   5,024,033     7,779,196     4,880,236  
    

 

 

Finished goods at cost

   132,113,591     138,819,804     142,658,001  

Less : Provision for stock obsolescence

   (853,652 )   (889,531 )   (1,816,842 )
    

 

 

Finished goods at net realisable value

   131,259,939     137,930,273     140,841,159  
    

 

 

Other stocks at cost

   3,215,229     6,519,272     6,390,959  

Less : Provision for stock obsolescence

   (438,257 )   (1,282,795 )   (1,182,795 )
    

 

 

Other stocks at net realisable value

   2,776,972     5,236,477     5,208,164  
    

 

 

     147,411,193     162,032,137     160,741,965  
    

 

 

Note 10 Other current assets

                  

Prepayments

   3,219,753     3,323,269     2,258,575  
    

 

 

Note 11 Other financial assets

                  

Non-current

                  

Investments in controlled entities

                  

Unlisted shares at cost

   —       —       —    
    

 

 

     —       —       —    
    

 

 

 

158


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Note 12 Property, plant and equipment

                  

Freehold land

                  

At cost

   2,508,947     3,350,000     3,350,000  
    

 

 

     2,508,947     3,350,000     3,350,000  
    

 

 

Freehold buildings

                  

At cost

   10,769,845     11,886,348     11,841,455  

Accumulated depreciation

   (1,275,597 )   (1,184,367 )   (1,008,840 )
    

 

 

     9,494,248     10,701,981     10,832,615  
    

 

 

Leasehold land and buildings

                  

At cost

   34,438,146     57,165,525     57,096,991  

Accumulated amortisation

   (6,779,839 )   (7,366,006 )   (6,667,761 )
    

 

 

     27,658,307     49,799,519     50,429,230  

Held for sale at recoverable amount

   19,104,877     —       —    
    

 

 

     46,763,184     49,799,519     50,429,230  
    

 

 

Plant and equipment

                  

At cost

   346,754,924     357,168,327     369,419,397  

Accumulated depreciation

   (211,578,026 )   (227,312,706 )   (242,149,279 )
    

 

 

     135,176,898     129,855,621     127,270,118  

Held for sale at recoverable amount

   145,123     —       —    
    

 

 

     135,322,021     129,855,621     127,270,118  
    

 

 

Buildings and plant under construction

                  

At cost

   3,735,276     24,717,907     10,945,130  
    

 

 

Total property, plant and equipment net book value

   197,823,676     218,425,028     202,827,093  
    

 

 

Assets held for sale relate to Footscray tyre plant closed in December 2001 and Thomastown tyre plant closed in July 2002.  

Reconciliations

                  
Reconciliations of the carrying amounts for each class of property, plant and equipment are set out below:                   

Freehold land

                  

Carrying amount at the beginning of year

   3,350,000     3,350,000     3,350,000  

Disposals

   (841,053 )   —       —    
    

 

 

Carrying amount at the end of year

   2,508,947     3,350,000     3,350,000  
    

 

 

Buildings

                  

Carrying amount at the beginning of year

   10,701,981     10,832,615     11,539,044  

Currency conversion

   —       —       (101,481 )

Additions

   —       —       11,706  

Transfer from capital works in progress

   12,543     44,893     30,818  

Disposal of businesses / subsidiary (net)

   —       —       (543,153 )

Disposals

   (968,427 )   —       —    

Depreciation

   (251,849 )   (175,527 )   (104,319 )
    

 

 

Carrying amount at the end of year

   9,494,248     10,701,981     10,832,615  
    

 

 

 

159


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Note 12 Property, plant and equipment (continued)

                  

Leasehold land and buildings

                  
Carrying amount at the beginning of year    49,799,519     50,429,230     51,725,245  

Transfer from capital works in progress

   344,534     458,306     39,515  

Disposals

   (2,221,960 )   (12,009 )   (20,005 )

Depreciation

   (1,158,909 )   (1,076,008 )   (1,315,525 )
    

 

 

Carrying amount at the end of year

   46,763,184     49,799,519     50,429,230  
    

 

 

Plant and equipment

                  
Carrying amount at the beginning of year    129,855,621     127,270,118     151,296,771  

Currency conversion

   —       —       (31,013 )

Acquired businesses/subsidiaries

   —       —       458,033  

Additions

   189,115     11,306     188,971  

Transfer from capital works in progress

   36,562,647     34,225,413     15,784,417  

Disposals

   (9,391,035 )   (12,181,833 )   (13,639,725 )

Disposal of businesses / subsidiary (net)

   —       —       (158,909 )

Depreciation

   (21,894,327 )   (19,469,383 )   (26,628,427 )
    

 

 

Carrying amount at the end of year

   135,322,021     129,855,621     127,270,118  
    

 

 

Capital works in progress

                  
Carrying amount at the beginning of year    24,717,907     10,945,130     14,837,434  

Acquired businesses/subsidiaries

   —       —       458,033  

Additions

   16,090,754     48,501,389     14,549,558  

Transfer to property, plant and equipment

   (36,919,723 )   (34,728,612 )   (16,312,783 )

Other disposals

   (153,662 )   —       (2,587,112 )
    

 

 

Carrying amount at the end of year

   3,735,276     24,717,907     10,945,130  
    

 

 

Note 13 Intangibles

                  
Goodwill - at cost    5,847,772     7,268,104     7,768,104  

Accumulated amortisation

   (1,348,820 )   (2,351,230 )   (2,563,842 )
    

 

 

     4,498,952     4,916,874     5,204,262  
    

 

 

The consolidated entity estimates that the annual amortisation expense related to intangible assets will be $287,388 during each of the next 5 years and the weighted average remaining amortisation period is approximately 14 years.   

Note 14 Payables

                  

Current

                  
Trade creditors    108,050,790     115,985,030     117,076,110  

Accrued liabilities

   35,797,893     41,841,676     43,903,827  

Other creditors

   179,723     2,127,124     802,781  
    

 

 

Total Current

   144,028,406     159,953,830     161,782,718  
    

 

 

Non-current

                  
Trade creditors    704,179     752,291     871,199  

Other creditors

   —       7,234,668     27,620,616  
    

 

 

Total Non Current

   704,179     7,986,959     28,491,815  
    

 

 

Total Payables

   144,732,585     167,940,789     190,274,533  
    

 

 

 

160


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


  

2003

$


  

2002

$


Note 15 Interest bearing liabilities

              

Current

              
Bank overdrafts - secured    783,427    —      —  

Bank overdrafts - unsecured

   —      690,488    1,002,808

Bank loans - secured

   77,638,119    —      —  

Bank loans - unsecured

   —      95,833,119    65,897,645

Goodyear Australia Pty Ltd loans

   35,033,668    —      —  

Securitisation

   75,029,449    74,890,227    75,494,759
    
  
  

Total Current

   188,484,663    171,413,834    142,395,212
    
  
  

Non-current

              
Partner Loan - Pacific Dunlop Tyres Pty Ltd    62,853,754    55,548,722    30,547,507

Partner Loan - Goodyear Tyres Pty Ltd

   62,853,754    55,548,722    30,547,507
    
  
  

Total Non Current

   125,707,508    111,097,444    61,095,014
    
  
  

Total Interest bearing liabilities

   314,192,171    282,511,278    203,490,226
    
  
  

 

Partner Loans - Pacific Dunlop Tyres Pty Ltd & Goodyear Tyres Pty Ltd

 

On 19 October, 2001, the partners in South Pacific Tyres (SPT) signed an agreement setting forth a plan to restructure certain operations of the consolidated entity, details of which are set forth in two agreements - the Australian Deed and the Co-ordination Deed (the “Agreements.”) The Agreements require the partners to advance (in one or more tranches) up to $56.3 million to the consolidated entity. As of 30 June, 2004, the amounts due to each partner (including principal and interest) were $62.9 million compared to $55.5 million at 30 June, 2003. The increase from 30 June, 2003 is primarily due to the receipt of the final tranche of $3.8 million from each partner. Interest on the outstanding portion of the loan which is compounded and calculated at 90 day intervals based on the 90 day bank bill rate plus a margin of 0.6% per annum.

 

Also included in the Agreements, is a put and call option giving the partners the right to acquire from the other partner, that partner’s interest in the partnership. The earliest date this provision can be exercised is 15 August, 2005 (the “put option date”) by Pacific Dunlop Tyres Pty Ltd (“PDL.”) Beginning with the put option date, PDL has twelve months during which they may exercise their put option. At the end of this twelve month period, Goodyear Tyres Pty Ltd will have the right to exercise their call option during the subsequent six month period.

 

The loans mature at the earlier of:

 

PDL exercising the put option (no earlier than August 2005);

 

the tenth anniversary of the Agreements (October 2011); and

 

the dissolution of the partnership (not expected.)

 

Bank Loans

 

Pacific Dunlop Tyres Pty Ltd and Goodyear Tyres Pty Ltd (together comprising the SPT partnership in Australia) along with SPT’s Australian controlled entities, are borrowers under bank facilities (the “Facilities”) provided by a group of banks referred to as the “Lenders.” At 30 June, 2004, the Facilities provided for borrowings of up to $79.7 million of which, $2.4 million was unused. In August 2003, the unsecured bank facilities were renewed for one year and restructured to reduce their size and to provide security to the Lenders by way of a fixed and floating charge over certain assets. Secured bank loans and overdrafts rank ahead in priority order of other interest bearing liabilities. Also in August 2004, a guarantee was provided by The Goodyear Tire & Rubber Company (U.S.)

 

Interest on the facilities is calculated using the bank bill rate in effect at the time of borrowing plus a margin of up to 1.8% depending on the type of advance. The borrowers must also pay a fee equal to 3.00% per annum on the facility limit regardless of utilization.

 

In addition to providing cash advances, the Facilities may be used for other purposes including borrowings relating to trade finance (such as bid/performance bonds and shipping guarantees), performance and financial guarantees, leasing, business credit cards, and payroll electronic payment requirements.

 

Accounts Receivable Financing

 

During November 2001, the consolidated entity entered into an agreement with a major financial institution in relation to the securitisation of trade receivables. Under this arrangement, eligible receivables are transferred to a SPT Trust Special Purpose Vehicle (SPV) in return for cash and a “subordinated loan amount.” The SPV is managed by one of the bank facility lenders. Interest on the facility is calculated using the one month bank bill rate (determined each monthly settlement date) plus a margin. This facility must be renewed on 2 November, 2006.

 

161


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 
Note 15 Interest bearing liabilities (continued)                   

Financing arrangements

                  

The consolidated entity has access to the following lines of credit:

                  

Total facilities available:

                  

Bank overdrafts

   2,000,000     6,500,000     6,500,000  

Bank loans

   71,650,000     90,000,000     105,500,000  

Trade bills

   6,000,000     6,000,000     6,000,000  
    

 

 

     79,650,000     102,500,000     118,000,000  
    

 

 

Facilities utilised at balance date:

                  

Bank overdrafts

   743,773     574,845     1,012,585  

Bank loans

   71,650,000     90,000,000     63,500,000  

Trade bills

   4,859,813     5,589,308     2,247,952  
    

 

 

     77,253,586     96,164,153     66,760,537  
    

 

 

Facilities not utilised at balance date:

                  

Bank overdrafts

   1,256,227     5,925,155     5,487,415  

Bank loans

   —       —       42,000,000  

Trade bills

   1,140,187     410,692     3,752,048  
    

 

 

     2,396,414     6,335,847     51,239,463  
    

 

 

Interest on bank overdrafts is charged at prevailing market rates. The effective interest rates for all overdrafts as at 30 June 2004 is 8.6 % (2003 :8.6%) (2002 : 8.6%).   
All bank loans are denominated in Australian dollars. The bank loans amount in current liabilities comprises the portion of the consolidated entitiy’s bank loan payable within one year. The effective interest rate on bank loans is 8.65% (2003 : 8.34%) (2002 : 6.56%)    
The effective interest rate on trade bills is 8.15% (2003 : 5.66%) (2002 : 5.32%).  
At 30 June 2002 the consolidated entity had committed lines of bank loans of $105,500,000 up to 1 December 2002.  
At 30 June 2002 $42,000,000 of the lines were undrawn. An annual commitment fee of 0.5% to 0.9% was paid.  
Note 16 Provisions                   
Current                   

Employee entitlements

   33,143,515     30,803,805     35,447,716  

Rationalisation and restructuring

   13,995,281     16,981,066     60,411,626  

Rebates

   7,179,476     5,580,819     6,978,516  
    

 

 

     54,318,272     53,365,690     102,837,858  
    

 

 

Non-current

                  

Employee entitlements

   6,357,177     6,883,413     7,978,203  
    

 

 

     6,357,177     6,883,413     7,978,203  
    

 

 

Reconciliations                   
Reconciliations of the carrying amounts of each class of provision, except for employee benefits are set out below.  
To maintain competitiveness, the consolidated entity has implemented rationalisation actions over the past several years for the purpose of reducing excess capacity, improving productivity and reducing costs. The net amounts of rationalisation charges to the Statement of Financial Performance were as follows:    

Rationalisation and restructuring

                  

Carrying amount at beginning of year

   16,981,066     60,411,626     14,084,483  

Provisions made during the year

   2,162,833     2,565,442     91,183,546  

Provision utilised by loss on disposal / scrappings of assets

   —       (8,475,000 )   (13,100,000 )

Payments made during the period

   (5,148,618 )   (37,521,002 )   (31,756,403 )
    

 

 

Carrying amount at end of year

   13,995,281     16,981,066     60,411,626  
    

 

 

 

162


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 
Note 16 Provisions                   
In fiscal year 2000 and 2001, a rationalisation program was undertaken by the consolidated entity to close the tyre plants in Thomastown and Footscray, the MRT plant in Somerton and the BA Hamill engineering workshop for the purpose of reducing excess capacity, improving productivity and reducing costs. Rationalisation expense for this plan was $50.6 million, $91.2 million, $2.6 million, and $2.2 million in 2001, 2002, 2003 and 2004 respectively and was charged to significant items in the statement of financial performance.      
The number of people planned to be terminated at the MRT site at Somerton was 525. The actual number of people terminated was 519, all of whom were manufacturing related employees. The number of people planned to be terminated at the Thomastown, Footscray and BA Hamill sites was 868. The actual number of people terminated was 871, 799 of whom were manufacturing and 72 of whom were administrative. At 30 June, 2004 there was a plan to close two tyre retreading plants at North Albury and Tamworth in July 2004. The planned number of people terminating is 6 people.      
Net Charges in 2004 of $2.2 million consisted of $3.6 million for environmental remediation of the Thomastown and Footscray tyre plants, $0.5 million for retreading plant closures and $(1.9) million reversal of provision made for storage, dismantling and packaging of plant and equipment at the MRT Plant at Somerton. In 2004, $5.1 million was incurred which comprised $3.6 million for settlement of contractual dispute with customer (Norhead) and $1.5 million for environmental remediation at Thomastown & Footscray.      
Net Charges in 2003 of $2.6 million related to settlement of contractual dispute with customer (Norhead). In 2003, $37.5 million was incurred which comprised $35.4 million of associate redundancy payments for employees at the Thomastown, Footscray and BA Hamill sites, $0.5 million for environmental remediation at Thomastown and Footscray, $0.5 million for settlement of contractual dispute with customer (Norhead) and $1.1 million for storage, dismantling and packaging costs of equipment at the MRT Plant at Somerton.      
Net Charges in 2002 of $91.2 million consisted $66.3 million for associate redundancy payments for associates at the Thomastown, Footscray and BA Hamill sites, $9.9 million for environmental remediation at the Thomastown and Footscray tyre plants, $21.6 million for plant and equipment write off at the Thomastown, Footscray and BA Hamill sites, $1.5 million for settlement of contractual dispute with customer (Norhead), $(1.5) million reversal of provision made for preparation of the land and buildings at the MRT site at Somerton for sale, $(4.0) million reversal of provision made for activity alignment redundancy plan and $(2.6) million reversal of provision of redundancy for closure of the MRT Plant at Somerton. In 2002, $31.8 million was incurred which comprised $9.3 million of associate redundancy payments for employees at the Thomastown, Footscray and BA Hamill sites, $0.2 million for the activity alignment redundancy plan, $0.4 million for associate redundancy payments at the MRT Plant at Somerton, $1.6 million for business interruption expenditure and $0.3 million for storage, dismantling and packaging of plant and equipment at the MRT Plant at Somerton.           
The provision at 30 June, 2004 was $13,995,281, which included $1,996,622 for the future costs of storage, dismantling and packaging of plant & equipment at the MRT plant in Somerton, $11,484,916 for environmental remediation and $513,743 for the closure of the North Albury and Tamworth Retreading plants.    

Rebates

                  

Carrying amount at beginning of year

   5,580,819     6,978,516     6,236,155  

Provisions made during the year

   27,265,039     19,542,569     19,979,619  

Payments made during the period

   (25,666,382 )   (20,940,266 )   (19,237,258 )
    

 

 

Carrying amount at end of year

   7,179,476     5,580,819     6,978,516  
    

 

 

Number of employees

   3,063     3,133     3,730  

 

163


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


  

2002

$


 
Note 17 Amounts payable/receivable in foreign currencies                  
The Australian dollar equivalents of unhedged amounts payable or receivable in foreign currencies, calculated at year-end exchange rates, are as follows:                  

United states dollars

                 

Amounts payable :

                 

Current

   779,816     872,599    1,382,011  

Japanese Yen

                 

Amounts payable :

                 

Current

   —       —      1,432,379  

Euro dollar

                 

Amounts payable :

                 

Current

   764,127     435,439    195,889  
    

 
  

Total

   1,543,943     1,308,038    3,010,279  
    

 
  

Note 18 Contributed equity                  

Goodyear Tyres Pty Ltd

                 

Contributed equity at the beginning of year

   158,837,569     158,837,569    158,837,569  

Additional contributed equity

   13,000     —      —    
    

 
  

Contributed equity at the end of year

   158,850,569     158,837,569    158,837,569  
    

 
  

Pacific Dunlop Tyres Pty Ltd

                 

Contributed equity at the beginning of year

   158,837,569     158,837,569    158,837,569  
    

 
  

Contributed equity at the end of year

   158,837,569     158,837,569    158,837,569  
    

 
  

     317,688,138     317,675,138    317,675,138  
    

 
  

Note 19 Reserves                  

Asset revaluation

   12,374,551     12,570,229    12,570,229  
    

 
  

     12,374,551     12,570,229    12,570,229  
    

 
  

Movements during the year                  

Asset revaluation reserve

                 

Balance at the beginning of year

   12,570,229     12,570,229    12,561,891  

Transferred to retained profits

   (195,678 )   —      8,338  
    

 
  

Balance at the end of year

   12,374,551     12,570,229    12,570,229  
    

 
  

Foreign currency translation reserve

                 

Balance at the beginning of year

   —       —      (3,341,868 )

Translation adjustment on assets and liabilities held in foreign currencies

   —       —      (303,980 )

Transferred to retained profits

   —       —      3,645,848  
    

 
  

Balance at the end of year

   —       —      —    
    

 
  

 

Nature and purpose of reserves

 

Asset revaluation

 

The asset revaluation reserve includes the net revaluation increments and decrements arising from the revaluation of non-current assets measured at fair value in accordance with AASB1041.

 

Foreign currency reserve

 

The foreign currency translation reserve records the foreign currency differences arising from the translation of self-sustaining foreign operations, the translation of transactions that hedge the Entity’s net investment in a foreign operation or the translation of foreign currency monetary items forming part of the net investment in a self-sustaining operation. Refer to accounting policy Note 1(e).

 

164


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Note 20 Accumulated Losses

                  

Goodyear Tyres Pty Ltd

                  

Accumulated losses at the beginning of year

   (136,469,457 )   (116,635,878 )   (49,795,200 )

Net loss attributable to partners

   (11,240,650 )   (19,781,893 )   (65,013,585 )

Amounts transferred from reserves

   97,839     —       (1,827,093 )

Net effect of initial adoption of Revised AASB 1028 “Employee Benefits”

   —       (51,686 )   —    
    

 

 

Accumulated losses at the end of year

   (147,612,268 )   (136,469,457 )   (116,635,878 )
    

 

 

Pacific Dunlop Tyres Pty Ltd

                  

Accumulated losses at the beginning of year

   (135,466,272 )   (115,632,693 )   (48,792,015 )

Net loss attributable to partners

   (11,240,650 )   (19,781,892 )   (65,013,585 )

Amounts transferred from reserves

   97,839     —       (1,827,093 )

Net effect of initial adoption of Revised AASB 1028 “Employee Benefits”

   —       (51,687 )   —    
    

 

 

Accumulated losses at the end of year

   (146,609,083 )   (135,466,272 )   (115,632,693 )
    

 

 

     (294,221,351 )   (271,935,729 )   (232,268,571 )
    

 

 

The consolidated entity’s ability to pay dividends is restricted by credit facility agreements.

                  

Note 21 Outside equity interest

                  

Outside equity interest in controlled entities comprise:

                  

Interest in retained profits at the beginning of the financial year after adjusting for outside equity interests in entities

   —       —       1,034,550  

Interest in operating profit after income tax

   —       —       470  

Interest in dividends provided for or paid

   —       —       (2,146 )

Disposal of Interest in Retained Profits

   —       —       (1,032,874 )
    

 

 

Interest in retained profits at the end of the financial year

   —       —       —    

Interest in share capital

   —       —       —    

Interest in reserves

   —       —       —    
    

 

 

Total outside equity interest

   —       —       —    
    

 

 

 

165


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 22 Additional financial instruments disclosure

 

(a) Interest rate risk

 

The consolidated entity enters into interest rate swaps to manage cash flow risks associated with the floating interest rates on borrowings.

 

Interest rate swaps and forward rate agreements

 

Interest rate swaps allow the consolidated entity to swap floating rate borrowings into fixed rates. Maturities of swap contracts are principally between one to five years.

 

Each contract involves quarterly payment or receipt of the net amount of interest. At 30 June 2004 the fixed rates were 5.9% (2003 : 5.7% to 5.9%) (2002 : 5.5% to 5.9%) and floating rates were at bank bill rates plus the consolidated entity’s credit margin. The weighted average effective floating interest rate at 30 June 2004 was 5.9% (2003 : 5.8%) (2002 : 5.7%).

 

Interest rate risk exposures

 

The consolidated entity’s exposure to interest rate risk and the effective weighted average interest rate for classes of financial assets and financial liabilities is set out below:

 

     Fixed interest maturity in:

2004


   Note

  

Weighted
average
interest

rate


   

Floating

interest

rate


   

1 year

or less


  

Over

1 year to

years


  

More

than

5 years


  

Non-

interest

bearing


   Total

Financial assets

                                         

Cash

   7    4.74 %   56,343,803                    92,072    56,435,875

Receivables

   8    —                            131,826,150    131,826,150
               

                
  
                56,343,803                    131,918,222    188,262,025
               

                
  

Financial liabilities

                                         

Bank overdrafts and loans

   15    8.65 %   73,561,733                         73,561,733

Securitisation

   15    5.60 %   75,029,449                         75,029,449

Partner Loans

   15    6.31 %   160,741,176                         160,741,176

Trade bills

   15    8.15 %   4,859,813                         4,859,813

Accounts payable

   14                               144,732,585    144,732,585

Employee entitlements

   16    0.00 %         33,143,515    3,378,237    2,978,940         39,500,692
               

 
  
  
  
  
                314,192,171     33,143,515    3,378,237    2,978,940    144,732,585    498,425,448
               

 
  
  
  
  

Interest rate swaps

              (20,000,000 )   20,000,000                    
               

 
                   

2003


                                         

Financial assets

                                         

Cash

   7    4.51 %   15,133,917                    96,022    15,229,939

Receivables

   8    —                            146,987,933    146,987,933
               

                
  
                15,133,917                    147,083,955    162,217,872
               

                
  

Financial liabilities

                                         

Bank overdrafts and loans

   15    8.27 %   90,934,299                         90,934,299

Securitisation

   15    4.88 %   74,890,227                         74,890,227

Partner Loans

   15    5.35 %   111,097,444                         111,097,444

Trade bills

   15    5.66 %   5,589,308                         5,589,308

Accounts payable

   14                               167,940,789    167,940,789

Employee entitlements

   16    1.30 %         30,803,805    3,177,964    3,705,449         37,687,218
               

 
  
  
  
  
                282,511,278     30,803,805    3,177,964    3,705,449    167,940,789    488,139,285
               

 
  
  
  
  

Interest rate swaps

              (50,000,000 )   30,000,000    20,000,000               
               

 
  
              

 

166


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 22 Additional financial instruments disclosure (continued)

 

(a) Interest rate risk (continued)

 

Fixed interest maturity in:

 

2002


   Note

  

Weighted

average

interest

rate


   

Floating

interest

rate


   

1 year

or less


  

Over

1 year to

5 years


  

More

than 5

years


  

Non-

Interest

bearing


   Total

Financial assets

                                         

Cash

   7    4.70 %   37,092,372                    8,300    37,100,672

Receivables

   8    —                            172,042,609    172,042,609
               

                
  
                37,092,372                    172,050,909    209,143,281
               

                
  

Financial liabilities

                                         
                                           

Bank overdrafts and loans

   15    6.59 %   64,652,501                         64,652,501

Securitisation

   15    5.06 %   75,494,759                         75,494,759

Partner Loans

   15    5.46 %   61,095,014                         61,095,014

Trade bills

   15    5.32 %   2,247,952                         2,247,952

Accounts payable

   14                               190,274,533    190,274,533

Employee entitlements

   16    2.00 %         35,447,716    4,278,361    3,699,842         43,425,919
               

 
  
  
  
  
                203,490,226     35,447,716    4,278,361    3,699,842    190,274,533    437,190,678
               

 
  
  
  
  

Interest rate swaps

              (50,000,000 )   20,000,000    30,000,000               
               

 
  
              

 

(b) Foreign exchange risk

 

The consolidated entity enters into forward foreign exchange contracts to hedge foreign currency purchases expected in each month within the following six months within Board approval limits. The amount of anticipated future purchases and sales are forecast in light of current conditions in foreign markets, commitments from customers and experience.

 

The following table sets out the gross value to be received under foreign currency contracts, the weighted average contracted exchange rates and the settlement periods of outstanding contracts for the consolidated entity.

 

     2004

   2003

   2002

   2004
$


   2003
$


   2002
$


          Average rate                    

Buy US Dollars

                             

Not later than one year

   0.7029    0.63    0.56    17,860,867    26,558,702    43,978

Later than one year but not later than two years

                  —      —      —  

Later than two year but not later than three years

                  —      —      —  
                   
  
  
                    17,860,867    26,558,702    43,978
                   
  
  

Sell US Dollars

                             

Not later than one year

   0.7155    0.64    —      1,623,900    814,196    —  

Later than one year but not later than two years

                  —      —      —  

Later than two year but not later than three years

                  —      —      —  
                   
  
  
                    1,623,900    814,196    —  
                   
  
  

Buy EURO dollars

                             

Not later than one year

   0.59    0.55    0.60    5,693,338    9,937,775    1,096,037

Later than one year but not later than two years

                  —      —      —  

Later than two year but not later than three years

                  —      —      —  
                   
  
  
                    5,693,338    9,937,775    1,096,037
                   
  
  

Sell EURO dollars

                             

Not later than one year

   0.61    0.55    —      18,245    179,783    —  

Later than one year but not later than two years

                  —      —      —  

Later than two year but not later than three years

                  —      —      —  
                   
  
  
                    18,245    179,783    —  
                   
  
  

Buy Japanese yen

                             

Not later than one year

   79.33    70.57    67.3    1,560,868    2,101,635    223,131

Later than one year but not later than two years

                  —      —      —  

Later than two year but not later than three years

                  —      —      —  
                   
  
  
                    1,560,868    2,101,635    223,131
                   
  
  

 

167


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 22 Additional financial instruments disclosure (continued)

 

(b) Foreign exchange risk (continued)

 

     2004

   2003

   2002

  

2004

$


  

2003

$


  

2002

$


          Average rate                    

Sell Japanese yen

                             

Not later than one year

   76.45    73.94    —      133,059    56,934    —  

Later than one year but not later than two years

                  —      —      —  

Later than two year but not later than three years

                  —      —      —  
                   
  
  
                    133,059    56,934    —  
                   
  
  

Buy English pound

                             

Not later than one year

   —      0.39    0.37    —      77,119    71,779

Later than one year but not later than two years

                  —      —      —  

Later than two year but not later than three years

                  —      —      —  
                   
  
  
                    —      77,119    71,779
                   
  
  

 

As these contracts are hedging anticipated purchases, any unrealised gains and losses on the contracts, together with the costs of the contracts, will be deferred and then recognized in the financial statements at the time the underlying transaction occurs as designated. The gross deferred gains and losses on hedges of anticipated foreign current purchases are:

 

     2004

   2003

   2002

    

Gains

$


  

Losses

$


  

Gains

$


  

Losses

$


  

Gains

$


  

Losses

$


Not later than one year

   778,676    80,710    44,231    2,021,565    54,818    —  

Later than one year but not later than two years

   —      —      —      —      —      —  

Later than two year but not later than three years

   —      —      —      —      —      —  

 

When the underlying transaction has occurred as designated, the effect of the hedge has been recognised in the financial statements.

 

(c) Commodity price risk

 

The consolidated entity does not enter into futures contracts to hedge (or hedge a proportion of ) commodity purchase prices on anticipated specific purchase commitments of natural rubber.

 

(d) Credit risk exposures

 

Credit risk represents the loss that would be recognised if counterparties failed to perform as contracted.

 

Recognised Financial Instruments

 

The credit risk on financial assets, excluding investments, of the consolidated entity which have been recognised on the statement of financial position, is the carrying amount, net of any provision for doubtful debts.

 

The consolidated entity minimises concentrations of credit risk by undertaking transactions with a large number of customers and counterparties in various countries.

 

The consolidated entity is not materially exposed to any individual overseas country or individual customer. Concentrations of credit risk on trade debtors and term debtors due from customers are the motor vehicle and transport industries.

 

Unrecognised Financial Instruments

 

Credit risk on derivative contracts which have not been recognised on the statement of financial position is minimised as counterparties are recognised financial intermediaries with acceptable credit ratings determined by a recognised ratings agency.

 

Interest rate swaps and foreign exchange contracts are subject to credit risk in relation to the relevant counterparties, which are principally large banks.

 

As all future contracts are transacted through a recognised futures exchange, credit risk associated with these contracts is minimal.

 

(e) Net fair values of financial assets and liabilities

 

Valuation approach

 

Net fair value of financial assets and liabilities are determined by the consolidated entity on the following basis:

 

Recognised Financial Instruments

 

The carrying amounts of bank term deposits, trade debtors, other debtors, bank overdrafts, accounts payable, bank loans and employee entitlements approximate net fair value.

 

Unrecognised Financial Instruments

 

The valuation of financial instruments not recognised on the statement of financial position detailed in this note reflects the estimated amounts which the consolidated entity expects to pay or receive to terminate the contracts (net of transaction costs), or replace the contracts at their current market rates as at reporting date. This is based on independent market quotations and determined using standard valuation techniques.

 

168


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 22 Additional financial instruments disclosure (continued)

 

(e) Net fair values of financial assets and liabilities (continued)

 

Net fair values

 

Recognised Financial Instruments

 

The carrying amounts and net fair values of financial assets and financial liabilities as at the reporting date are as follows:

 

     2004

   2003

   2002

    

Carrying
amount

$


  

Net fair

value

$


  

Carrying
amount

$


  

Net fair

value

$


  

Carrying
amount

$


  

Net fair

value

$


Financial assets

                             

Cash assets

   56,435,875    56,435,875    15,229,939    15,229,939    37,100,672    37,100,672

Receivables

   131,826,150    131,826,150    146,987,933    146,987,933    172,042,609    172,042,609

Financial liabilities

                             

Payables

   144,732,585    144,732,585    167,940,789    167,940,789    190,274,533    190,274,533

Bank overdrafts and loans

   73,561,733    73,561,733    90,934,299    90,934,299    64,652,501    64,652,501

Securitisation

   75,029,449    75,029,449    74,890,227    74,890,227    75,494,759    75,494,759

Partner Loans

   160,741,176    160,741,176    111,097,444    111,097,444    61,095,014    61,095,014

Trade bills

   4,859,813    4,859,813    5,589,308    5,589,308    2,247,952    2,247,952

Employee entitlements

   39,500,692    39,500,692    37,687,218    37,687,218    43,425,919    43,425,919

 

Unrecognised Financial Instruments

 

The net fair value of financial instruments not recognised on the statement of financial position held as at the reporting date are:

 

    

2004

$


  

2003

$


   

2002

$


Forward foreign exchange contracts gains/(losses)

   697,966    (1,977,334 )   54,818

Note 23 Commitments

               

Capital expenditure commitments

               

Plant

               

Contracted but not provided for and payable within one year

   951,935    3,311,414     4,505,841
    
  

 
     951,935    3,311,414     4,505,841
    
  

 

Lease commitments

               

Operating lease expense commitments

               

Future operating lease commitments not provided for in the financial statements and payable:

               

Within one year

   29,992,274    23,865,262     25,799,409

One year or later and no later than five years

   60,779,467    47,292,290     48,518,490

Later than 5 years

   6,720,240    15,992,314     10,596,215
    
  

 
     97,491,981    87,149,866     84,914,114
    
  

 

 

The consolidated entity leases property under non-cancellable operating leases expiring from one to ten years.

 

Leases generally provide the consolidated entity with a right of renewal at which time all terms are renegotiated.

 

Assets pledged and cash restrictions

 

Assets pledged to financial institutions as at 30 June 2004 ( $175,571,699 ), 2003 ( $nil ) and 2002 ( $nil ). Agreements with financial institutions place certain restrictions on the use of cash balances. These restrictions do not affect the daily operations of the consolidated entity and will not have a material adverse affect on its operations.

 

Note 24 Contingent liabilities

 

There were no contingent liabilities as at 30 June 2004, 30 June 2003 and 30 June 2004.

 

169


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 25 Related party transactions

 

The consolidated entity from time to time has dealings with Ansell Limited Group Companies and Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co. Group Companies.

 

Under the partnership agreement, the consolidated entity leases certain properties from Ansell Limited and Goodyear Australia Limited (a wholly owned subsidiary of Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co.) on a basis of equitable rentals between the partners.

 

The amounts of these transactions are detailed below:

 

Lease payments


  

2004

$


  

2003

$


  

2002

$


Ansell Limited Group Companies

   217,885    217,885    217,885

Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co. Group Companies

   75,273    75,273    75,273
During the financial year the consolidated entity received loans from the partners that are subject to interest at market rates compounding quarterly as detailed in Note 15.
On 29/12/2000, the consolidated entity entered into a supply agreement whereby Goodyear will be (subject to certain conditions) the exclusive supplier of certain tyres for a period of twelve years commencing 01/01/2001. The consolidated entity has received $25.0m plus interest in consideration for this supply.
On 20/12/2000, the consolidated entity received a loan of $25.0m from Ansell Limited on which interest is charged quarterly in arrears.
Interest brought to account by the consolidated entity in relation to these loans during the year:

Interest expense

   —      —      1,750,000

Interest revenue

   —      —      1,750,000
All other dealings with the above parties are on normal commercial terms and involve the purchase and/or supply of materials from/to both parties and the provision of forward exchange cover and commodity hedging by Ansell Limited Group Companies.
The amounts of these transactions are detailed below:

Sale of goods and services

              

Ansell Limited Group Companies

   —      —      37,791

Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co. Group Companies

   7,044,157    1,357,021    4,396,011

Purchase of goods and services

              

Ansell Limited Group Companies

   —      4,092    1,252,256

Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co. Group Companies

   115,062,875    118,165,909    107,439,259

Details of interest received/paid to related parties are set out in Notes 3 & 4.

 

The amounts included in receivables and payables in relation to the consolidated entity are set out in the notes to the financial statements and the amounts relating to the other parties are:

Current receivables

              

Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co. Group Companies

   588,874    182,079    526,745

Current payables

              

Ansell Limited Group Companies

   —      —      81,767

Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co. Group Companies

   20,921,867    21,072,760    23,663,413

 

The consolidated entity has had since 1987 a significant Research and Development arrangement with Goodyear Tire and Rubber Limited. A fee is payable as a percentage of sales of locally produced tyres. The amount of costs incurred for this contract was, for the year ended 30 June 2004 $3,528,348 ( June 2003 $4,928,422 ) and ( June 2002 $10,856,910 ).

 

The names of each person holding the position of director of the company during the year were:

 

Mr. Richard Kramer   Dr Edward Tweddell   Mr. Robert W. Tieken
Mr. Hugh D. Pace   Mr. Herbert J. Elliott   Mr. Clark E. Sprang
Ms. Janell Lopus   Mr. Douglas Tough   Mr. Harry Boon
Mr. Harold Smith   Mr. David Graham    

 

170


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 26 Superannuation commitments

 

Employer plans

 

Up until April 1st 2004 the consolidated entity participated in the Pacific Dunlop Superannuation Fund for employees.

 

Effective 1 April 2004 members were transferred out of the Pacific Dunlop Superannuation Fund to Equipsuper (an independent superannuation fund). the transfer of assets from the Pacific Dunlop Superannuation Fund to Equipsuper has not yet been completed.

 

    

2002

$


 

Net Assets

   148,178,000  

Accrued benefits

   148,802,000  
    

Deficiency

   (624,000 )
    

Vested Benefits

   146,578,000  

 

Country    Australia
Benefit type    Defined benefit / Accumulation
Basis of contribution    Balance of cost / Defined contribution
Date of last actuarial valuation    30/06/2002
Actuary    Mercer Human Resource Consulting Pty Ltd

 

Plan net assets, accrued benefits and vested benefits have been calculated at 30 June 2002, being the date of the most recent financial statements of the plan. Accrued benefits are based on an actuarial valuation undertaken at 30 June 2002.

 

The consolidated entity has accrued a superannuation expense of $1,630,000 to meet expected fund deficiency as at 30 June 2004.

 

The liabilities of the superannuation fund are covered by the assets in the fund or by specific provisions created by the consolidated entity.

 

The consolidated entity is obliged to contribute to the superannuation fund as a consequence of Legislation or Trust Deed. Legal enforceability is dependent on the terms of the Legislation and the Trust Deed.

 

Definitions

 

Balance of cost    The consolidated entity’s contribution is assessed by the Actuary after taking into account the member’s contribution and the value of assets.
Defined contribution    The consolidated entity’s contribution is set out in the appropriate fund rules, usually as a fixed percentage of salary.

 

 

Industry / union plans

 

The consolidated entity participates in industry and union plans on behalf of certain employees. These plans, which are reviewed periodically, operate on an accumulation basis and provide lump sum benefits for members on resignation, retirement or death.

 

The consolidated entity has a legally enforceable obligation to contribute at varying rates to the plans.

 

Note 27 Segment reporting

 

The principal activity of the group during the year was the manufacture and sale of motor vehicle and aircraft tyres in Australia.

 

171


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 28 Particulars relating to controlled entities

 

Details of controlled entities, including the extent that each contributed to the period’s result are given below:

 

Name of Company


   Place of
incorporation


   Beneficial
interest held
by
consolidated
entity


   

Class

of share


  

Book value of

consolidated entity’s

investment


  

Contribution to the

consolidated profit

after tax inclusive

of abnormal items and

after deducting the

amount attributable to

Outside Equity Interest


 
           2004

   2003

   2002

   2004

    2003

    2002

 

South Pacific Tyres

                                  (28,982,129 )   (44,501,568 )   (96,796,795 )

Tyre Marketers

                                                 

(Australia) Limited

   Vic    100 %   Ordinary    21,496,245    21,496,245    21,496,245    8,559,276     4,952,958     (33,840,907 )

Sacrt Trading Pty Ltd

   Vic    100 %   Ordinary                   491,696     158,826     365,417  

South Pacific Tyres

                                                 

(PNG) Pty. Ltd.

   PNG    80 %   Ordinary                   —       —       27,119  

Dunlop PNG Pty. Ltd.

   PNG    80 %   Ordinary                   —       —       (25,244 )

Consolidation adjustments

                                  (2,550,143 )   (174,001 )   243,240  
                    
  
  
  

 

 

                     21,496,245    21,496,245    21,496,245    (22,481,300 )   (39,563,785 )   (130,027,170 )
                    
  
  
  

 

 

 

172


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 29 Events subsequent to balance date

 

This financial report has been prepared in accordance with Australian accounting standards and other financial reporting requirements (Australian GAAP). The differences between Australian GAAP and IFRS identified to date as potentially having a significant effect on the consolidated entity’s financial performance and financial position are summarised below. The summary should not be taken as an exhaustive list of all the differences between Australian GAAP and IFRS. No attempt has been made to identify all disclosure, presentation or classification differences that would affect the manner in which transactions or events are presented.

 

The consolidated entity has not quantified the effects of the differences discussed below. Accordingly there can be no assurances that the consolidated financial performance and financial position as disclosed in this financial report would not be significantly different if determined in accordance with IFRS.

 

Regulatory bodies that promulgate Australian GAAP and IFRS have significant ongoing projects that could affect the differences between Australian GAAP and IFRS described below and the impact of these differences relative to the consolidated entity’s financial reports in the future. The potential impacts on the consolidated entity’s financial performance and financial position of the adoption of IFRS, including system upgrades and other implementation costs which may be incurred, have not been quantified as at the transition date of 1 July 2004 due to the short timeframe between finalisation of the IFRS standards and the date of preparing this report. The impact of future years will depend on the particular circumstances prevailing in those years.

 

The board has established a formal project, monitored by a steering committee, to achieve transition to IFRS reporting.

 

The company’s implementation project consists of three phases as described below.

 

    Assessment and planning phase

 

    Design phase

 

    Implementation phase

 

Except for certain training that has been given to operational staff, the company has not yet commenced the implementation phase. However, the company expects this phase to be substantially complete by 30 June 2005.

 

The key potential implications of the conversion to IFRS on the consolidated entity are as follows:

 

    financial instruments must be recognised in the statement of financial position and all derivatives and most financial assets must be carried at fair value

 

    income tax will be calculated based on the “balance sheet” approach, which may result in more deferred tax assets and liabilities and, as tax effects follow the underlying transaction, some tax effects will be recognised in equity

 

    surpluses and deficits in the defined benefit superannuation plans sponsored by the entities within the consolidated entity will be recognised in the statement of financial position and the statement of financial performance

 

    revaluation increments and decrements relating to revalued property, plant and equipment and intangible assets will be recognised on an individual asset basis, not a class of asset basis

 

    intangible assets:

 

internally generated intangible assets will not be recognised

 

intangible assets can only be revalued if there is an active market

 

    goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives will be tested for impairment annually and will not be amortised

 

    impairment of assets will be determined on a discounted basis, with strict tests for determining whether goodwill and cash generating operations have been impaired

 

    changes in accounting policies will be recognised by restating comparatives rather than making current year adjustments with note disclosure of prior year effects.

 

Other than as noted above, there has not arisen in the interval between the end of the financial year and the date of this report any item, transaction or event of a material nature likely, in the opinion of the directors of the consolidated entity, to affect significantly the operations, or the state of affairs of the consolidated entity in subsequent financial years.

 

173


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 30 Notes to the statements of cash flows

 

(a) Reconciliation of cash

 

For the purposes of the statement of cash flows, cash includes cash on hand and at bank and investments in money market instruments net of outstanding bank overdrafts. Cash as at the end of the financial year as shown in the statement of cash flows is reconciled to the related items in the statement of financial position as follows:

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Cash assets

   56,435,875     5,629,939     8,400,672  

Cash on deposit

   —       9,600,000     28,700,000  

Bank overdrafts

   (783,427 )   (690,488 )   (1,002,808 )
    

 

 

     55,652,448     14,539,451     36,097,864  
    

 

 

 

(b) Acquisition/disposal of businesses and entities

 

 

During the 2004 and 2003 financial years the consolidated entity purchased no businesses.

 

 

During the 2002 year the consolidated entity purchased 100% of businesses of which the details are as follows:  

 

Acquisitions of businesses

 

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Net assets acquired/disposed

                  

Property, plant and equipment

   —       —       458,033  

Inventories

   —       —       298,112  

Receivables

   —       —       268,685  

Creditors

   —       —       —    
    

 

 

     —       —       1,024,830  

Goodwill

   —       —       222,001  

Consideration

                  
    

 

 

Cash paid/(received)

   —       —       1,246,831  
    

 

 

Outflow/(inflow) of cash

                  
    

 

 

Cash consideration

   —       —       1,246,831  
    

 

 

 

Disposal of entities

                  

 

During the 2002 year, the consolidated entity disposed of all of its 80% share of South Pacific Tyres PNG Ltd.

 

 

Details of the disposal is as follows:                   

Consideration ( Cash )

   —       —       1,983,805  

Net assets of entity disposed of

                  

Property, plant and equipment

   —       —       702,062  

Inventories

   —       —       2,174,162  

Receivables

   —       —       1,096,993  

Other assets

   —       —       60,964  

Prepayments

   —       —       82,822  

Creditors

   —       —       (952,514 )

Other liabilities and provisions

   —       —       (146,852 )

Outside equity

   —       —       (408,017 )
    

 

 

     —       —       2,609,620  
    

 

 

Profit / (loss) on disposal

   —       —       (625,815 )
    

 

 

 

174


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 30 Notes to the statements of cash flows (continued)

 

(c) Reconciliation of profit/(loss) from ordinary activities after income tax to net cash provided by operating activities

 

    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Loss from ordinary activities after income tax

   (22,481,300 )   (39,563,785 )   (130,026,700 )

Add /(less) items classified as investing/financing activities:

                  

(Profit)/loss on sale of non-current assets

   6,134,607     7,721,228     13,327,002  

(Profit)/loss on sale of controlled entities

   —       —       625,815  

Add(less) non-cash items:

                  

Amortisation

   1,456,297     1,363,397     1,800,587  

Depreciation

   22,146,175     19,644,910     26,732,747  

Write-down of Property, Plant & Equipment

   2,219,064     —       —    

Amounts set aside to provisions

   (924,572 )   41,651,096     134,902,663  

(Decrease)/increase in income taxes payable

   154,865     77,057     (180,144 )

Decrease/(increase) in future income tax benefit

   3,714,819     4,209,755     (13,605,285 )

Write-off bad trade debts

   1,549,439     1,015,199     1,386,762  
    

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities before change in assets and liabilitties

   13,969,394     36,118,857     34,963,447  
    

 

 

Change in assets and liabilities adjusted for effects of purchase and disposal of controlled entities during the financial year:                   

(Increase)/decrease in receivables

   14,536,916     3,494,488     (13,406,489 )

(Increase)/decrease in inventories

   14,620,947     (1,290,172 )   4,628,518  

(Increase)/decrease in prepayments

   103,514     (1,064,694 )   180,180  

(Decrease)/increase in accounts payable

   (23,186,218 )   (22,333,744 )   20,283,451  

(Decrease)/increase in provisions

   404,360     (71,776,437 )   (70,029,855 )

(Decrease)/increase in reserves

   —       —       (524,325 )
    

 

 

     6,479,519     (92,970,559 )   (58,868,520 )
    

 

 

Net cash provided by / (used in) operating activities

   20,448,913     (56,851,702 )   (23,905,073 )
    

 

 

 

Note 31 Summary of significant differences between generally accepted accounting principles in Australia and generally accepted accounting principles in the United States - RESTATED

 

The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in Australia (AGAAP), which differ in certain significant respects with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (US GAAP). Pursuant to certain rules and regulations of the US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC), financial statements to be included in filings with the SEC that are prepared on a basis of accounting other than US GAAP are required to provide a description of the significant differences and their effects on net income and equity in arriving at such amounts in accordance with US GAAP.

 

Subsequent to the issuance of the Company’s consolidated financial statements as of 30 June, 2003 and 2002 and for each of the years in the three-year period ended 30 June, 2003, it was determined that information previously provided with respect to material differences and the effects of such differences on the determination of net loss and partners’ equity in accordance with US GAAP was inaccurate and incomplete. Those previously issued consolidated financial statements indicated (i) a reduction of $10.6 million and $10.7 million as of 30 June, 2003 and 2002, respectively, in arriving at partners’ equity pursuant to US GAAP would be required to eliminate the effects of an asset revaluation reserve recognized in partners’ equity under AGAAP; (ii) a decrease in depreciation expense of $125,000 would be required in arriving at net loss pursuant to US GAAP for each of the years in the three-year period ended 30 June, 2003 to reflect the elimination of the asset revaluation reserve described above and; (iii) that there were no further adjustments of a material nature that would be required to be included in the determination of net loss and partners’ equity pursuant to US GAAP.

 

Accordingly, the information set out in notes 32 and 33 provides, as at 30 June, 2004, 2003 and 2002 and for each of the years in the three-year period ended 30 June, 2004 a description of the material differences and their effects in reconciling net loss and partners’ equity as reported under AGAAP in the accompanying consolidated financial statements to such amounts pursuant to US GAAP. As indicated above, information as of, and for each of the years in the two-year period ended 30 June 2003 have been presented on a restated basis substantially in their entirety. In addition, the Company has supplementally included disclosures required pursuant to US GAAP that have not otherwise been provided in the consolidated financial statements prepared under AGAAP.

 

175


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 32 Major differences between Australian GAAP and USGAAP

 

(a) Property, plant and equipment

 

As permitted by AGAAP, certain property, plant and equipment has been revalued by South Pacific Tyres at various times in prior financial periods. Revaluation increments have increased the carrying value of the assets and accordingly the depreciation charges are different from those which would be required on a historical cost basis pursuant to US GAAP. As a result, a reconciliation adjustment is required to eliminate this effect for US GAAP. Additionally, US GAAP has specific criteria in regard to assets designated as ‘held for sale’ versus ‘ held for use’. Accordingly, certain impairment charges taken under AGAAP may result in reversal under US GAAP, but with ongoing accelerated depreciation charges. Furthermore, certain assets written down to ‘fair value’ under AGAAP may continue to be further depreciated under US GAAP requirements if the ‘held for sale’ classification criteria are not fully satisfied. The annual depreciation and impairment charges under US GAAP are lower than the amounts reflected in the AGAAP consolidated financial statements for the years ended 2002 and 2004 for certain assets. This results in a higher net income for US GAAP purposes of $430,414 for the year ended June 2002 and $128,000 for the year ended June 2004. For the year ended June 2003, and having regard to certain accelerated depreciation charges under US GAAP, depreciation expense would be higher than the amount reflected in the AGAAP consolidated financial statements. Consequently, USGAAP net income for the year ended June 2003 would be lower by $157,714. The above policy also causes differences in reported gains and losses on the sale of property, plant and equipment. Gains and losses for AGAAP are based on consideration less revalued amounts net of accumulated depreciation and amortisation. For US GAAP purposes gains and losses are determined having regard to depreciated historical cost, and net revaluation reserves applicable to assets sold are reported in Income. The effect of this is to decrease US GAAP net income by $8,338 in the year ended 30 June 2002. In the year ended 30 June 2004 the effect is to increase net income by $195,678.

 

For USGAAP purposes the Company follows the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) Statement of Financial Accounting Standard (SFAS) No. 144 “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-lived Assets”. SFAS No. 144 superseded SFAS No. 121 “Accounting for the Impairment of Long-lived Assets and for Long-lived Assets to be Disposed of” and was adopted by the Company effective 1 July 2002. SFAS No. 144 retains the requirements of SFAS No. 121 to (a) recognise an impairment loss if the carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not recoverable from its undiscounted cash flows and (b) measure an impairment loss as the difference between the carrying amount and fair value of the asset less estimated costs to sell and expands specific criteria relative to the classification and accounting for such assets. SFAS No. 144 also requires that long lived assets to be abandoned, exchanged for a similar productive asset, or distributed to owners in a spin-off be considered held and used until the asset is disposed of, exchanged or distributed.

 

(b) Minority interests

 

Outside Equity interests are included as part of total Equity under AGAAP. The reconciliation to US GAAP in Note 33 has excluded these from Partners’ Equity in 2002 consistent with US GAAP treatment. The entity in which the outside equity interest existed was sold in the year ended 30 June 2002.

 

(c) Provisions

 

The term “provisions” is used in AGAAP to designate accrued expenses with no definitive payment date. Classification between current and non-current is generally based on management assessments, as subject to audit.

 

(d) Pension plans

 

The consolidated entity sponsors contributory and non-contributory accumulation and defined benefit pension plans covering substantially all employees. The defined benefit plans generally provide benefits based on salary in the period prior to retirement. All defined benefit plans are funded based on actuarial determination, and contribution levels are revised, on a regular basis so as to ensure that the plans are fundamentally maintained on a fully funded basis. Actuarial calculations have been carried out for the defined benefit funds and the material provisions of the plans are as detailed in Note 26. The majority of assets of the funds are invested in pooled superannuation trusts in the case of the Australian funds and equity securities for other major funds. Limited disclosure in respect of pension plans is presently required by AGAAP. Under AGAAP the actual contributions to the various pension plans are recorded as an expense in the Statement of Financial Performance in the period they are paid or accrued. The disclosure requirements of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 87 (SFAS No. 87) and No. 132 (SFAS No. 132 as revised) have been included in Note 33 to these consolidated financial statements. The consolidated entity reports pension plans aggregated where allowed by SFAS No.87. Additionally, an adjustment is made to recognize the measurement principles of SFAS No. 87 and related standards in determining net income and shareholders’ equity under US GAAP.

 

(e) Statement of Cash Flows

 

Net profit (loss) determined under AGAAP differs in certain respects from the amount determined in accordance with USGAAP. A reconciliation of net profit (loss) according to US GAAP to Cash Flows from Operating Activities under US GAAP is provided. There are no material differences between net cash provided by (used in ) financing and investing activities determined in accordance with AGAAP and such amounts determined in accordance with US GAAP. Under AGAAP, cash is defined as cash on hand and deposits repayable on demand, less overdrafts repayable on demand. Under US GAAP, cash and cash equivalents are defined as cash and investments with original maturities of three months or less, and do not include bank overdrafts or restricted deposits. Cash and cash equivalents as of 30 June, 2004, 2003 and 2002 would have been $56,435,875, $15,229,939 and $37,100,672 respectively, under US GAAP.

 

(f) Income Taxes

 

Under AGAAP, deferred tax assets (future income tax benefits) attributable to temporary differences are only brought to account when their realisation is assured beyond reasonable doubt. Future income tax benefits related to tax losses are only brought to account when their realisation is virtually certain. At each respective reporting date the value of gross tax losses for which future tax benefits have been brought to account under AGAAP totalled $29,183,817 in June 2004, (2003 $44,173,986) and (2002 $53,137,787). These losses have no expiry date. Refer Note 6( c ). According to US GAAP deferred tax assets are only brought to account when their realization is more likely that not. As US GAAP represents a lower threshold for assessing the realisability of deferred tax assets as compared to AGAAP, there is no material effect in arriving at net profit (loss) under US GAAP. The SPT operations are conducted through the Partnership (non taxable entity), and by its subsidiary – TMA. As TMA is a stand-alone taxable entity certain US GAAP adjustments related to TMA are subject to tax effects. The majority of the US GAAP adjustments are in respect of the Partnership, the results of which are taxed in the hands of the Partners. Accordingly, a substantial number of the adjustments have no tax effect in the SPT consolidated financial statement reconciliation. The consolidated entity has (gross) capital tax losses of $21,271,173 in 2004 (2003 $22,081,014) and (2002 $22,817,537). These losses have no expiry date. Total capital losses are offset by a valuation allowance. The adequacy of the valuation

 

176


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 32 Major differences between Australian GAAP and USGAAP (continued)

 

(f) Income Taxes (continued)

 

allowance is regularly assessed. The valuation allowance in respect of the capital losses decreased by $242,952 and $220,957 for the years ended 30 June 2004 and 2003, respectively.

 

Analysis of Pre tax profit / (loss):          Restated

 
     2004

    2003

    2002

 

Australian operations

   (18,611,616 )   (35,355,948 )   (143,606,153 )

Foreign operations

   —       —       —    
    

 

 

Total

   (18,611,616 )   (35,355,948 )   (143,606,153 )
    

 

 

Temporary differences and carryforwards giving rise to deferred tax assets and liabilities at 30 June, follows:

 

 

           Restated

 
     2004

    2003

    2002

 

Trading stock adjustments

   166,306     36,887     30,409  

Provisions

   6,892,310     6,931,368     8,533,692  

Accruals

   237,699     160,408     251,990  

Accumulated tax losses

   8,755,145     13,252,196     15,941,336  

Accumulated capital losses

   6,381,352     6,624,304     6,845,261  

Other

   52,234     —       —    
    

 

 

     22,485,046     27,005,163     31,602,688  

Less Valuation allowance

   (6,381,352 )   (6,624,304 )   (6,845,261 )
    

 

 

Total deferred assets

   16,103,694     20,380,859     24,757,427  
    

 

 

Total deferred liabilities

                  

Property, plant and equipment

   (1,586,941 )   (2,018,708 )   (2,132,392 )

Other

   —       (130,579 )   (183,708 )
    

 

 

Total deferred liabilities

   (1,586,941 )   (2,149,287 )   (2,316,100 )
    

 

 

Total net deferred tax assets

   14,516,753     18,231,572     22,441,327  
    

 

 

 

As the amount of current deferred tax items are not material in nature, all deferred tax assets have been presented as non current in the Statement of Financial Position.

 

(g) Accounting for Goodwill

 

Shares in controlled entities are valued on acquisition at the holding company’s cost. Any difference between the fair value of net assets acquired and cost is recognised as goodwill. Under AGAAP, goodwill is amortised on a straight line basis over varying periods not exceeding 20 years. In accounting for business combinations, the Company follows SFAS No. 141, “Business Combinations”, and SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Intangible Assets”. SFAS No. 141 requires that the purchase method of accounting be used for all business combinations completed after 30 June 2002 which is consistent with AGAAP. SFAS No. 141 also specifies the types of acquired intangible assets that are required to be recognised and reported separately from goodwill and those acquired intangible assets that are required to be included in goodwill.

 

SFAS No. 142 requires that goodwill no longer be amortised, but instead tested for impairment at least annually. This requirement creates a difference between the amortisation required under AGAAP and US GAAP. SFAS No. 142 also requires recognised intangible assets to be amortised over their respective estimated useful lives and reviewed for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-lived Assets”. SFAS No. 142 also permits indefinite useful lives to be assigned to recognised intangibles. Any recognised intangible assets determined to have an indefinite useful life will not be amortised, but instead tested for impairment in accordance with the SFAS No. 142 until its life is determined to no longer be indefinite. The Company has determined it has one reporting unit consistent with its single operating segment. SFAS No. 142 requires goodwill and other intangible assets to be tested for impairment at the reporting unit level. A reporting unit is the same as, or one level below, an operating segment as defined by SFAS No. 131 “Disclosure about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information”.

 

Accordingly, goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are tested for impairment annually or when events or circumstances indicate that impairment may have occurred. Any material diminution in value is charged to the Statement of Financial Performance for USGAAP purposes. For USGAAP purposes no goodwill amortisation has been charged against income since 1 July 2002, the effective date of SFAS No. 142. Goodwill amortisation of $287,389 under AGAAP in 2004 and 2003 has been added back to income in the Statement of Financial Performance for US GAAP purposes.

 

Goodwill attributable to sold businesses is brought to account in determining the gain or loss on sale.

 

177


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 32 Major differences between Australian GAAP and USGAAP (continued)

 

(h) Derivatives not designated as hedges

 

Derivatives not designated as hedges primarily consist of interest rate swaps and forward exchange contracts which, while mitigating economic risks to which the economic entity is exposed, do not qualify for hedge accounting under USGAAP pursuant to SFAS 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities” as they relate to hedging of anticipated transactions. These amounts are adjusted in determining net profit (loss) according to US GAAP. The fair value of the interest rate swaps as at June 2003 was an unrealized loss of $517,350. The fair value at June 2004 was an unrealized loss of $62,176. The effect of the necessary reconciling adjustment is an increase in the USGAAP loss for June 2003 of $517,350 and a decrease in the loss of $455,174 for the year ended June 2004.

 

(i) Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

 

The nature of South Pacific Tyres’ business activities necessarily involves the management of various financial and market risks, including those related to changes in interest rates, currency exchange rates and commodity prices. South Pacific Tyres uses derivative financial instruments to mitigate or eliminate certain of those risks, as a component of its risk management strategy. The Company does not use derivative instruments for trading purposes. Under AGAAP, derivative financial instruments may have hedge accounting treatment applied if the hedging derivatives are effective in reducing the exposure being hedged and are designated as a hedge at the inception of the contract. Hedging derivatives are accounted for in a manner consistent with the accounting treatment of the hedged items. For US GAAP purposes, the Company follows SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities” as amended, which became effective for South Pacific Tyres on 1 July 2000. Under SFAS No. 133, as amended, all derivative instruments are recognised in the Statement of Financial Position at their fair values and changes in fair value are recognised immediately in earnings, unless the derivatives qualify as hedges of future cash flows or of investments in foreign operations. For derivatives qualifying as hedges of future cash flows, the effective portion of changes in fair value is recorded temporarily in equity, then recognised in earnings along with the related effects of the hedged items. Any ineffective portion of hedges is reported in net profit (loss) as it occurs. Under US GAAP, all derivatives are recognised on the Statement of Financial Position at their fair value. On the date the derivative is entered into South Pacific Tyres designates the derivative as either a hedge of the fair value of a recognised asset or liability or firm commitment ( fair value hedge) or of the variability of cash flows to be paid or received related to a recognised asset, liability or forecasted transaction (cash flow hedge). There is no material impact on net profit/(loss) as a result of these differences as the fair value of the derivative instruments at the balance sheet date is offset by the foreign currency translation of the hedged receivables and payables recorded at the forward rate for AGAAP to the spot rate at balance date. Any net difference arising relates to the forward points spread between the spot rate and the forward rate at the balance sheet date which is not material. No US GAAP adjustment has been recognised as a consequence.

 

(j) Supply agreement

 

In December 2000, Goodyear contracted to pay SPT an amount of $28,500,000 in relation to a 10-year supply agreement commencing in 2003. The amount was to be paid on 1 January 2003. As there were no onerous conditions upon SPT as a result of the contract, and because the receipt of the contribution did not result in a change in the relative interests of the partners in the partnership, the present value of the sum was recognised as revenue under AGAAP in December 2000. SPT further recognised interest income on the determined present value on an accrual basis. Under US GAAP, SPT has recognised the amount of $25,000,000 not as revenue, but as a capital contribution. The capital contribution has been recognised in the period ended 30 June 2002, being the period in which the cash was actually received from Goodyear.

 

(k) Provision for Environmental remediation/Impairment

 

(i) Remediation

 

In December 2001, SPT recognized a liability to remediate its Footscray and Thomastown idled manufacturing facilities to prepare them for sale. The expenditure of $9,900,000 was authorized by the SPT Board of Directors and, under AGAAP, was recorded based on that approval. As a result of further development of the disposal plan, and not withstanding that the plan would not be completed within twelve months, $3,600,000 of additional expenditure was authorised in April 2004 and an additional liability was recorded under AGAAP.

 

The expenditure is to cover environmental remediation, demolition and project management. This liability is included in the provision for Rationalisation and Restructure in the AGAAP consolidated balance sheet. Refer Note 16. In addition to the actual cash outlays of $508,113 charged against the provision in the year ended 30 June, 2003 a further $1,506,970 was expended and charged against this provision in the year ended 30 June, 2004.

 

Under US GAAP, environmental liabilities are not recognised until a company has a legal or constructive obligation to remediate. Accordingly, because there is no such obligation to remediate, for US GAAP purposes only the actual cash outlays described above are recognised as expense when they were incurred. Accordingly, the net loss determined under US GAAP was decreased by $2,093,000 as a result of the reversal of the provision increase of $3,600,000 and the expensing of the actual cash outlays charged against the provision in 2004 of $1,506,970.

 

(ii) Asset Impairment

 

In December 2001 and as referred to in (i) above, South Pacific Tyres committed to the closedown of its Footscray and Thomastown manufacturing facilities and to prepare them for sale. Because, as a result of this decision, the plants were no longer to generate operating cash flows, the asset carrying values at the time were considered for impairment.

 

Under US GAAP, in accordance with the provisions of SFAS 121 and SFAS 144, a one time impairment charge of $7,800,000 was taken against property, plant and equipment in 2002 to write down the net book value of these facilities to the estimated fair values attributable to the unremediated sites. In 2004 following the further development of the plans for remediation and sale of the plants, and due to the plants not qualifying for “held for sale” classification under US GAAP, a further evaluation of impairment of the sites was undertaken. Based on the valuations obtained, a further impairment charge of $2,034,000 was required due to the reduction in the values of the unremediated sites. The further impairment charge of $2,034,000 significantly offsets the reversal of the excess Environmental remediation charge of $2,093,000 set out in (i) above. The net impact of these items is to decrese the 2004 loss determined in accordance with US GAAP by $59,030. Accordingly, the cumulative net increase in US GAAP equity at June 2004 for these items is $1,650,917.

 

178


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 32 Major differences between Australian GAAP and USGAAP (continued)

 

(l) Activity Alignment

 

In December 2000 South Pacific Tyres recognised under AGAAP, a $6 million provision for redundancy costs for headcount reduction. The provision was based on an external consultant’s assessment of the required headcount reduction to achieve certain identified overhead efficiencies. The project was called “Activity Alignment”. The plan was not completed and $4,046,953 was reversed in the year ended 30 June 2002 under AGAAP. The $6 million provision at June 2001 did not meet US GAAP recognition criteria and as a result, US GAAP net income in that period is higher by the unspent amount of $4,046,953. In the year ended 30 June 2002 when the unspent amount was reversed for AGAAP, the net income for US GAAP is $4,046,953 less.

 

(m) Manufacturing Plant – Accelerated Depreciation

 

In September 2001 the SPT Board of Directors authorized the closure of operations at its Footscray and Thomastown manufacturing facilities. A provision was recognized in December 2001 under AGAAP for the eventual write-off of plant and equipment. The Thomastown facility was to remain partly in operation until July 2002. Under US GAAP the plant and equipment relating to this partial operation was subject to accelerated depreciation for seven months in accordance with SFAS 121, rather than immediate write off. At June 2002 one month’s depreciation in the amount of $285,714 was still to be brought to account having the effect of decreasing US GAAP losses in the year ended June 2002 and increasing US GAAP losses in the year ended June 2003.

 

(n) Tyre Marketers Tax Adjustment

 

The Retail/Corporate restructuring provisions (see Note 4) arose in a tax paying entity, Tyre Marketers (Australia) Ltd (TMA). The provision was therefore tax effected at TMA’s effective rate of 30%. Accordingly, US GAAP adjustments relating to TMA have been tax effected.

 

(o) Business Interruption

 

In June 2002 South Pacific Tyres released $1,577,315 of the rationalisation provision to net profit (loss) on the basis that production levels and operating capacity of the tyre plant were significantly reduced as a consequence of the restructuring activities at Somerton. While AGAAP allows for costs associated with effecting restructuring activities to be charged as a component of a restructuring provision, it was not considered appropriate under US GAAP. The specific cost cannot be provided for under USGAAP as they are considered future operating costs. This has the effect of increasing the net loss according to US GAAP in the year ended June 2002 by $1,577,316 and decreasing net loss according to US GAAP by the same amount in the year ended June 2003.

 

(p) Advertising

 

Under AGAAP, advertising is generally expensed as the service is performed. Under US GAAP, advertising is expensed as incurred although there are exceptions to this, related to co-operative advertising programs and advertising related materials. Costs incurred under South Pacific Tyres’ co-operative advertising program with dealers and franchisees are initially deferred and then recorded as reductions of sales as related revenues are recognised under AGAAP. No direct response advertising is reported as an asset. The effect of this difference is that under US GAAP, Partners’ equity is lower by $840,000 after tax compared to that under AGAAP as such amounts are expensed as incurred under US GAAP. This difference relates to all periods presented as the Yellow Pages advertising cost has remained consistent.

 

(q) Foreign Currency Translation Reserve

 

In June 2002 South Pacific Tyres sold its interest in South Pacific Tyres PNG Pty Ltd. Under AGAAP the accumulated foreign currency translation reserve of $3,645,848 was transferred to retained earnings. Under US GAAP the accumulated foreign currency translation reserve included as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income for US GAAP, is reported as part of the gain or loss on sale for the period during which the sale occurs. Consequently the net loss according to US GAAP for the year ended June 2002 is greater than the loss according to AGAAP purposes by $3,645,848. However, there is no effect on partners’ equity under US GAAP.

 

(r) Securitisation

 

From November 2001 South Pacific Tyres has maintained a program for the continuous sale of substantially all its domestic trade accounts receivable to the South Pacific Tyres Trust, a bankruptcy remote qualifying special purpose vehicle (QSPV). The QSPV is consolidated for AGAAP, as well as US GAAP, because the program did not meet all the criteria for off balance sheet treatment in accordance with SFAS 140 “Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities”. Accordingly there is no difference between AGAAP & US GAAP treatment of the securitisation program.

 

The amount of the receivables securitised at June 2004 was $115,149,129 (June 2003 $112,899,035) and (June 2002 $114,957,253). The amount of interest paid by South Pacific Tyres to the QSPV for the year ended June 2004 was $3,941,622 (June 2003 $3,543,248) and (June 2002 $2,068,668). South Pacific Tyres retains the responsibility for servicing the receivables. As receivables are collected the cash proceeds are used to purchase additional receivables. The amount of service fees paid by the QSPV to South Pacific Tyres was approximately $120,000 for the year ended June 2004, $120,000 for the year ended 2003 and $80,000 for the year ended 2002.

 

(s) Warranties

 

South Pacific Tyres and its controlled entities offer warranties on the sale of certain of its products as required under the Australian Trade Practices Act. For AGAAP, warranty expense is charged as incurred. For US GAAP, a provision for warranties has been recognised based on past claims experience, sales history and other considerations. The effect of this difference is that under US GAAP, Partners’ equity is lower by $3,204,000 as compared to such amount pursuant to AGAAP. Due to the consistency in the Company’s operations, sales generated, customer base, warranty offerings and historical cost experience there has not been a material change in amount of accrued obligation at the balance sheet date since 2000.

 

(t) MRT Factory - Costs to Sell land and buildings

 

In fiscal 2001 South Pacific Tyres decided to close its medium truck radial tyre plant at Somerton. $1,500,000 was recorded as an accrued obligation under AGAAP for the costs associated with the separation and ultimate sale of the land and buildings. In October 2001 the South Pacific Tyres Board reconsidered its decision and changed the classification of the site to “held for use” and reversed the provision. Since the AGAAP provision represented “costs to sell” and the land and buildings were not considered to be impaired under the “held for use” criteria pursuant to SFAS121, the provision was reversed for US GAAP purposes. As a result, net profit according to US GAAP was increased by $1,500,000 in the year ended 30 June 2001 and reduced by the same amount for US GAAP in the year ended 30 June 2002.

 

179


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 32 Major differences between Australian GAAP and USGAAP (continued)

 

(u) Change in Accounting Policy - Employee benefits

 

The consolidated entity has applied the revised AASB 1028 “Employee Benefits” for the first time from 1 July 2002. The liability for wages and salaries, annual leave and sick leave is now calculated using the remuneration rates the consolidated entity expects to pay as at each reporting date, not wage and salary rates current at reporting date. Under AGAAP the initial adjustment of $103,373 to the consolidated financial report as at 1 July 2002 as a result of this change was charged directly to retained earnings. Under US GAAP, this has been accounted for as a reduction of net income of $103,373 in the year ended 30 June 2003.

 

(v) Revenue Recognition

 

Under AGAAP, interest revenue and proceeds from the sale of non current assets are recorded as other revenues from ordinary activities and the book basis of the assets and businesses sold is included in expenses. Under US GAAP, interest revenue is classified as other income and the difference between the sale proceeds and the book basis of the assets and business sold would be presented as a gain or loss and included in the determination of net profit (loss). Accordingly, revenue for the years 2004, 2003 and 2002 under US GAAP would have been $818,736,638, $793,596,996 and $829,385,986 respectively.

 

180


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 33 Reconciliation to United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (US GAAP)

 

                 Restated

 
           2004
$


    2003
$


    2002
$


 

Statement of Financial Performance

                        

Net profit/(loss) of the consolidated entity per Australian GAAP

         (22,481,300 )   (39,563,785 )   (130,026,700 )

Less interest of outside equity holders

   32 (b)   —       —       470  
          

 

 

Net profit / (loss) attributable to the consolidated entity

         (22,481,300 )   (39,563,785 )   (130,027,170 )

Adjustments required to accord with US GAAP:

                        

Add / (deduct)

         977,171     1,473,930     (5,123,240 )
          

 

 

Net profit/(loss) according to US GAAP

         (21,504,129 )   (38,089,855 )   (135,150,410 )
          

 

 

Statement of Comprehensive Income/ (Loss)

                        

Net profit/(loss) according to USGAAP

         (21,504,129 )   (38,089,855 )   (135,150,410 )

Foreign currency translation reserve (net of nil tax)

         —       —       3,341,868  
          

 

 

Comprehensive Income (Loss)

         (21,504,129 )   (38,089,855 )   (131,808,542 )
          

 

 

Reconciliation of net profit and loss according to US GAAP to Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities determined under US GAAP.

                        

Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities according to US GAAP

         20,448,913     (56,851,702 )   (23,905,073 )

Write-down of Property, Plant & Equipment

         (4,253,064 )   —       (7,800,000 )

Depreciation

         (22,018,175 )   (19,802,624 )   (26,302,333 )

Amortisation

         (1,168,908 )   (1,076,008 )   (1,800,587 )

Amounts set aside to provisions

         4,524,572     (38,496,466 )   (130,626,931 )

Write-of bad trade debts

         (1,549,439 )   (1,015,199 )   (1,386,762 )

Gain / (loss) on sale of investments, properties, plant and equipment

         (6,134,607 )   (7,721,228 )   (13,952,817 )

Outside equity interest in (profit) / loss for the year

         —       —       (470 )

Change in assets and liabilities net of effects of purchase and disposal of controlled entities during the financial year:

                        

Increase / (decrease) in receivables

         (14,536,916 )   (3,494,488 )   13,406,489  

Increase / (decrease) in inventories

         (14,620,947 )   1,290,172     (4,628,518 )

Increase / (decrease) in prepayments

         (103,514 )   1,064,694     (180,180 )

(Increase) / decrease in accounts payable

         23,846,392     22,848,394     (16,683,451 )

(Increase) / decrease in provisions

         (1,911,330 )   69,587,636     68,529,855  

Increase / (decrease) in reserves

         195,678     —       (3,129,861 )

(Increase) / decrease in income taxes payable

         (154,865 )   (77,057 )   180,144  

Increase / (decrease) in future income tax benefit

         (4,067,919 )   (4,345,979 )   13,130,085  
          

 

 

Net profit/(loss) according to US GAAP

         (21,504,129 )   (38,089,855 )   (135,150,410 )
          

 

 

Adjustments to reflect US GAAP:

                        

Add / (Deduct) :

                        

Supply Agreement

   32 (j)   —       —       —    

Manufacturing plant accelerated depreciation

   32 (m)   —       (285,714 )   285,714  

Depreciation difference Thomastown / Footscray

   32 (a)   (170,000 )   (170,000 )   —    

Fixed Asset Revaluation depreciation difference

   32 (a)   298,000     298,000     144,700  

Fixed Asset Disposal Difference

   32 (a)   195,678     —       (8,338 )

FAS87 Pension

   32 (d)   205,000     1,032,000     3,600,000  

Environmental remediation

   32 (k)   59,030     (508,113 )   9,900,000  

Impairment

   32 (k)               (7,800,000 )

Advertising

   32 (p)   —       —       —    

Activity Alignment

   32 (l)   —       —       (4,046,953 )

Business Interruption

   32 (o)   —       1,577,315     (1,577,315 )

MRT Factory - Costs to Sell

   32 (t)   —       —       (1,500,000 )

Goodwill Amortisation

   32 (g)   287,389     287,389     —    

Interest Rate Swaps

   32 (h)   455,174     (517,350 )   —    

Disposal of PNG - Translation Reserve

   32 (q)   —       —       (3,645,848 )

Initial Adoption of Revised AASB1028

   32 (u)   —       (103,373 )   —    

Income tax (expense) / benefit

   32 (n)   (353,100 )   (136,224 )   (475,200 )
          

 

 

Total Adjustments

         977,171     1,473,930     (5,123,240 )
          

 

 

 

181


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities – Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 33 Reconciliation to United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (US GAAP)

 

                 Restated

 
           2004
$


    2003
$


    2002
$


 

Partners’ equity according to AGAAP

         35,841,338     58,309,638     97,976,796  

Deduct outside equity interests

   32 (b)   —       —       —    
          

 

 

Partners’ equity attributable to the Partners

         35,841,338     58,309,638     97,976,796  
          

 

 

Adjustments required to reflect US GAAP:

                        

Add / (Deduct) :

                        

Asset Revaluation Reserve

   32 (a)   (12,374,551 )   (12,570,229 )   (12,570,229 )

Supply Agreement

   32 (j)   —       —       —    

Manufacturing plant accelerated depreciation

   32 (m)   —       —       285,714  

Depreciation difference Thomastown / Footscray

   32 (a)   (340,000 )   (170,000 )   —    

Fixed Asset Revaluation depreciation difference

   32 (a)   885,400     587,400     289,400  

FAS87 Pension

   32 (d)   (363,000 )   (568,000 )   (1,600,000 )

Environmental remediation/Impairment

   32 (k)   1,650,917     1,591,887     2,100,000  

Advertising

   32 (p)   (1,200,000 )   (1,200,000 )   (1,200,000 )

Warranty

   32 (s)   (3,204,000 )   (3,204,000 )   (3,204,000 )

Activity Alignment

   32 (l)   —       —       —    

Business Interruption

   32 (o)   —       —       (1,577,315 )

MRT Factory - Costs to Sell

   32 (t)   —       —       —    

Goodwill Amortisation

   32 (g)   574,778     287,389     —    

Interest Rate Swaps

   32 (h)   (62,176 )   (517,350 )   —    

Income tax (expense) / benefit

   32 (n)   81,876     434,976     571,200  
          

 

 

Total Adjustments

         (14,350,756 )   (15,327,927 )   (16,905,230 )
          

 

 

Partners’ equity according to US GAAP

         21,490,582     42,981,711     81,071,566  
          

 

 

 

182


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities - Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 33 Reconciliation to United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles ( US GAAP )

 

     Australian Fund

 
    

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Pension Plan data supporting Note 26

                  

Plan’s funded status at 30 June is summarised as follows:

                  

Actuarial present value of accumulated obligations:

                  

- Vested

   135,209,000     120,700,000     141,100,000  

- Non Vested

   —       —       —    

Total accumulated benefit obligation

   135,209,000     120,700,000     141,100,000  

Projected benefit obligation

   135,957,000     121,887,000     142,532,000  

Plan assets at fair value

   138,236,000     121,360,000     152,709,000  

Excess / (deficiency) of assets over benefit obligations

   2,279,000     (527,000 )   10,177,000  

Unrecognised net gain / (loss)

   (11,588,000 )   (11,719,000 )   573,000  

Net Pension (Liability) / Asset

   13,867,000     11,192,000     9,604,000  

NET PENSION COST

                  

Defined Benefit Plans:

                  

- Service cost-benefits earned during the year

   10,240,000     13,914,000     10,311,000  

- Interest cost on projected benefit obligation

   7,313,000     7,131,000     10,072,000  

- Expected return on plan assets

   (8,495,000 )   (10,092,000 )   (13,084,000 )

- Net amortisation and settlement and curtailment (gain) / loss

   —       —       —    

Net Pension Cost of Defined Benefit Plans

   9,058,000     10,953,000     7,299,000  

ASSUMPTIONS ( used to determine net pension cost )

                  

Weighted average discount rate

   6.00 %   6.00 %   6.00 %

Rate of increase in compensation level

   3.50 %   3.50 %   3.50 %

Expected long term rate of return

   7.00 %   7.00 %   7.00 %

The expected long term rate of return on pension assets is based on a strategic asset allocation. The real rate of return (net of inflation) is expected to average 4.5% over the long term and the long term average rate of inflation is expected to be 2.5%.

                  

MEASUREMENT DATE

   30 June 2004     30 June 2003     30 June 2002  

CHANGE IN BENEFIT OBLIGATION

                  

Projected Benefit Obligation at beginning of year

   121,887,000     142,532,000     179,926,000  

Service cost

   10,240,000     13,914,000     10,311,000  

Interest cost

   7,313,000     7,131,000     10,072,000  

Member contributions

   1,387,000     —       —    

Actuarial (gain) / loss

   8,511,000     (14,990,000 )   (19,177,000 )

Benefits, administrative expenses and tax paid

   (13,381,000 )   (26,700,000 )   (38,600,000 )

Projected Benefit Obligation at end of year

   135,957,000     121,887,000     142,532,000  

ASSUMPTIONS (used to determine end of the year benefit obligations)

                  

Weighted average discount rate

   5.50 %   6.00 %   6.00 %

Rate of increase in compensation level

   3.50 %   3.50 %   3.50 %

CHANGE IN PLAN ASSETS

                  

Market value of assets at beginning of year

   121,360,000     152,709,000     180,630,000  

Member / Employer Contributions

   13,120,000     12,541,000     10,467,000  

Benefits, administrative expenses and tax paid

   (13,381,000 )   (26,700,000 )   (38,600,000 )

Actual return on plan assets

   17,137,000     (17,190,000 )   212,000  

Market value of assets at end of year

   138,236,000     121,360,000     152,709,000  

 

 

183


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities - Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 33 Reconciliation to United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles ( US GAAP ) ( continued )

 

CONTRIBUTIONS

 

Employer contributions to the Australian fund during the year ending 30 June 2005 are expected to be $13,580,000.

 

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

Estimated Future Benefit Payments

 

The following benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, are expected to be paid:

 

2005

   14,936,000

2006

   15,185,000

2007

   18,597,000

2008

   18,080,000

2009

   18,739,000

2010 - 2014

   82,616,000

 

Plan Assets

 

The allocation of the Fund’s assets by asset category is as follows:

 

           Plan assets

 
    

Target

Allocation


   

June

2004


   

June

2003


 

Asset Category

                  

Equity securities

   64 %   64 %   73 %

Debt securities

   22 %   21 %   15 %

Real estate

   9 %   9 %   10 %

Other

   5 %   6 %   2 %

 

The primary investment objective of the South Pacific Tyres Fund within Equipsuper is to achieve a rate of return ( after tax and investment expenses ) that exceeds inflation (CPI) increases by at least 4.0% per annum over rolling three year periods.

 

The South Pacific Tyres partnership (SPT) has maintained Pension Plan benefits for its Australian employees which has comprised both Accumulation and Defined Benefit Components. Both the Defined Benefit and Accumulation components of the Plan have legally existed within a plan sponsored by its Australian partner, Ansell Limited (Ansell). SPT has maintained notional separation of the plan assets and the benefit obligations for all periods presented. Accordingly the accompanying financial information is intended to provide relevant disclosures required pursuant to SFAS 87 and SFAS 132 (revised) with respect to the defined benefit and accumulation components of the SPT plan. Effective 1 April 2004 legal separation from Ansell was achieved and members were transferred out of the Pacific Dunlop Superannuation Fund to Equipsuper (an independent superannuation fund).

 

                 Restated

 
          

2004

$


   

2003

$


   

2002

$


 

Partners’ equity in accordance with US GAAP - Rollforward

                        

Opening Balance July 1

         42,981,711     81,071,566     217,507,945  

Cumulative effect of restatement adjustments at 1st July 2001

         —       —       (29,627,838 )

Net Profit (loss)

         (21,504,129 )   (38,089,855 )   (135,150,410 )

Additional contributed equity - Goodyear Tyres Pty Ltd

         13,000     —       —    

Movement in Other Comprehensive Income

         —       —       3,341,869  

Additional Equity Contribution - Supply Agreement

   32 (j)   —       —       25,000,000  
          

 

 

Closing Balance

         21,490,582     42,981,711     81,071,566  
          

 

 

 

184


PART III

 

South Pacific Tyres and Controlled Entities - Statutory Accounts Year Ended 30 June 2004

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

Note 33 Reconciliation to United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles ( US GAAP ) ( continued )

 

Balance Sheet GAAP adjustment reconciliation

 

    Notes

    AGAAP

 

2004

$

Adjustment


    US GAAP

  AGAAP

 

2003

$

Adjustment


    US GAAP

  AGAAP

 

2002

$

Adjustment


    US GAAP

STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION

                                               

CURRENT ASSETS

                                               

Cash assets

        56,435,875         56,435,875   15,229,939         15,229,939   37,100,672         37,100,672

Receivables

        130,174,880         130,174,880   137,441,630         137,441,630   141,657,657         141,657,657

Inventories

        147,411,193         147,411,193   162,032,137         162,032,137   160,741,965         160,741,965

Prepayments

        3,219,753         3,219,753   3,323,269         3,323,269   2,258,575         2,258,575
         
       
 
 

 
 
       

TOTAL CURRENT ASSETS

        337,241,701         337,241,701   318,026,975         318,026,975   341,758,869         341,758,869
         
       
 
 

 
 
       

NON-CURRENT ASSETS

                                               

Receivables

        1,651,270         1,651,270   9,546,303         9,546,303   30,384,952         30,384,952

Property, plant and equipment

  32
32
32
(a),
(m),
(k)
  197,823,676   (21,663,151 )   176,160,525   218,425,028   (19,952,829 )   198,472,199   202,827,093   (19,795,115 )   183,031,978

Intangible assets

  32 (g)   4,498,952   574,778     5,073,730   4,916,874   287,389     5,204,263   5,204,262         5,204,262

Deferred tax assets

  32 (n)   14,516,753   81,876     14,598,629   18,231,572   434,976     18,666,548   22,441,327   571,200     23,012,527
         
 

 
 
 

 
 
 

 

TOTAL NON-CURRENT ASSETS

        218,490,651   (21,006,497 )   197,484,154   251,119,777   (19,230,464 )   231,889,313   260,857,634   (19,223,915 )   241,633,719
         
 

 
 
 

 
 
 

 

TOTAL ASSETS

        555,732,352   (21,006,497 )   534,725,855   569,146,752   (19,230,464 )   549,916,288   602,616,503   (19,223,915 )   583,392,588
         
 

 
 
 

 
 
 

 

CURRENT LIABILITIES

                                               

Payables

  32
32
32
(p),
(d),
(h)
  144,028,406   1,625,176     145,653,582   159,953,830   2,285,350     162,239,180   161,782,718   2,800,000     164,582,718

Interest bearing liabilities

        188,484,663         188,484,663   171,413,834         171,413,834   142,395,212         142,395,212

Current tax liabilities

        290,809         290,809   135,944         135,944   58,887         58,887

Provisions

  32
32
32
32
32
(k),
(s),
(I),
(o),
(t)
  54,318,272   (8,280,917 )   46,037,355   53,365,690   (6,187,887 )   47,177,803   102,837,858   (5,118,685 )   97,719,173
         
 

 
 
 

 
 
 

 

TOTAL CURRENT LIABILITIES

        387,122,150   (6,655,741 )   380,466,409   384,869,298   (3,902,537 )   380,966,761   407,074,675   (2,318,685 )   404,755,990
         
 

 
 
 

 
 
 

 

NON-CURRENT LIABILITIES

                                               

Payables

        704,179         704,179   7,986,959         7,986,959   28,491,815         28,491,815

Interest bearing liabilities

        125,707,508         125,707,508   111,097,444         111,097,444   61,095,014         61,095,014

Provisions

        6,357,177         6,357,177   6,883,413         6,883,413   7,978,203         7,978,203
         
       
 
       
 
       

TOTAL NON-CURRENT LIABILITIES

        132,768,864         132,768,864   125,967,816         125,967,816   97,565,032         97,565,032
         
 

 
 
 

 
 
 

 

TOTAL LIABLITIES

        519,891,014   (6,655,741 )   513,235,273   510,837,114   (3,902,537 )   506,934,577   504,639,707   (2,318,685 )   502,321,022
         
 

 
 
 

 
 
 

 

PARTNERS’ EQUITY/ACCUMULATED LOSSES

        35,841,338   (14,350,756 )   21,490,582   58,309,638   (15,327,927 )   42,981,711   97,976,796   (16,905,230 )   81,071,566
         
 

 
 
 

 
 
 

 

TOTAL LIABILITIES AND PARTNERS’ EQUITY

        555,732,352   (21,006,497 )   534,725,855   569,146,752   (19,230,464 )   549,916,288   602,616,503   (19,223,915 )   583,392,588
         
 

 
 
 

 
 
 

 

 

185


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

The Partners

South Pacific Tyres:

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statement of financial position of South Pacific Tyres (the Partnership) as of 30 June, 2004, 2003 and 2002 and the related consolidated statements of financial performance, partners’ equity and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year-period ended 30 June, 2004. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Partnerships’ management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Partnership as of 30 June, 2004, 2003 and 2002, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended 30 June, 2004 in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles in Australia.

 

Accounting principles generally accepted in Australia vary in certain significant respects from accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. Information relating to the nature and effect of such differences as it relates to Partnership is presented in Note 31 to the consolidated financial statements. The application of accounting principles generally accepted in the United States would have affected consolidated financial performance for each of the years in the three-year period ended 30 June, 2004 and the determination of partners’ equity as of 30 June, 2004, 2003 and 2002, to the extent summarized in Note 31 to 33 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

As discussed in Note 31 to the consolidated financial statements, the Partnership has restated its description of significant differences between generally accepted accounting principles in Australia and generally accepted accounting principles in the United States and their effects on financial performance and partners’ equity for each of the years in the two-year period ended 30 June, 2003.

 

KPMG

 

Dated in Melbourne, Australia

13 October, 2004,

except for notes 31, 32 and 33

which are as of 15 March, 2005

 

186


Exhibit Index

 

1.1    Constitution of Ansell Limited (incorporated by reference to File No. 0-15850, Form 20-F. filed by the Registrant on December 30, 2002).
7.1    Computation of the Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges.
8.1    List of Subsidiaries.
12.1    Certification of Chief Executive Officer or Equivalent Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
12.2    Certification of Chief Financial Officer or Equivalent Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
13.1    Certification of Chief Executive Officer or Equivalent Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(b) or 15d-14(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code.
13.2    Certification of Chief Financial Officer or Equivalent Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(b) or 15d-14(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code.

 

187